SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549


FORM 6-K


Report of Foreign Private Issuer

Pursuant to Rule 13a-16 or 15d-16 of
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

30 August 2011



The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc


Gogarburn
PO Box 1000
Edinburgh EH12 1HQ
Scotland
United Kingdom

(Address of principal executive offices)



Indicate by check mark whether the registrant files or will file annual reports under cover of Form 20-F or Form 40-F.

Form 20-F                                              Form 40-F    

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is submitting the Form 6-K in paper as permitted by Regulation S-T Rule 101(b)(1):__

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is submitting the Form 6-K in paper as permitted by Regulation S-T Rule 101(b)(7):__

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant by furnishing the information contained in this Form is also thereby furnishing the information to the Commission pursuant to Rule 12g3-2(b) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

Yes                                                                 No  X 

If "Yes" is marked, indicate below the file number assigned to
the registrant in connection with Rule 12g3-2(b): 82-            

This report on Form 6-K shall be deemed incorporated by reference into the company's Registration Statement on Form F-3 (File Nos. 333-162219 and 333-162219-01) and to be a part thereof from the date which it was filed, to the extent not superseded by documents or reports subsequently filed or furnished.

 
 
 

 
 
Explanatory Note
 
The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc is filing this Form 6-K to add note 21 (Consolidating financial information) to its results for the six months ended 30 June 2011, which were previously filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on a separate Form 6-K on 12 August 2011. Note 21 contains condensed consolidating financial information in accordance with Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X for:

- RBSG plc on a stand-alone basis as guarantor ("RBSG Company")
- RBS plc on a stand-alone basis as Issuer ("RBS Company")
- Non-guarantor Subsidiaries of RBSG Company on a combined basis ("Subsidiaries")
- Consolidation adjustments; and
- RBSG plc consolidated amounts ("RBSG Group").
 
 
 

 

Contents

   
 
Page 
   
Forward-looking statements
   
Presentation of information
   
Condensed consolidated income statement
   
Highlights
   
Analysis of results
13 
   
Divisional performance
20 
UK Retail
23 
UK Corporate
27 
Wealth
31 
Global Transaction Services
34 
Ulster Bank
36 
US Retail & Commercial
39 
Global Banking & Markets
45 
RBS Insurance
49 
Central items
53 
Non-Core
54 
   
Condensed consolidated income statement
62 
   
Condensed consolidated statement of comprehensive income
63 
   
Condensed consolidated balance sheet
64 
   
Commentary on condensed consolidated balance sheet
65 
   
Average balance sheet
67 
   
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
70 
   
Condensed consolidated cash flow statement
73 
   
Notes
74 
 
 
1

 

Contents (continued)
   
 
Page 
   
Risk and balance sheet management
 
   
Capital
121 
   
Funding and liquidity risk
126 
   
Credit risk
134 
   
Market risk
168 
   
Risk factors
175 
   
Additional information
179 
   
Selected financial data
179 
   
Signature page
182 
   
Appendix 1  Businesses outlined for disposal
 
   
Appendix 2  Additional risk management disclosures
 
   
Appendix 3  Asset Protection Scheme
 
   
Glossary of terms
 
 
 
2

 

Forward-looking statements

Certain sections in this document contain ‘forward-looking statements’ as that term is defined in the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, such as statements that include the words ‘expect’, ‘estimate’, ‘project’, ‘anticipate’, ‘believes’, ‘should’, ‘intend’, ‘plan’, ‘could’, ‘probability’, ‘risk’, ‘Value-at-Risk (VaR)’, ‘target’, ‘goal’, ‘objective’, ‘will’, ‘endeavour’, ‘outlook’, ‘optimistic’, ‘prospects’ and similar expressions or variations on such expressions.

In particular, this document includes forward-looking statements relating, but not limited to: the Group’s restructuring plans, capitalisation, portfolios, net interest margin, capital ratios, liquidity, risk weighted assets, return on equity (ROE), profitability, cost:income ratios, leverage and loan:deposit ratios, funding and risk profile;  certain ring-fencing proposals; the Group’s future financial performance; the level and extent of future impairments and write-downs, including sovereign debt impairments; the protection provided by the Asset Protection Scheme (APS); and the Group’s potential exposures to various types of market risks, such as interest rate risk, foreign exchange rate risk and commodity and equity price risk. These statements are based on current plans, estimates and projections, and are subject to inherent risks, uncertainties and other factors which could cause actual results to differ materially from the future results expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. For example, certain of the market risk disclosures are dependent on choices about key model characteristics and assumptions and are subject to various limitations. By their nature, certain of the market risk disclosures are only estimates and, as a result, actual future gains and losses could differ materially from those that have been estimated.

Other factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those estimated by the forward-looking statements contained in this document include, but are not limited to: the full nationalisation of the Group or other resolution procedures under the Banking Act 2009; the global economic and financial market conditions and other geopolitical risks, and their impact on the financial industry in general and on the Group in particular; the financial stability of other financial institutions, and the Group’s counterparties and borrowers; the ability to complete restructurings on a timely basis, or at all, including the disposal of certain Non-Core assets and assets and businesses required as part of the EC State Aid restructuring plan; organisational restructuring, including any adverse consequences of a failure to transfer, or delay in transferring, certain businesses, assets and liabilities from RBS Bank N.V. to RBS plc; the ability to access sufficient funding to meet liquidity needs; the extent of future write-downs and impairment charges caused by depressed asset valuations; the inability to hedge certain risks economically; costs or exposures borne by the Group arising out of the origination or sale of mortgages or mortgage-backed securities in the United States; the value and effectiveness of any credit protection purchased by the Group; unanticipated turbulence in interest rates, yield curves, foreign currency exchange rates, credit spreads, bond prices, commodity prices, equity prices and basis, volatility and correlation risks; changes in the credit ratings of the Group; ineffective management of capital or changes to capital adequacy or liquidity requirements; changes to the valuation of financial instruments recorded at fair value; competition and consolidation in the banking sector; HM Treasury exercising influence over the operations of the Group; the ability of the Group to attract or retain senior management or other key employees; regulatory or legal changes (including those requiring any restructuring of the Group’s operations) in the United Kingdom, the United States and other countries in which the Group operates or a change in United Kingdom Government policy; changes to regulatory requirements relating to capital and liquidity; changes to the monetary and interest rate policies of central banks and other government and regulatory bodies; impairments of goodwill; pension fund shortfalls; litigation and regulatory investigations; general operational risks; insurance claims; reputational risk; changes in UK and foreign laws, regulations, accounting standards and taxes, including changes in regulatory capital regulations and liquidity requirements; the recommendations made by the UK Independent Commission on Banking and their potential implications; the participation of the Group in the APS and the effect of the APS on the Group’s financial and capital position; the ability to access the contingent capital arrangements with HM Treasury; the conversion of the B Shares in accordance with their terms; limitations on, or additional requirements imposed on, the Group’s activities as a result of HM Treasury’s investment in the Group; and the success of the Group in managing the risks involved in the foregoing.

The forward-looking statements contained in this document speak only as of the date of this announcement, and the Group does not undertake to update any forward-looking statement to reflect events or circumstances after the date hereof or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events.

The information, statements and opinions contained in this document do not constitute a public offer under any applicable legislation or an offer to sell or solicitation of any offer to buy any securities or financial instruments or any advice or recommendation with respect to such securities or other financial instruments.

 
3

 
Presentation of information

RFS Holdings is the entity that acquired ABN AMRO and is now 98% owned by RBS and is fully consolidated in its financial statements. The interests of Fortis, and its successor the State of the Netherlands, and Santander in RFS Holdings are included in non-controlling interests. Following legal separation on 1 April 2010, the interests of other Consortium Members in RFS Holdings relate only to shared assets.

Non-GAAP financial information
IFRS requires the Group to consolidate those entities that it controls, including RFS Holdings as described above. However, discussion of the Group’s performance focuses on performance measures that exclude the RFS Holdings minority interest as the Group believes that such measures allow a more meaningful analysis of the Group’s financial condition and the results of its operations. These measures are non-GAAP financial measures. A body of generally accepted accounting principles such as IFRS is commonly referred to as ‘GAAP’. A non-GAAP financial measure is defined as one that measures historical or future financial performance, financial position or cash flows but which excludes or includes amounts that would not be so adjusted in the most comparable GAAP measure. Reconciliations of these non-GAAP measures are presented throughout this document. These non-GAAP financial measures are not a substitute for GAAP measures, for which management has responsibility. RBS has divided its operations into “Core” and “Non-Core” for internal reporting purposes. Certain measures disclosed in this document for Core operations and used by RBS management are non-GAAP financial measures as they represent a combination of all reportable segments with the exception of Non-Core. In addition, RBS has further divided parts of the Core business into “Retail & Commercial” consisting of UK Retail, UK Corporate, Wealth, Global Transaction Services, Ulster Bank and US Retail & Commercial divisions. This is a non-GAAP financial measure.


Net interest margin
The basis of calculating the net interest margin (NIM) was refined in Q1 2011 and reflects the actual number of days in each quarter. Group and divisional NIMs for 2010 have been re-computed on the new basis.

 
4

 
 
Condensed consolidated income statement
for the half year ended 30 June 2011

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Interest receivable
5,404 
5,401 
5,888 
 
10,805 
11,580 
Interest payable
(2,177)
(2,100)
(2,212)
 
(4,277)
(4,362)
             
Net interest income
3,227 
3,301 
3,676 
 
6,528 
7,218 
             
Fees and commissions receivable
1,700 
1,642 
2,053 
 
3,342 
4,104 
Fees and commissions payable
(323)
(260)
(579)
 
(583)
(1,151)
Income from trading activities
1,147 
835 
2,110 
 
1,982 
3,876 
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
553 
 
255 
553 
Other operating income (excluding insurance
  premium income)
1,142 
391 
346 
 
1,533 
793 
Insurance net premium income
1,090 
1,149 
1,278 
 
2,239 
2,567 
             
Non-interest income
5,011 
3,757 
5,761 
 
8,768 
10,742 
             
Total income
8,238 
7,058 
9,437 
 
15,296 
17,960 
             
Staff costs
(2,210)
(2,399)
(2,365)
 
(4,609)
(5,054)
Premises and equipment
(602)
(571)
(547)
 
(1,173)
(1,082)
Other administrative expenses
(1,752)
(921)
(1,022)
 
(2,673)
(2,033)
Depreciation and amortisation
(453)
(424)
(519)
 
(877)
(1,001)
             
Operating expenses
(5,017)
(4,315)
(4,453)
 
(9,332)
(9,170)
             
Profit before other operating charges and
  impairment losses
3,221 
2,743 
4,984 
 
5,964 
8,790 
Insurance net claims
(793)
(912)
(1,323)
 
(1,705)
(2,459)
Impairment losses
(3,106)
(1,947)
(2,487)
 
(5,053)
(5,162)
             
Operating (loss)/profit before tax
(678)
(116)
1,174 
 
(794)
1,169 
Tax charge
(222)
(423)
(825)
 
(645)
(932)
             
(Loss)/profit from continuing operations
(900)
(539)
349 
 
(1,439)
237 
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
21 
10 
(1,019)
 
31 
(706)
             
Loss for the period
(879)
(529)
(670)
 
(1,408)
(469)
Non-controlling interests
(18)
946 
 
(17)
602 
Preference share and other dividends
(19)
 
(124)
             
(Loss)/profit attributable to ordinary and B
  shareholders
(897)
(528)
257 
 
(1,425)
 
 
5

 
 
Comment

Stephen Hester, Group Chief Executive, commented:

“RBS’s second quarter results show the Group’s restructuring momentum continues whilst Core business performance is resilient in challenging market conditions.

I am pleased with progress across key aspects of the RBS Strategic Plan.  The run-down of Non-Core assets is ahead of schedule and c.60% below our starting point. The large improvements in balance sheet structure and funding that we have accomplished particularly show their value in turbulent debt markets such as those of recent months. In our Core businesses important turnarounds in RBS Insurance and Citizens continue. New provisioning in Ireland has shown its first quarterly decline.

Service to customers remains at the heart of our mission. It is even more important with economic recovery slower than had been hoped for which will also affect the speed of our own recovery. However, the Bank’s principal businesses remain solidly profitable, though results in GBM have been impacted by difficult markets.

There is no shortcut to achieving our goals. We seek excellence in support of customers; a strong risk profile with the past accounted for; and the improved shareholder returns important to all. This is our focus. Economic and regulatory headwinds may be challenging but the momentum that our people and restructuring actions have sustained thus far in the RBS recovery plan should continue to stand us in good stead.”
 
 
6

 
 
Highlights

Second quarter results summary
The Royal Bank of Scotland Group (RBS or the Group) reported an operating loss before tax of £678 million in the second quarter of 2011, compared with a loss of £116 million in the first quarter of 2011 and a profit of £1,174 million in Q2 2010.

Excluding the impact of Payment Protection Insurance costs of £850 million, Sovereign debt impairment of £733 million and interest rate hedge adjustments on impaired available-for-sale Greek government bonds of £109 million, the Group reported a profit of £818 million in the second quarter of 2011, 22% lower than in Q1 2011 but up from £250 million in Q2 2010.

The results reflect steady momentum in the Core Retail & Commercial (R&C) businesses, with further progress in the US and reduced losses in Ulster Bank, but lower revenue in Global Banking & Markets (GBM), where weaker client activity across all trading desks and active risk reduction within the business reflected the uncertain market environment. RBS Insurance continued its recovery.

Non-Core continued its risk reduction programme, with funded assets falling by £12 billion during the quarter as the division worked through its pipeline of disposals. Non-Core remains on track to meet its target of reducing third party assets to below £100 billion by the end of the year.

A charge of £850 million, previously announced, was booked during the second quarter for Payment Protection Insurance claims. In addition a provision for impairment of £733 million was booked against Greek government bonds. If the proposed restructuring of Greek government debt announced in July is effected, RBS could recognise a credit of c.£275 million in the second half of 2011, partially offsetting this charge. A liability management exercise in Ulster Bank resulted in a gain of £255 million on the purchase of own asset securitisation debt during the quarter.

A gain of £339 million was recorded on movements in the fair value of own debt, as credit spreads widened, compared with a charge of £480 million in Q1 2011 and a gain of £619 million in Q2 2010. A further charge of £168 million (compared with £469 million in the first quarter) was booked in respect of the Asset Protection Scheme (APS), which is accounted for as a derivative. The cumulative APS charge now stands at £2,187 million.

After these and other charges, RBS recorded a pre-tax loss of £678 million. After tax and minority interests, the attributable loss was £897 million, compared with a loss of £528 million in Q1 2011 and a profit of £257 million in Q2 2010.

Income
Group income totalled £8,238 million, up 17% from Q1 2011. Excluding movements in the fair value of own debt of £339 million, a charge in respect of the APS credit default swap of £168 million, strategic disposals of £50 million, gain on redemption of own debt of £255 million and other adjustments totalling a loss of £5 million, Group income totalled £7,767 million, down 3% from Q1 2011. Retail & Commercial (R&C) revenues were up 1% while GBM revenues fell back from a strong first quarter result, as the uncertain trading environment dampened client activities across all trading desks. GBM income in the first half, at £3,930 million, was broadly in line with previous guidance on annual run rates. However, fixed income and currency flows are inherently volatile, and in current difficult market conditions we have reduced risk exposures in the division, which is likely to result in lower run rates until customer confidence improves. On the same basis, Group income was down 5% compared with the second quarter of 2010.
 
 
7

 
 
Highlights (continued)

Second quarter results summary (continued)
Non-Core income performance, on the other hand, was strong, up from £486 million in the first quarter to £978 million in the second quarter, reflecting gains on a number of securities arising from restructured assets.

Net interest income was 2% lower than in the first quarter, with Group net interest margin narrowing to 1.96% from 2.04%, reflecting a Q1 2011 non-recurring item in UK Corporate of £50 million, as well as precautionary liquidity and funding strategies given the environment. Non-interest income increased 33% to £5,011 million from £3,757 million. Excluding movements in the fair value of own debt of £339 million, a charge on the APS credit default swap of £168 million, strategic disposals of £50 million, gain on redemption of own debt of £255 million and other adjustments of £1 million, non-interest income fell by 4% from Q1 2011, reflecting principally the decline in trading income in GBM. This was partially offset by the strong performance in Non-Core.

Expenses
Group second quarter costs totalled £5,017 million, up 16% from Q1 2011 and down 13% from Q2 2010. Excluding Payment Protection Insurance costs of £850 million, integration and restructuring costs of £209 million, amortisation of purchased intangible assets of £56 million and other adjustments of £10 million, Group second quarter costs totalled £3,892 million, down 6% from Q1 2011 and down 5% from Q2 2010. This was principally driven by reduced staff costs in GBM, reflecting the division’s lower income levels, as well as overall tight expense discipline.

The Group cost:income ratio was 61%, compared with 61% in Q1 2011 and 47% in Q2 2010. The Core cost:income ratio was 52%, compared with 50% in Q1 2011 and 48% in Q2 2010.

Impairments
Impairments were £1,159 million higher at £3,106 million in Q2 2011. Excluding sovereign debt impairment of £733 million and interest rate hedge adjustments on available-for-sale Greek government bonds of £109 million, impairments were £317 million higher at £2,264 million in Q2 2011, driven principally by additional provisions in respect of development land values in Non-Core’s Irish portfolios and a small number of impairments relating to large corporates. Core impairments were 2% lower than in Q1 2011 at £853 million and 22% down from Q2 2010, with more stable trends in Core Ulster Bank and US loan books partially offset by a number of single name corporate impairments. Core impairments represented 0.8% of loans and advances to customers, compared with 0.8% in Q1 2011 and 1.0% in Q2 2010.

The combined Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) impairment charge of £1,251 million for Q2 2011 was £49 million lower than Q1 2011. This reflected a decrease in defaulting loans and a stabilisation of mortgage loan loss metrics, offset by deteriorating collateral values in our development portfolios.

Balance sheet
RBS’s balance sheet remained stable in the second quarter, with Group third party assets (excluding derivatives) of £1,051 billion, compared with £1,052 billion at 31 March 2011.
 
 
8

 
 
Highlights (continued)

Second quarter results summary (continued)

Non-Core third party assets fell by £12 billion to £113 billion during the second quarter, driven by £7 billion of disposals and £5 billion of portfolio run-off. Over the 12 months ending 30 June 2011, Non-Core assets declined by £61 billion (35%), including £36 billion of disposals and £26 billion of run-off.

Core third party assets grew by £11 billion during the quarter, with strong asset growth in Global Transaction Services (GTS) and increased cash balances held with central banks.

Funding and liquidity
The Group funding gap fell by £5 billion to £61 billion in the quarter, as the Group loan:deposit ratio (LDR) improved to 114% versus 115% in Q1 2011 and 128% in Q2 2010. The Core LDR was 96%, flat to the first quarter and down from 102% in Q2 2010.

Short term wholesale funding, excluding derivative collateral, increased slightly, reflecting the approaching maturity of medium term notes issued under the Credit Guarantee Scheme, which are on track to be repaid in full by Q2 2012. The liquidity portfolio remained above target at £155 billion and increased £18 billion year on year.

RBS issued £8 billion of term funding during the second quarter, taking total term issuance for the first half to £18 billion, compared with a full year target of £23 billion. Issuance was principally in euros and US dollars.

Capital
The Core Tier 1 ratio remained strong at 11.1%. The movement in the ratio from the first quarter reflected a small reduction in Core Tier 1 capital driven by the loss in the quarter partially offset by a small decline in gross risk-weighted assets, excluding the benefit provided by the APS. During the second quarter RWAs fell in GBM and Non-Core, but rose in Ulster Bank, where the continuing weak credit environment led to increased risk weightings. Compared with Q2 2010, gross Group RWAs have fallen by £9.4 billion. The APS provided a benefit to the Core Tier 1 ratio of approximately 1.3%, unchanged in the quarter.

Regulation
The international regulatory reform agenda has continued to progress in recent months, including the announcement of draft proposals from the European Commission for the implementation of the Basel III capital and liquidity framework, publication by the Basel Committee of increased loss absorbency requirements for banks deemed to be of global systemic importance and consultation by the Financial Stability Board on measures to enable the effective resolution of systemically important financial institutions.

In the UK, RBS has responded to the Interim Report of the Independent Commission on Banking, welcoming the Commission’s support for the far-reaching programme of international reform. This programme in RBS’s view will bring about a substantial reduction in both the probability of bank failure and the impact of such failure and thereby effectively tackle the issue of implicit state subsidies.

 
9

 
 
Highlights (continued)

Second quarter results summary (continued)

RBS continues to engage with the Commission and with regulators on the Commission’s proposals for ring-fencing certain activities. In RBS’s view, ring-fencing is unlikely to meet the tests set out in the Commission’s terms of reference. We believe it might actually result in increased risk whilst costs to banks and the broader economy could be significant. The case for going further than the international reform under way is unproven. The economic and market backdrop also suggest that further change may be ill-timed.

RBS’s analysis of these issues and constructive proposals regarding a ring-fence are set out in the above referenced response to the Commission, available on the RBS website.

Customer franchises
Central to the Group’s strategic plan is the objective of serving our customers well and better.  Throughout the last two years our businesses have demonstrated their commitment to making this a firm reality.  We continue to execute previously announced programmes and the first half of 2011 saw further examples of that commitment.

Key to all of our businesses is ensuring that customers have access to the products and services they require, where and when they require them.  In working to achieve this, many of our businesses have focused on how they can work together to improve the customer experience.

GBM, GTS and UK Corporate have established a cross-business committee to work with customers to develop and deepen the relationships already in place and ensure that customers receive a truly joined-up service from the Group. 

During H1 2011 GTS also worked in partnership with Citizens in the US to provide a new, all-in-one, cash management tool to SME customers. The tool is accessed online from a computer or mobile device and was developed as a result of direct feedback from Citizens customers, allowing smaller businesses to improve the efficiency and effectiveness of their everyday cash transactions.

In the UK, UK Corporate’s newly launched “Ahead for Business” campaign brings together the services provided by its own relationship managers but also some of those provided by GTS, GBM and UK Retail. For instance, GTS can provide advice and support for UK businesses looking to expand internationally, GBM can carry out foreign exchange transactions on behalf of smaller clients and UK Retail provide the branch network and online capabilities which allow many of UK Corporate’s customers to interact with the RBS Group.

Developments in technology have also helped meet our goal of improving the customer experience; the development of an updated iPhone application by UK Retail in H1 2011 allowed customers sight of all their accounts held with RBS or NatWest and provided the capability to make transfers between them. Wealth’s continuing use of social media in increasing public awareness of the Coutts brand, and of the products and services on offer was another example. GBM also improved its online research and trading portal in the quarter with innovative tools such as the application for the BlackBerry PlayBook, which provides tailored research to clients on the move.

The Group recognises that there is still progress to be made, but remains committed to improving standards of customer service in all its businesses.
 
 
10

 
 
Highlights (continued)

Second quarter results summary (continued)

UK Lending
RBS is committed to supporting its UK customers and the UK economy as a whole. Lending to UK businesses is one way in which the Group provides this support, and in H1 2011 the Group provided a total of £44.2 billion of new lending to UK business customers. This comprised £16.7 billion of gross new loans and facilities to mid and large corporates, £7.2 billion of mid-corporate overdraft renewals, £15.5 billion of gross new loans and facilities to SMEs and £4.8 billion of SME overdraft renewals. RBS continues to make available lending facilities considerably in excess of its market share of UK corporate and SME relationships, highlighting the effectiveness of the Group’s efforts to support business customers.

The Group recognised the importance of the overdraft as a source of finance for SMEs when it introduced its Overdraft Price Promise in 2008.  Since then, the overdraft price promise has been a significant driver of lending volumes, and over a quarter of gross new lending to SMEs in H1 2011 represented an overdraft renewal or new overdraft facility. Over 90% of SME customers have had their overdrafts renewed at the same or a lower margin, representing a total saving to customers of £250 million.

Demand from mid and large corporates remained robust in the second quarter, with the attractive rates available in the market encouraging many businesses to refinance. This led to strong gross new lending volumes, though repayments were also high. Mid and large corporate drawn balances totalled £52.8 billion at 30 June 2011, compared with £54.5 billion at the end of Q1 2011.

Repayments also continued at elevated levels in the SME segment in Q2 2011, with the result that drawn balances declined during the quarter. In the manufacturing and public administration sectors, however, drawn balances increased, reflecting stronger demand in these sectors. Core SME drawn balances totalled £52.3 billion at 30 June 2011, compared with £53.5 billion at 31 March 2011. Excluding real estate and construction, balances were 1% lower.

Demand for credit from SMEs remains well below pre-crisis levels. The independent SME Finance Monitor survey showed that 81% of SMEs had no plans to borrow in the following three months and only 2% of SMEs cited lack of external finance as the main obstacle to running their business over the same time period. This is reflected in the continued low volumes of applications for new lending received from businesses - 139,000 in H1 2011, down 20% from H1 2010. Approval rates remained above 85% in H1 2011, but overdraft utilisation rates also fell away from the seasonal high in Q1 2011.

The Group is committed to fostering demand and has launched a number of new initiatives, under the banner of “Ahead for Business”, designed to ensure that SME customers banking with the Group can be confident in realising their potential. Specific activities include reinforcing the “open for business” message through the provision of funds targeted at specific segments including renewables and franchises. The Group has invested in increasing relationship managers’ skills, with over 4,000 relationship managers completing accredited qualifications.

 
11

 
 
Highlights (continued)

Second quarter results summary (continued)

Outlook
RBS targets continued progress in implementing its restructuring plans. The trajectory of economic recovery and interest rates will influence the pace of R&C profit improvement. GBM seems likely to experience activity levels below those targeted while markets remain anxious. The pattern of regulatory change will also impact industry outlook. Despite these factors the bank will remain focussed on supporting customers, reducing risk and building sustainable profitability.

 
12

 
Analysis of results

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
Net interest income
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
           
Net interest income
3,227 
3,301 
 
6,528 
7,218 
           
Average interest-earning assets
660,548 
657,610 
 
658,887 
709,910 
           
Net interest margin
         
  - Group
1.96% 
2.04% 
 
2.00% 
2.05% 
  - Core
         
    - Retail & Commercial (1)
3.22% 
3.27% 
 
3.25% 
3.06% 
    - Global Banking & Markets
0.70% 
0.76% 
 
0.73% 
1.07% 
  - Non-Core
0.87% 
0.90% 
 
0.89% 
1.25% 

Notes:
(1)
Retail & Commercial comprises the UK Retail, UK Corporate, Wealth, Global Transaction Services, Ulster Bank and US Retail & Commercial divisions.

Key points

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Net interest income (NII) fell 2% from Q1 2011, primarily reflecting an income recognition adjustment in UK Corporate in Q1 2011 and higher funding costs, along with the continued run-down of Non-Core assets.
   
·
Group NIM narrowed to 1.96% from 2.04% in the first quarter, or 4 basis points adjusting for the UK Corporate income recognition adjustment of £50 million in Q1 2011. This reflected some tightening of margins in GBM and precautionary Group liquidity and funding strategies given the environment.
   
·
Core Retail & Commercial NIM decreased 5 basis points from Q1 2011 to 3.22%. Excluding the one-off adjustment in UK Corporate of £50 million, Core R&C NIM was stable, 3.22% in Q2 2011 compared with 3.21% underlying in Q1 2011. Asset margins in UK Retail were stable as higher quality, lower loan to value, mortgage lending continued to increase as a proportion of total lending, curtailing further margin expansion.  Overall deposit margins held broadly flat quarter on quarter.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
First half net interest income was 10% lower than in 2010, with Group NIM down 5 basis points to 2.00%. Excluding one-off adjustments of £200 million, first half net interest income was 7% lower than in 2010 reflecting lower interest earning assets. Group NIM was stable with strengthening asset margins in Retail & Commercial offsetting a decline in Non-Core and GBM, driven by a reduction in margin on the lending portfolio combined with higher costs of funding and liquidity.

 
13

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
Non-interest income
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Net fees and commissions
1,377 
1,382 
1,474 
 
2,759 
2,953 
Income from trading activities
           
  - Asset Protection Scheme credit default swap - fair value charges
(168)
(469)
500 
 
(637)
  - movements in the fair value of own debt
111 
 (186)
104 
 
 (75)
145 
  - other
1,204 
1,490 
1,506 
 
2,694 
3,731 
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
553 
 
255 
553 
Other operating income
           
  - strategic disposals
50 
(23)
(411)
 
27 
(358)
  - movements in the fair value of own debt
228 
 (294)
515 
 
 (66)
305 
  - other
864 
708 
242 
 
1,572 
846 
             
Non-interest income (excluding insurance
  net premium income)
3,921 
2,608 
4,483 
 
6,529 
8,175 
Insurance net premium income
1,090 
1,149 
1,278 
 
2,239 
2,567 
             
Total non-interest income
5,011 
3,757 
5,761 
 
8,768 
10,742 

Key points

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Non-interest income increased 33% to £5,011 million. Excluding movements in the fair value of own debt of £339 million, a charge on the APS credit default swap of £168 million, strategic disposals of £50 million, gain on redemption of own debt of £255 million and other adjustments of £1 million, non-interest income fell by 4%, principally reflecting the decline in trading income in GBM after the strong results recorded in Q1 2011. Non-Core, however, recorded gains on a number of securities arising from restructured assets. A gain of £108 million was also recorded on the sale of Group Treasury’s remaining shares in Visa.
   
·
A £255 million gain on purchase of own asset securitisation debt was booked in the quarter arising from a liability management exercise by Ulster Bank.
   
·
The decline in insurance net premium income principally reflects the run-off of the legacy insurance book in Non-Core.

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Non-interest income decreased by 13% to £5,011 million, principally reflecting lower income from trading activities in GBM, partially offset by the increase in Non-Core gains recognised in the quarter.
   
·
Net premium income in RBS Insurance declined by 8%, reflecting the earned impact of the reduction in the risk of the book and pricing action taken last year, together with the exit of unprofitable partnerships and personal lines broker business.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Lower non-interest income was driven by the 31% fall in GBM trading income, reflecting buoyant market conditions experienced during the first half of 2010, contrasting with increased client risk aversion as a result of concerns over the Eurozone sovereign debt situation experienced in H1 2011.
 
 
14

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
Operating expenses
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Staff costs
2,210 
2,399 
2,365 
 
4,609 
5,054 
Premises and equipment
602 
571 
547 
 
1,173 
1,082 
Other
 
 
 
 
 
 
  - Payment Protection Insurance costs
850    850 
  - other 902  921  1,022    1,823  2,033 
             
Administrative expenses
4,564 
3,891 
3,934 
 
8,455 
8,169 
Depreciation and amortisation
           
  - amortisation of purchased intangible assets
56 
44 
85 
 
100 
150 
  - other
397
380 
434 
 
777
851 
             
Operating expenses
5,017 
4,315 
4,453 
 
9,332 
9,170 
             
             
General insurance
793 
912 
1,348 
 
1,705 
2,455 
Bancassurance
(25)
 
             
Insurance net claims
793 
912 
1,323 
 
1,705 
2,459 
             
             
Staff costs as a % of total income
27% 
34% 
25% 
 
30% 
28% 

Key points

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Group second quarter costs were up 16%. Excluding Payment Protection Insurance costs of £850 million, amortisation of purchased intangible assets of £56 million, integration and restructuring costs of £209 million and other adjustments of £10 million. Group second quarter costs were down 6%, principally driven by reduced staff costs in GBM, reflecting the division’s lower income levels. Retail & Commercial costs were 2% higher, reflecting the phasing of technology project expenditure.
   
·
As previously announced, an £850 million Payment Protection Insurance provision was taken in the quarter. This provision is in addition to an existing provision of £100 million, as well as £100 million already paid out to customers as at 30 June 2011.

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Group costs were 13% higher than in Q2 2010, with staff costs 7% lower.
   
·
Insurance net claims fell 40% from the high levels recorded in Q2 2010, which included increased bodily injury reserving.
   
·
The Group cost:income ratio was 61% compared with 61% in Q2 2010. The Core cost:income ratio was 52% compared with 50% in the prior quarter, driven by a fall in GBM income.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Total expenses were 2% higher than in H1 2010, with Core expenses stable and Non-Core 46% down.
   
·
The Group's Cost Reduction Programme is running ahead of its target to deliver annual savings of £2.5 billion by 2011, as announced in February 2009. Further opportunities to reduce costs and make headroom for new investment continue to be pursued. Savings totalled £1.4 billion in H1 2011 compared with £1.1 billion in H1 2010. The underlying run rate achieved was £2.9 billion per annum.

 
15

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
Impairment losses
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Loan impairment losses
2,237 
1,898 
2,479 
 
4,135 
5,081 
Securities impairment losses
           
  - sovereign debt impairment (1)
733 
 
733 
  - interest rate hedge adjustments on
    impaired available-for-sale Greek
    government bonds
109 
 
109 
  - other
27 
49 
 
76 
81 
             
Group impairment losses
3,106 
1,947 
2,487 
 
5,053 
5,162 
             
Loan impairment losses - customers
           
  - latent
(188)
(107)
(76)
 
(295)
(45)
  - collectively assessed
591 
720 
752 
 
1,311 
1,593 
  - individual assessed
1,834 
1,285 
1,803 
 
3,119 
3,533 
             
Loan impairment losses
2,237 
1,898 
2,479 
 
4,135 
5,081 
             
Core
810 
852 
1,096 
 
1,662 
2,046 
Non-Core
1,427 
1,046 
1,383 
 
2,473 
3,035 
             
Loan impairment losses
2,237 
1,898 
2,479 
 
4,135 
5,081 
             
             
Customer loan impairment charge as
  a % of gross loans and advances (2)
           
Group
1.8% 
1.5% 
1.8% 
 
1.6% 
1.8% 
Core
0.8% 
0.8% 
1.0% 
 
0.8% 
1.0% 
Non-Core
6.0% 
4.0% 
4.4% 
 
5.2% 
4.8% 

Notes:
(1)
The Group holds Greek government bonds with a notional amount of £1.45 billion. In the second quarter of 2011, the Group recorded an impairment loss of £733 million in respect of these bonds as a result of Greece’s continuing fiscal difficulties. This charge (c.50% of notional) wrote the bonds down to their market price as at 30 June 2011.
 
The bonds are classified as available-for-sale financial assets and measured at fair value. Under IFRS, when an available-for-sale financial asset is impaired, cumulative losses in other comprehensive income are recycled to profit or loss as an impairment charge. This mark was taken as of 30 June 2011, as called for under IFRS, and does not reflect subsequent events.
 
On 21 July 2011 proposals to restructure Greek government debt were announced by the Heads of State or Government of the Euro area and EU institutions. These proposals include a voluntary programme of debt exchange for bonds that mature in 2020 or earlier and a buyback plan developed by the Greek government. There are four different instruments in the exchange programme but each will be priced to produce a c.21% net present value loss based on an assumed discount rate of 9%; the Group holds bonds with a notional amount of £941 million that would be eligible for the exchange programme. If the proposals go ahead, the Group could recognise a credit of c.£275 million.
(2)
Gross loans and advances to customers include disposal groups and exclude reverse repurchase agreements.
 
 
16

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)

Key points

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Impairments were £1,159 million higher at £3,106 million. Excluding sovereign debt impairment of £733 million and interest rate hedge adjustments on available-for sale Greek government bonds of £109 million, impairments were £317 million higher at £2,264 million driven by a significant increase in Non-Core, with higher provisions associated with development land values in Ireland and impairments relating to a small number of large corporates. Core impairments were 2% lower than in Q1 2011, with greater stability in Core Ulster Bank and US loan books partially offset by a number of single name corporate impairments in the UK.
   
·
Greece’s continuing fiscal difficulties during Q2 2011 drove impairment on the Greek government AFS bond portfolio, resulting in the recycling of £733 million cumulative losses included within the available-for-sale reserve, in the quarter.
   
·
Combined Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) impairments, though still elevated, declined slightly to £1,251 million.

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Core R&C impairments were 12% lower, with marked improvements in credit metrics for UK and US Retail & Commercial but increased provisions on single corporate exposures.
   
·
The Group impairment charge remained stable as a percentage of loans and advances at 1.8%.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Group impairment losses were down 2%, with reductions in both Core and Non-Core impairments, partially offset by the impairment on the Greek government AFS bond portfolio.
   
·
The Group impairment charge as a percentage of loans and advances was 20 basis points lower at 1.6%.

 
17

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)

Capital resources and ratios
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
       
Core Tier 1 capital
£48bn 
£49bn 
£50bn 
Tier 1 capital
£58bn 
£60bn 
£60bn 
Total capital
£62bn 
£64bn 
£65bn 
Risk-weighted assets
     
  - gross
£529bn 
£538bn 
£571bn 
  - benefit of the Asset Protection Scheme
(£95bn)
(£98bn)
(£106bn)
Risk-weighted assets
£434bn 
£440bn 
£465bn 
Core Tier 1 ratio (1)
11.1% 
11.2% 
10.7% 
Tier 1 ratio
13.5% 
13.5% 
12.9% 
Total capital ratio
14.4% 
14.5% 
14.0% 

Note:
(1)
The benefit of APS in Core Tier 1 ratio is 1.3% at 30 June 2011 (31 March 2011 - 1.3%; 31 December 2010 - 1.2 %).
 
Key points
·
The Core Tier 1 ratio remained strong at 11.1%. The movement in the ratio reflects a small reduction in Core Tier 1 capital driven by the loss in the quarter, partially offset by a modest decline in gross risk-weighted assets, excluding the benefit provided by the APS.
   
·
The APS scheme provided relief equivalent to 1.3% of Core Tier 1.
   
·
GBM risk-weighted assets fell by £7.5 billion from Q1 2011, largely driven by a decrease in market risk as the division managed down its risk positions. Non-Core risk-weighted assets decreased by £3.8 billion as a result of further run-off and disposals in the quarter. These reductions were partially offset by an increase of £4.6 billion in Ulster Bank reflecting the impact of a weak economic environment on credit risk metrics.
 
 
18

 
Analysis of results (continued)

Balance sheet
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
       
Total assets
£1,446bn 
£1,413bn 
£1,454bn 
Funded balance sheet
£1,051bn 
£1,052bn 
£1,026bn 
Loans and advances to customers (1)
£490bn 
£494bn 
£503bn 
Customer deposits (2)
£429bn 
£428bn 
£429bn 
Loan:deposit ratio - Core (3)
96% 
96% 
96% 
Loan:deposit ratio - Group (3)
114% 
115% 
117% 

Notes:
(1)
Excluding reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing.
(2)
Excluding repurchase agreements and stock lending.
(3)
Net of provisions.

Key points
·
The Group’s funded balance sheet remained stable over the quarter at £1,051 billion. Non-Core’s funded assets fell by £12 billion in the quarter; the division remains on track to meet the year end target of under £100 billion of funded assets. GBM’s funded assets declined £4 billion in the quarter and remain in the middle of the division’s target range. Offsetting these decreases was an increase in the holding of Government bonds and increased cash balances held at Central Banks. Liquid assets increased, with the liquidity portfolio now £155 billion.
   
·
Loans and advances to customers fell by £4 billion in the quarter, reflecting further progress in the run-down of Non-Core assets. In Core, loan growth returned to the US Retail & Commercial franchise and balance sheet momentum continued in GTS. Retail & Commercial overall saw a £2 billion (1%) increase in loans and advances.
   
·
The Group loan:deposit ratio was 114% in Q2 2011, improving by 1% from the first quarter and down from 128% in Q2 2010. The Core loan:deposit ratio was 96% in Q2 2011, compared with 96% in Q1 2011 and 102% in Q2 2010.

Further discussion of the Group’s funding and liquidity position is included on pages 125 to 133.

 
19

 

Divisional performance


 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Operating profit/(loss) by division
           
UK Retail
523 
508 
276 
 
1,031 
416 
UK Corporate
345 
493 
390 
 
838 
708 
Wealth
74 
80 
81 
 
154 
143 
Global Transaction Services
164 
187 
279 
 
351 
512 
Ulster Bank
(189)
(377)
(177)
 
(566)
(314)
US Retail & Commercial
127 
80 
129 
 
207 
169 
             
Retail & Commercial
1,044 
971 
978 
 
2,015 
1,634 
Global Banking & Markets
446 
1,098 
750 
 
1,544 
2,248 
RBS Insurance
139 
67 
(203)
 
206 
(253)
Central items
47 
(43)
49 
 
386 
             
Core
1,676 
2,093 
1,574 
 
3,769 
4,015 
Non-Core
(858)
(1,040)
(1,324)
 
(1,898)
(2,883)
             
 
818 
1,053 
250 
 
1,871 
1,132 
Reconciling items:
           
Fair value of own debt
339 
(480)
619 
 
(141)
450 
Asset Protection Scheme credit default swap -
  fair value changes
(168)
(469)
500 
 
(637)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(850)
 
(850)
Sovereign debt impairment and related interest rate
  hedge adjustments
(842)
 
(842)
Amortisation of purchased intangible costs
(56)
(44)
(85)
 
(100)
(150)
Integration and restructuring costs
(208)
(145)
(254)
 
(353)
(422)
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
553 
 
255 
553 
Strategic disposals
50 
(23)
(411)
 
27 
(358)
Other
(16)
(8)
 
(24)
(36)
             
Group operating (loss)/profit
(678)
(116)
1,174 
 
(794)
1,169 

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Impairment losses/(recoveries) by division
           
UK Retail
208 
194 
300 
 
402 
687 
UK Corporate
218 
105 
198 
 
323 
384 
Wealth
 
11 
Global Transaction Services
54 
20 
 
74 
Ulster Bank
269 
461 
281 
 
730 
499 
US Retail & Commercial
66 
110 
144 
 
176 
287 
             
Retail & Commercial
818 
895 
933 
 
1,713 
1,871 
Global Banking & Markets
37 
(24)
164 
 
13 
196 
Central items
(2)
 
(1)
             
Core
853 
872 
1,097 
 
1,725 
2,068 
Non-Core
1,411 
1,075 
1,390 
 
2,486 
3,094 
             
Impairment losses
2,264 
1,947 
2,487 
 
4,211 
5,162 
             
Reconciling item:
           
Sovereign debt impairment and related interest rate
  hedge adjustments
842 
 
842 
             
Group impairment losses
3,106 
1,947 
2,487 
 
5,053 
5,162 
 
 
20

 
 
Divisional performance (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
 
             
Net interest margin by division
           
UK Retail
4.00 
4.04 
3.89 
 
4.02 
3.80 
UK Corporate
2.55 
2.73 
2.51 
 
2.64 
2.46 
Wealth
3.61 
3.45 
3.37 
 
3.53 
3.40 
Global Transaction Services
5.63 
5.91 
6.49 
 
5.77 
7.16 
Ulster Bank
1.69 
1.72 
1.92 
 
1.71 
1.86 
US Retail & Commercial
3.11 
3.01 
2.79 
 
3.06 
2.76 
             
Retail & Commercial
3.22 
3.27 
3.11 
 
3.25 
3.06 
Global Banking & Markets
0.70 
0.76 
1.01 
 
0.73 
1.07 
Non-Core
0.87 
0.90 
1.23 
 
0.89 
1.25 
             
Group net interest margin
1.96 
2.04 
   
2.00 
2.05 


 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Risk-weighted assets by division
           
UK Retail
49.5 
50.3 
(2%)
 
48.8 
1% 
UK Corporate
77.9 
79.3 
(2%)
 
81.4 
(4%)
Wealth
12.9 
12.6 
2% 
 
12.5 
3% 
Global Transaction Services
18.8 
18.2 
3% 
 
18.3 
3% 
Ulster Bank
36.3 
31.7 
15% 
 
31.6 
15%  
US Retail & Commercial
54.8 
53.6 
2% 
 
57.0 
(4%)
             
Retail & Commercial
250.2 
245.7 
2% 
 
249.6 
Global Banking & Markets
139.0 
146.5 
(5%)
 
146.9 
(5%)
Other
11.8 
14.5 
(19%)
 
18.0 
(34%)
             
Core
401.0 
406.7 
(1%)
 
414.5 
(3%)
Non-Core
124.7 
128.5 
(3%)
 
153.7 
(19%)
             
Group before benefit of Asset Protection Scheme
525.7 
535.2 
 (2%)
 
568.2 
(7%)
Benefit of Asset Protection Scheme
(95.2)
(98.4)
 (3%)
 
(105.6)
(10%)
             
Group before RFS Holdings minority interest
430.5 
436.8 
 (1%)
 
462.6 
(7%)
RFS Holdings minority interest
3.0 
2.9 
3% 
 
2.9 
3% 
             
Group
433.5 
439.7 
 (1%)
 
465.5 
(7%)

For the purposes of the divisional return on equity ratios, notional equity has been calculated as a percentage of the monthly average of divisional risk-weighted assets, adjusted for capital deductions. Currently, 9% has been applied to the Retail & Commercial divisions and 10% to Global Banking & Markets. However, these will be subject to modification as the final Basel III rules and ICB recommendations are considered.

 
21

 
 
Divisional performance (continued)

Employee numbers by division (full time equivalents in continuing operations rounded to the nearest hundred)
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
       
UK Retail
27,900 
28,100 
28,200 
UK Corporate
13,400 
13,100 
13,100 
Wealth
5,500 
5,400 
5,200 
Global Transaction Services
2,700 
2,700 
2,600 
Ulster Bank
4,300 
4,300 
4,200 
US Retail & Commercial
15,200 
15,400 
15,700 
       
Retail & Commercial
69,000 
69,000 
69,000 
Global Banking & Markets
19,000 
18,700 
18,700 
RBS Insurance
14,600 
14,900 
14,500 
Group Centre
5,100 
4,800 
4,700 
       
Core
107,700 
107,400 
106,900 
Non-Core
6,300 
6,700 
6,900 
       
 
114,000 
114,100 
113,800 
Business Services
33,500 
34,100 
34,400 
Integration
800 
300 
300 
       
Group
148,300 
148,500 
148,500 
 
 
22

 
 
UK Retail

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
1,086 
1,076 
1,001 
 
2,162 
1,934 
             
Net fees and commissions
295 
270 
280 
 
609 
553 
Other non-interest income
38 
34 
17 
 
28 
90 
             
Non-interest income
333 
304 
297 
 
637 
643 
             
Total income
1,419 
1,380 
1,298 
 
2,799 
2,577 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(218)
(215)
(230)
 
(433)
(455)
  - other
(106)
(113)
(142)
 
(219)
(275)
Indirect expenses
(364)
(350)
(375)
 
(714)
(740)
             
 
(688)
(678)
(747)
 
(1,366)
(1,470)
             
Insurance net claims
25 
 
(4)
Impairment losses
(208)
(194)
(300)
 
(402)
(687)
             
Operating profit
523 
508 
276 
 
1,031 
416 
             
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Personal advances
278 
275 
236 
 
553 
470 
Personal deposits
257 
254 
277 
 
511 
554 
Mortgages
581 
543 
478 
 
1,124 
900 
Cards
243 
238 
239 
 
481 
468 
Other, including bancassurance
60 
70 
93 
 
130 
181 
             
Total income
1,419 
1,380 
1,323 
 
2,799 
2,573 
             
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Mortgages
55 
61 
44 
 
116 
92 
Personal
106 
95 
168 
 
201 
401 
Cards
47 
38 
88 
 
85 
194 
             
Total impairment losses
208 
194 
300 
 
402 
687 
             
             
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer
  loans and advances (excluding reverse
  repurchase agreements) by sector
           
Mortgages
0.2% 
0.3% 
0.2% 
 
0.2% 
0.2% 
Personal
3.9% 
3.3% 
5.3% 
 
3.7% 
6.3% 
Cards
3.4% 
2.7% 
5.9% 
 
3.0% 
6.5% 
             
Total
0.8% 
0.7% 
1.1% 
 
0.7% 
1.3% 
 
 
23

 
 
UK Retail (continued)


Key metrics
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
27.6% 
26.2% 
14.3% 
 
26.9% 
10.7% 
Net interest margin
4.00% 
4.04% 
3.89% 
 
4.02% 
3.80% 
Cost:income ratio
48% 
49% 
58% 
 
49% 
57% 

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - mortgages
94.0 
93.0 
1% 
 
90.6 
4% 
  - personal
10.8 
11.4 
(5%)
 
11.7 
(8%)
  - cards
5.6 
5.6 
 
6.1 
(8%)
             
 
110.4 
110.0 
 
108.4 
2% 
Customer deposits (excluding bancassurance)
95.9 
96.1 
 
96.1 
Assets under management (excluding deposits)
5.8 
5.8 
 
5.7 
2% 
Risk elements in lending
4.6 
4.6 
 
4.6 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
112% 
112% 
 
110% 
200bp 
Risk-weighted assets
49.5 
50.3 
(2%)
 
48.8 
1% 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).

Key points
During Q2 2011, UK Retail continued to focus on becoming the most helpful and sustainable bank in the UK. Specifically, the division increased its online functionality and developed the first iPad Banking application by a UK high-street bank and an enhanced iPhone application based on direct customer feedback. The division also simplified the overall product offering to more effectively meet the needs of customers.

Improved customer satisfaction metrics over the first half of 2011 suggest that progress is being made, but the division recognises that there is still more to do.

UK Retail also recognises the need to support improvements in customer service with internal business improvements and, during the first half of 2011, continued with a major investment programme aimed at providing staff with the training and tools necessary to achieve the strategic goals of the division.
 
 
24

 
 
UK Retail (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Operating profit of £523 million in Q2 2011 was £15 million higher than in the previous quarter. Growth in income of 3%, £39 million was partly offset by an increase in costs of 1% (£10 million) and impairment losses of 7%, £14 million. Return on equity was 27.6% compared with 26.2% in Q1 2011.
   
·
UK Retail continued to drive growth in secured lending.
 
o    Mortgage balances increased 1% on Q1 2011. RBS’s share of gross new lending remained strong at 10% in the quarter and continues to perform above our share of stock at 8%.
 
o    Unsecured lending fell 4% in the quarter, in line with the Group’s continued focus on lower risk secured lending.
 
o    Total deposits remained flat in the quarter due to continued strong competition in the marketplace.
 
o    The loan to deposit ratio at 30 June 2011 remained flat at 112%.
   
·
Net interest income increased marginally in the quarter with slower volume growth and net interest margin declining 4 basis points to 4.00%. The overall asset margin remained stable as higher quality, lower loan to value, mortgage lending continued to increase as a proportion of total lending, curtailing further margin expansion in the quarter. The liability margin continued to contract modestly due to continued lower long-term swap rate returns on current account balances.
   
·
Non-interest income increased by 10% on Q1 2011 driven by an increase in transactional fees and investment related sales partly due to seasonal factors.
   
·
Overall expenses increased by 1%, £10 million quarter on quarter. Direct costs fell by 1%, £4 million due to reductions in fraud charges in the quarter and efficiency benefits partly offset by an annual wage award increasing staff costs. Indirect costs were up 4%, £14 million due to increased investment and the additional cost of regulatory requirements.
   
·
Impairment losses increased by 7%, £14 million during the period.
o    Mortgage impairment losses were £55 million on a total book of £94 billion, a £6 million reduction quarter on quarter. The charge included £35 million on the already defaulted book reflecting continued difficult market conditions for cash recovery, and also customer forbearance(1). Arrears rates were stable and remained below the Council of Mortgage Lenders industry average.
 
o    The unsecured portfolio impairment charge increased 15% to £153 million, on a book of £16 billion.  Underlying default levels remained broadly flat quarter on quarter; however, a provision surplus release in Q2 2011 was lower than in Q1 2011. Industry benchmarks for cards arrears remain stable, with RBS continuing to perform better than the market.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets decreased 2% in the quarter, primarily reflecting improved quality and lower volume within the unsecured portfolio partly offset by volume growth in lower risk secured mortgages.

Note:
(1)
For further details see page 139.

 
25

 
 
UK Retail (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Operating profit increased by £247 million, with income up 9%, costs down 8% and impairments 31% lower than in Q2 2010.
   
·
Net interest income was 8% higher than Q2 2010, with strong mortgage balance growth and recovering asset margins across all products, partially offset by continued competitive pressure on liability margins.
   
·
Costs were 8% lower than in Q2 2010 due to continued implementation of process efficiencies throughout the branch network and operational centres. The cost:income ratio improved from 58% to 48%.
   
·
Impairment losses decreased by 31% on Q2 2010, primarily reflecting the impact of risk appetite tightening and unsecured book contraction as well as a more stable economic environment.
   
·
Savings balances were up 10% on Q2 2010, outperforming the market which remains highly competitive.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Net interest income was 12% higher, with net interest margin increasing by 22 basis points. This was driven by stronger asset margins seen across all products. Liability margins, however, fell as a result of a competitive marketplace, a decline in long-term swap rates and a focus on savings balance growth.
   
·
Total customer lending grew 4% from H1 2010 with mortgage balances increasing 8%, whilst unsecured balances reduced 13%. Deposit balances grew 7% with savings deposits up 10%.
   
·
Costs decreased by 7%, with the majority of savings coming from a reduction in direct costs as a result of operational efficiencies.
   
·
Impairment losses fell 41% in H1 2011, again reflecting the impact of risk appetite tightening and a more stable economic environment.

 
26

 
 
UK Corporate

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
641 
689 
647 
 
1,330 
1,257 
             
Net fees and commissions
231 
244 
233 
 
475 
457 
Other non-interest income
94 
88 
107 
 
182 
212 
             
Non-interest income
325 
332 
340 
 
657 
669 
             
Total income
966 
1,021 
987 
 
1,987 
1,926 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(199)
(202)
(189)
 
(401)
(394)
  - other
(71)
(90)
(82)
 
(161)
(185)
Indirect expenses
(133)
(131)
(128)
 
(264)
(255)
             
 
(403)
(423)
(399)
 
(826)
(834)
             
Impairment losses
(218)
(105)
(198)
 
(323)
(384)
             
Operating profit
345 
493 
390 
 
838 
708 
             
             
Analysis of income by business
           
Corporate and commercial lending
666 
729 
660 
 
1,395 
1,290 
Asset and invoice finance
163 
152 
154 
 
315 
288 
Corporate deposits
171 
170 
185 
 
341 
361 
Other
(34)
(30)
(12)
 
(64)
(13)
             
Total income
966 
1,021 
987 
 
1,987 
1,926 
             
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Banks and financial institutions
13 
(9)
 
16 
(7)
Hotels and restaurants
13 
12 
 
21 
28 
Housebuilding and construction
15 
32 
 
47 
22 
Manufacturing
 
12 
Other
89 
83 
 
90 
120 
Private sector education, health, social work,
  recreational and community services
11 
 
12 
Property
51 
18 
61 
 
69 
127 
Wholesale and retail trade, repairs
16 
16 
28 
 
32 
46 
Asset and invoice finance
14 
10 
13 
 
24 
32 
             
Total impairment losses
218 
105 
198 
 
323 
384 
 
 
27

 
 
UK Corporate (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross
  customer loans and advances (excluding
  reverse repurchase agreements) by sector
           
Banks and financial institutions
0.9% 
0.2% 
(0.6%)
 
0.5% 
(0.2%)
Hotels and restaurants
0.8% 
0.5% 
0.7% 
 
0.6% 
0.8% 
Housebuilding and construction
1.4% 
2.8% 
0.7% 
 
2.2% 
0.9% 
Manufacturing
0.5% 
0.5% 
0.1% 
 
0.5% 
0.3% 
Other
1.1% 
1.0% 
 
0.6% 
0.7% 
Private sector education, health, social work,
  recreational and community services
0.5% 
0.2% 
 
0.3% 
0.2% 
Property
0.7% 
0.2% 
0.8% 
 
0.5% 
0.8% 
Wholesale and retail trade, repairs
0.7% 
0.7% 
1.1% 
 
0.7% 
0.9% 
Asset and invoice finance
0.6% 
0.4% 
0.6% 
 
0.5% 
0.7% 
             
Total
0.8% 
0.4% 
0.7% 
 
0.6% 
0.7% 

Key metrics
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
12.3% 
15.8% 
12.5% 
 
14.0% 
11.2% 
Net interest margin
2.55% 
2.73% 
2.51% 
 
2.64% 
2.46% 
Cost:income ratio
42% 
41% 
40% 
 
42% 
43% 

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
113.6 
115.0 
(1%)
 
114.6 
(1%)
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - banks and financial institutions
5.9 
6.0 
(2%)
 
6.1 
(3%)
  - hotels and restaurants
6.5 
6.7 
(3%)
 
6.8 
(4%)
  - housebuilding and construction
4.2 
4.5 
(7%)
 
4.5 
(7%)
  - manufacturing
4.9 
5.1 
(4%)
 
5.3 
(8%)
  - other
32.2 
31.8 
1% 
 
31.0 
4% 
  - private sector education, health, social
    work, recreational and community services
8.8 
8.9 
(1%)
 
9.0 
(2%)
  - property
29.2 
30.2 
(3%)
 
29.5 
(1%)
  - wholesale and retail trade, repairs
9.2 
9.5 
(3%)
 
9.6 
(4%)
  - asset and invoice finance
9.9 
9.8 
1% 
 
9.9 
             
 
110.8 
112.5 
(2%)
 
111.7 
(1%)
             
Customer deposits
99.5 
100.6 
(1%)
 
100.0 
(1%)
Risk elements in lending
4.8 
4.6 
4% 
 
4.0 
20% 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
109% 
110% 
(100bp)
 
110% 
(100bp)
Risk-weighted assets
77.9 
79.3 
(2%)
 
81.4 
(4%)

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax, divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
 
 
28

 
 
UK Corporate (continued)

Key points
UK Corporate continues to improve the ways it adds value for its customers, while building solid business foundations for sustainable growth.

Q2 2011 saw the launch of ‘Ahead for Business’, underpinning the division’s SME customer promise: “by doing business with us our customers can be confident that they can realise their ambitions”.

Specific activities supporting the delivery of the initiative include all SME relationship managers (RMs) undergoing formal accreditation to enable them to better support the division’s customers.  RMs will also spend two days a year working in SME customers’ businesses, amounting to over 5,000 visits this year.

In addition, UK Corporate reinforced the ‘open for business’ message through the launch of a number of lending initiatives, including the Franchise Fund and the Renewable Energy Fund.

The division’s launch of propositions tailored to the needs of specific customer groups continues to deliver success in start-ups, with over 50,000 new start-ups added as customers in H1 2011, and in businesses run by women. In addition, the recently launched partnership with Smarta means customers can now access a suite of business tools at low or no cost.

Furthermore, UK Corporate’s expanded investment programme is focused on strengthening the business overall while also delivering tangible benefits to its customers. For example, the recent launch of automatic credit decisioning strengthens risk disciplines and shortens the time it takes to make lending decisions.

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Operating profit of £345 million was 30% lower, predominantly driven by the one-off favourable impact of the revision of deferred fee income recognition assumptions in Q1 2011 (£50 million) and the release of latent provisions of £108 million in the same period.
   
·
Net interest income fell by 7%, significantly impacted by the revision of income deferral assumptions in Q1 2011, leading to a reduction in net interest margin of 18 basis points.  Adjusting for the impact of this change in assumptions in Q1 2011, lending income in Q2 2011 increased 1% while net interest margin improved by 1 basis point.
 
 
·
Non-interest income declined 2% with increased operating lease activity and profit on sale of assets partially offsetting lower Global Banking & Markets revenue share income.
   
·
Total costs decreased 5% primarily driven by a successful recovery of an operating loss exposure provided for in Q1 2011.
   
·
Impairments increased £113 million as a result of lower releases of latent provisions and higher specific impairments, albeit limited to a small number of exposures.
 
 
29

 
 
UK Corporate (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Operating profit decreased 12% to £345 million, with improved lending margins offset by higher funding costs and impairments.
   
·
Net interest income remained broadly in line with Q2 2010, whilst the net interest margin increased 4 basis points as a result of re-pricing of the loan portfolio. The net funding position improved £8 billion, reflecting successful deposit-gathering initiatives. 
 
 
·
Non-interest income decreased by £15 million, reflecting lower GBM revenue share income partially offset by asset disposal gains.
   
·
Impairments increased £20 million, reflecting higher specific impairments partially offset by an improvement in collectively assessed balances.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Operating profit increased by £130 million, 18%, driven by re-pricing of the lending portfolio, revised deferred income recognition and lower impairments partially offset by higher costs of funding.
   
·
Excluding the deferred fee impact of £50 million recognised in H1 2011, net interest income increased £23 million and net interest margin improved 7 basis points with gains from re-pricing only partially offset by deposit margin pressure. The loan to deposit ratio improved from 119% to 109% due to strong growth in customer deposits.
   
·
Non-interest income decreased by 2%. Investment disposal gains and increased operating lease activity were offset by lower GBM revenue share income.
   
·
Total costs decreased £8 million, 1%, but increased 3% excluding the £29 million OFT penalty in Q1 2010, reflecting the investment in strategic initiatives and increased operating lease activity in H1 2011.
   
·
Impairments of £323 million were 16% lower than H1 2010, the result of improved book quality and credit metrics slightly offset by a small number of specific provisions.
 
 
30

 
 
Wealth

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
182 
167 
150 
 
349 
293 
             
Net fees and commissions
94 
97 
97 
 
191 
192 
Other non-interest income
21 
17 
19 
 
38 
36 
             
Non-interest income
115 
114 
116 
 
229 
228 
             
Total income
297 
281 
266 
 
578 
521 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(111)
(100)
(92)
 
(211)
(191)
  - other
(51)
(44)
(39)
 
(95)
(74)
Indirect expenses
(58)
(52)
(47)
 
(110)
(102)
             
 
(220)
(196)
(178)
 
(416)
(367)
             
Impairment losses
(3)
(5)
(7)
 
(8)
(11)
             
Operating profit
74 
80 
81 
 
154 
143 
             
Analysis of income
           
Private banking
245 
231 
216 
 
476 
420 
Investments
52 
50 
50 
 
102 
101 
             
Total income
297 
281 
266 
 
578 
521 

Key metrics
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
17.4% 
19.0% 
20.1% 
 
18.2% 
18.1% 
Net interest margin
3.61% 
3.45% 
3.37% 
 
3.53% 
3.40% 
Cost:income ratio
74% 
70% 
67% 
 
72% 
70% 

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - mortgages
8.2 
7.8 
5% 
 
7.8 
5% 
  - personal
7.0 
7.0 
 
6.7 
4% 
  - other
1.6 
1.7 
(6%)
 
1.6 
             
 
16.8 
16.5 
2% 
 
16.1 
4% 
Customer deposits
37.3 
37.5 
(1%)
 
36.4 
2% 
Assets under management (excluding deposits)
34.3 
34.4 
 
32.1 
7% 
Risk elements in lending
0.2 
0.2 
 
0.2 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
45% 
44% 
100bp 
 
44% 
100bp 
Risk-weighted assets
12.9 
12.6 
2% 
 
12.5 
3% 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
 
 
31

 
 
Wealth (continued)

Key points
Following the Q1 2011 announcement of a new set of goals and strategic plans, Wealth advanced the execution of these plans during the second quarter with significant changes implemented.

The global market footprint has been adjusted to increase focus on territories where Wealth has scale or the opportunity for strategic future growth while, in the UK, the business has focused on ensuring services provided more closely meet the specific needs of different client groups and remain of a consistently high quality. On the product side new product propositions are being developed to meet the needs of UK and international clients with more sophisticated investment and credit requirements. Internally, Wealth continues with a programme to develop talent at all levels of the organisation. The division is also putting in place a launch plan to bring the Coutts business in the UK, and RBS Coutts,  under one global ‘Coutts’ brand.

The division is increasing its focus on technology innovation, with implementation of a new IT platform in the UK continuing. The business is exploring additional opportunities to bring new innovation to the client interface with a view to improving the client experience, enhance the interaction between clients and the bank and provide advisers with improved ability to collaborate and serve client needs.

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Operating profit in the second quarter declined £6 million on the prior quarter as good income growth was more than offset by an increase in expenses, largely reflecting the continued investment programme within the division.
   
·
Income increased £16 million quarter on quarter with a 9% rise in net interest income. There was significant growth in treasury income and lending margins continued their upward trajectory with a further 6 basis point improvement. Deposit margins made a slight recovery and average deposit balances grew by 3%. These contributed to a 16 basis point increase in net interest margin.
   
·
Expenses increased 12% to £220 million, primarily driven by continued investment in strategic initiatives, including technology development and implementation, as well as by investment in regulatory programmes and further recruitment of private bankers.
   
·
Lending volumes maintained impetus with a 2% growth in loans. Assets under management were stable quarter on quarter as 2% growth in net new business was offset by adverse market and foreign exchange movements. Deposits were also stable quarter on quarter although average balances were higher.

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Q2 2011 operating profit declined 9% on prior year to £74 million.  An increase in expenses was only partially offset by increased income and a reduction in impairments.
   
·
Income increased by £31 million, with a 24 basis point improvement in net interest margin. Lending volumes and margins continued to grow whilst deposit margin compression was offset by a 3% growth in deposit volumes and increased internal reward for the divisional funding surplus.
   
·
Expenses rose £42 million with a 10% increase in headcount reflecting continued recruitment following previous private banker attrition and significant investment in strategic initiatives. Changes in the phasing of bonus expense accounted for £7 million of the increase in the expense base.

 
32

 
 
Wealth (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010 (continued)
·
Client assets and liabilities managed by the division increased by 9%. The division has managed to significantly increase assets under management with balances, adjusted for definitional changes, growing 8%.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
H1 2011 operating profit of £154 million increased 8% on H1 2010 reflecting strong growth in client assets and liabilities managed by the division and improved net interest margin.
   
·
Income, at £578 million, was 11% higher, reflecting strong growth in treasury income and sustained improvements in lending margin and volume.
   
·
Expenses increased by £49 million to £416 million reflecting additional strategic investment and headcount growth to service the increased revenue base.
   
·
Lending volumes maintained strong growth momentum and the deposit base increased despite the continued competitive markets for deposits.
 
 
33

 
 
Global Transaction Services

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
263 
260 
237 
 
523 
454 
Non-interest income
297 
282 
411 
 
579 
801 
             
Total income
560 
542 
648 
 
1,102 
1,255 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(95)
(96)
(102)
 
(191)
(206)
  - other
(32)
(29)
(37)
 
(61)
(70)
Indirect expenses
(215)
(210)
(227)
 
(425)
(464)
             
 
(342)
(335)
(366)
 
(677)
(740)
             
Impairment losses
(54)
(20)
(3)
 
(74)
(3)
             
Operating profit
164 
187 
279 
 
351 
512 
             
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Domestic cash management
217 
212 
201 
 
429 
395 
International cash management
215 
211 
193 
 
426 
378 
Trade finance
78 
73 
76 
 
151 
147 
Merchant acquiring
133 
 
248 
Commercial cards
46 
43 
45 
 
89 
87 
             
Total income
560 
542 
648 
 
1,102 
1,255 

Key metrics
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
27.0% 
30.8% 
45.0% 
 
28.9% 
40.3% 
Net interest margin
5.63% 
5.91% 
6.49% 
 
5.77% 
7.16% 
Cost:income ratio
61% 
62% 
56% 
 
61% 
59% 

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
30.2 
27.1 
11% 
 
25.2 
20% 
Loans and advances
19.2 
17.2 
12% 
 
14.4 
33% 
Customer deposits
73.3 
69.3 
6% 
 
69.9 
5% 
Risk elements in lending
0.3 
0.2 
50% 
 
0.1 
200% 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
26% 
25% 
100bp 
 
21% 
500bp 
Risk-weighted assets
18.8 
18.2 
3% 
 
18.3 
3% 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).

 
34

 
 
Global Transaction Services (continued)

Key points
Global Transaction Services (GTS) maintained momentum during Q2 2011 delivering a strong deposit gathering performance and growth across all product areas, demonstrating the division’s commitment to deliver working capital solutions for customers.
 
Building on the successes of the first quarter, GTS has enhanced its online trade capability MaxTrad to streamline workflows and simplify the process for clients. The ongoing support to UK companies, helping them to trade internationally, has been enhanced through the launch of a new international website and participation in UK Government-backed joint initiatives.
 
Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Operating profit decreased 12%, driven by a single name impairment provision recognised in Q2 2011.
   
·
Income increased by 3% with good performance across all product lines.
   
·
Expenses increased by 2%, largely due to investment in technology and support infrastructure.
   
·
Q2 2011 impairment losses of £54 million largely related to a single provision.
   
·
Third party assets increased by £3.1 billion, driven mainly by strong growth in trade financing combined with an uplift in short-term international cash management overdrafts.

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Operating profit fell 41%, in part reflecting the sale of Global Merchant Services (GMS), which completed on 30 November 2010. Adjusting for the disposal operating profit decreased 24%, driven by a single name provision recognised in Q2 2011.
   
·
Excluding GMS (£130 million), income increased by 8% supported by the strengthening of deposit gathering initiatives.
   
·
Customer deposits increased by 17% to £73.3 billion reflecting strong deposit volumes in domestic and international cash management, despite a challenging competitive environment.
   
·
Third party assets increased by £5 billion due to strong growth in trade financing.
   
·
During Q2 2010, GMS recorded income of £130 million, total expenses of £66 million and an operating profit of £64 million.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Operating profit decreased 31%, primarily due to the sale of GMS in November 2010. Adjusting for the disposal operating profit fell 12% driven by a single name provision recognised in H1 2011.
   
·
Excluding GMS (£243 million), income was up 9% reflecting strong deposit volumes in domestic and international cash management together with an improved performance in trade and commercial cards.
   
·
Excluding GMS (£128 million), expenses increased by 11%, due to business improvement initiatives and investment in technology and support infrastructure.
   
·
During H1 2010, GMS recorded income of £243 million, total expenses of £128 million and an operating profit of £115 million.

 
35

 
 
Ulster Bank

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
171 
169 
194 
 
340 
382 
             
Net fees and commissions
37 
36 
43 
 
73 
78 
Other non-interest income
14 
15 
10 
 
29 
28 
             
Non-interest income
51 
51 
53 
 
102 
106 
             
Total income
222 
220 
247 
 
442 
488 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(57)
(56)
(60)
 
(113)
(126)
  - other
(17)
(18)
(20)
 
(35)
(39)
Indirect expenses
(68)
(62)
(63)
 
(130)
(138)
             
 
(142)
(136)
(143)
 
(278)
(303)
             
Impairment losses
(269)
(461)
(281)
 
(730)
(499)
             
Operating loss
(189)
(377)
(177)
 
(566)
(314)
             
             
Analysis of income by business
           
Corporate
117 
113 
134 
 
230 
279 
Retail
98 
113 
105 
 
211 
217 
Other
(6)
 
(8)
             
Total income
222 
220 
247 
 
442 
488 
             
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Mortgages
78 
233 
33 
 
311 
66 
Corporate
           
  - property
66 
97 
117 
 
163 
199 
  - other corporate
103 
120 
118 
 
223 
209 
Other lending
22 
11 
13 
 
33 
25 
             
Total impairment losses
269 
461 
281 
 
730 
499 
             
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer
  loans and advances (excluding reverse
  repurchase agreements) by sector
           
Mortgages
1.4% 
4.3% 
0.9% 
 
2.9% 
0.9% 
Corporate
           
  - property
5.0% 
7.2% 
4.9% 
 
6.2% 
4.2% 
  - other corporate
4.7% 
5.5% 
4.8% 
 
5.1% 
4.2% 
Other lending
5.5% 
2.8% 
2.7% 
 
4.1% 
2.6% 
             
Total
2.9% 
5.0% 
3.1% 
 
3.9% 
2.8% 
 
 
36

 
 
Ulster Bank (continued)

Key metrics
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
(19.7%)
(41.9%)
(19.3%)
 
(30.5%)
(17.1%)
Net interest margin
1.69% 
1.72% 
1.92% 
 
1.71% 
1.86% 
Cost:income ratio
64% 
62% 
58% 
 
63% 
62% 

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - mortgages
21.8 
21.5 
1% 
 
21.2 
3% 
  - corporate
           
     - property
5.3 
5.4 
(2%)
 
5.4 
(2%)
     - other corporate
8.7 
8.8 
(1%)
 
9.0 
(3%)
  - other lending
1.6 
1.5 
7% 
 
1.3 
23% 
             
 
37.4 
37.2 
1% 
 
36.9 
1% 
Customer deposits
24.3 
23.8 
2% 
 
23.1 
5% 
Risk elements in lending
           
  - mortgages
2.0 
1.8 
11% 
 
1.5 
33% 
  - corporate
           
     - property
1.1 
1.0 
10% 
 
0.7 
57% 
     - other corporate
1.8 
1.6 
13% 
 
1.2 
50% 
  - other lending
0.2 
0.2 
 
0.2 
             
 
5.1 
4.6 
11% 
 
3.6 
42% 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
144% 
147% 
(300bp)
 
152% 
(800bp)
Risk-weighted assets
36.3 
31.7 
15% 
 
31.6 
15% 
             
Spot exchange rate - €/£
1.106 
1.131 
   
1.160 
 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating loss after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).

Key points
Macroeconomic conditions continue to be the key driver of Ulster Bank’s results. However, further progress is being made on economic, political and regulatory reform in the Republic of Ireland and recent trends suggest a more positive medium-term outlook, although key risks remain.

Ulster Bank continues to focus on the long-term recovery of the business. Deposit gathering, management of the cost base and capitalising on emerging market opportunities all remain priorities. Ulster Bank has also recently published the first, independently assured, report on progress made in achieving its Customer Commitments. Good progress has been made so far, with work ongoing to address areas that need further improvement.
 
 
37

 
 
Ulster Bank (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Operating loss of £189 million in Q2 2011 decreased by £188 million compared with Q1 2011, primarily driven by a reduction in impairment losses.
   
·
Net interest income increased by 1%, largely due to the income drag of the impaired loan book, offset by movements in exchange rates. Net interest margin fell by 3 basis points to 1.69%.
   
·
Loans and advances to customers increased by 1% due to continued amortisation, offset by movements in exchange rates. Customer deposits remained largely stable despite challenging market conditions, reflecting the continued uncertainty around the Republic of Ireland’s sovereign debt position.
   
·
Expenses increased by 4% in the quarter, largely reflecting a write-down in the value of own property assets.
   
·
Impairment losses for Q2 2011 of £269 million were £192 million lower than Q1 2011, which included an adjustment in respect of recalibration of credit metrics in relation to the mortgage portfolio. However, credit conditions in Ireland will remain challenging with continued downward pressure on asset values coupled with rising interest rates maintaining pressure on borrowers.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets increased by £4.6 billion, reflecting the continued weak credit environment and resultant impact on credit risk metrics.

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Net interest income fell by 12%, reflecting higher funding costs, partly offset by loan repricing initiatives. Non interest income fell by 4% largely reflecting the loss of income from the merchant services business, disposed of in Q4 2010.
   
·
Loans to customers increased by 3%, reflecting subdued demand for new business, offset by movements in exchange rates. Customer deposits were flat over the period with strong growth in core franchise deposits offset by lower wholesale balances.
   
·
Expenses were broadly flat over the period, as expense reductions over the period largely offset the property write-down in Q2 2011.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets increased by £5.8 billion driven by worsened portfolio risk metrics.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Operating loss of £566 million was £252 million higher than H1 2010, largely driven by an increase in impairment losses reflecting the deterioration in customer credit quality.
   
·
Total income fell by 9%, reflecting higher funding costs and the high cost of deposit gathering.
   
·
Expenses decreased by 8% due to active management of the cost base with a focus on reducing discretionary expenditure.

 
38

 
 
US Retail & Commercial (£ Sterling)

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
469 
451 
502 
 
920 
970 
             
Net fees and commissions
185 
170 
203 
 
355 
380 
Other non-interest income
61 
73 
72 
 
134 
147 
             
Non-interest income
246 
243 
275 
 
489 
527 
             
Total income
715 
694 
777 
 
1,409 
1,497 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(205)
(197)
(151)
 
(402)
(366)
  - other
(135)
(124)
(163)
 
(259)
(297)
Indirect expenses
(182)
(183)
(190)
 
(365)
(378)
             
 
(522)
(504)
(504)
 
(1,026)
(1,041)
             
Impairment losses
(66)
(110)
(144)
 
(176)
(287)
             
Operating profit
127 
80 
129 
 
207 
169 
             
             
Average exchange rate - US$/£
1.631 
1.601 
1.492 
 
1.616 
1.525 
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Mortgages and home equity
108 
109 
124 
 
217 
239 
Personal lending and cards
108 
107 
122 
 
215 
236 
Retail deposits
231 
216 
248 
 
447 
474 
Commercial lending
147 
137 
152 
 
284 
294 
Commercial deposits
72 
69 
86 
 
141 
167 
Other
49 
56 
45 
 
105 
87 
             
Total income
715 
694 
777 
 
1,409 
1,497 
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Residential mortgages
13 
22 
 
19 
41 
Home equity
11 
40 
38 
 
51 
44 
Corporate and commercial
22 
17 
76 
 
39 
125 
Other consumer
20 
 
29 
63 
Securities
11 
27 
 
38 
14 
             
Total impairment losses
66 
110 
144 
 
176 
287 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer
  loans and advances (excluding reverse
  repurchase agreements) by sector
           
Residential mortgages
0.9% 
0.4% 
1.3% 
 
0.7% 
1.2% 
Home equity
0.3% 
1.1% 
0.9% 
 
0.7% 
0.5% 
Corporate and commercial
0.4% 
0.3% 
1.5% 
 
0.4% 
1.2% 
Other consumer
0.6% 
1.3% 
0.3% 
 
0.9% 
1.6% 
             
Total
0.5% 
0.7% 
1.1% 
 
0.6% 
1.1% 
 
 
39

 
 
US Retail & Commercial (£ Sterling) (continued)

Key metrics
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
6.8% 
4.4% 
5.7% 
 
5.6% 
3.8% 
Net interest margin
3.11% 
3.01% 
2.79% 
 
3.06% 
2.76% 
Cost:income ratio
73% 
72% 
65% 
 
73% 
69% 


 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
70.9 
70.6 
 
71.2 
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - residential mortgages
5.7 
5.6 
2% 
 
6.1 
(7%)
  - home equity
14.6 
14.7 
(1%)
 
15.2 
(4%)
  - corporate and commercial
21.3 
20.2 
5% 
 
20.4 
4% 
  - other consumer
6.3 
6.4 
(2%)
 
6.9 
(9%)
 
47.9 
46.9 
2% 
 
48.6 
(1%)
Customer deposits (excluding repos)
56.5 
56.7 
 
58.7 
(4%)
Risk elements in lending
           
  - retail
0.5 
0.5 
 
0.4 
25% 
  - commercial
0.4 
0.5 
(20%)
 
0.5 
(20%)
             
 
0.9 
1.0 
(10%)
 
0.9 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
83% 
81% 
200bp 
 
81% 
200bp 
Risk-weighted assets
54.8 
53.6 
2% 
 
57.0 
(4%)
             
Spot exchange rate - US$/£
1.607 
1.605 
   
1.552 
 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
 
Key points
·
Sterling strengthened relative to the US dollar during the second quarter, with the average exchange rate increasing by 2% compared with Q1 2011.
   
·
Performance is described in full in the US dollar-based financial statements set out on pages 41 to 42.
 
 
40

 
 
US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar)

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
$m 
$m 
$m 
 
$m 
$m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
764 
723 
748 
 
1,487 
1,478 
             
Net fees and commissions
301 
273 
303 
 
574 
579 
Other non-interest income
100 
116 
110 
 
216 
226 
             
Non-interest income
401 
389 
413 
 
790 
805 
             
Total income
1,165 
1,112 
1,161 
 
2,277 
2,283 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(335)
(315)
(223)
 
(650)
(558)
  - other
(220)
(198)
(246)
 
(418)
(453)
Indirect expenses
(297)
(293)
(283)
 
(590)
(576)
             
 
(852)
(806)
(752)
 
(1,658)
(1,587)
             
Impairment losses
(107)
(177)
(214)
 
(284)
(438)
             
Operating profit
206 
129 
195 
 
335 
258 
             
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Mortgages and home equity
175 
175 
185 
 
350 
365 
Personal lending and cards
176 
171 
182 
 
347 
360 
Retail deposits
377 
346 
372 
 
723 
723 
Commercial lending
240 
219 
226 
 
459 
448 
Commercial deposits
118 
110 
128 
 
228 
254 
Other
79 
91 
68 
 
170 
133 
             
Total income
1,165 
1,112 
1,161 
 
2,277 
2,283 
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Residential mortgages
21 
33 
 
30 
63 
Home equity
19 
64 
56 
 
83 
66 
Corporate and commercial
35 
28 
113 
 
63 
190 
Other consumer
16 
33 
10 
 
49 
97 
Securities
16 
43 
 
59 
22 
             
Total impairment losses
107 
177 
214 
 
284 
438 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer
  loans and advances (excluding reverse
  repurchase agreements) by sector
           
Residential mortgages
0.9% 
0.4% 
1.3% 
 
0.7% 
1.3% 
Home equity
0.3% 
1.1% 
0.9% 
 
0.7% 
0.5% 
Corporate and commercial
0.4% 
0.3% 
1.5% 
 
0.4% 
1.2% 
Other consumer
0.6% 
1.3% 
0.3% 
 
1.0% 
1.6% 
             
Total
0.5% 
0.7% 
1.1% 
 
0.6% 
1.1% 
 
 
41

 
 
US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar) (continued)

Key metrics
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
6.8% 
4.4% 
5.7% 
 
5.6% 
3.8% 
Net interest margin
3.11% 
3.01% 
2.79% 
 
3.06% 
2.76% 
Cost:income ratio
73% 
72% 
65% 
 
73% 
69% 

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
$bn 
$bn 
Change 
 
$bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
113.9 
113.2 
1% 
 
110.5 
3% 
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - residential mortgages
9.2 
9.1 
1% 
 
9.4 
(2%)
  - home equity
23.5 
23.6 
 
23.6 
  - corporate and commercial
34.0 
32.2 
6% 
 
31.7 
7% 
  - other consumer
10.2 
10.3 
(1%)
 
10.6 
(4%)
             
 
76.9 
75.2 
2% 
 
75.3 
2% 
Customer deposits (excluding repos)
90.7 
91.0 
 
91.2 
(1%)
Risk elements in lending
           
  - retail
0.9 
0.8 
13% 
 
0.7 
29% 
  - commercial
0.6 
0.8 
(25%)
 
0.7 
(14%)
             
 
1.5 
1.6 
(6%)
 
1.4 
7% 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
83% 
81% 
200bp 
 
81% 
200bp 
Risk-weighted assets
88.1 
86.0 
2% 
 
88.4 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).

Key points
US Retail & Commercial continued to focus on its “back-to-basics” strategy, with good progress made in developing the division’s customer franchise over the first half of 2011. 

Consumer customer satisfaction improved significantly in Q2 2011, approaching the highest level in 24 months, and comparing well to the competitor average which declined in the same period.

US Retail & Commercial continued to re-energise the franchise through new branding, product development and competitive pricing.

Consumer Finance has continued to strengthen its alignment with branch banking, further increasing the penetration of products to deposit households.  Consumer Finance has also launched a new branded programme targeting residential lending.

The Commercial Banking business has also achieved good momentum through a refreshed sales training programme, improved product offering and further improvements in the cross-sell of Global Transaction Services (GTS) products to its customer base.

 
42

 
 
US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar) (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
US Retail & Commercial posted an operating profit of £127 million ($206 million) compared with £80 million ($129 million) in the prior quarter, an increase of £47 million ($77 million), or 59%. The Q2 2011 operating environment remained challenging, with low absolute interest rates, high but stable unemployment, a soft housing market and the continuing impact of legislative changes.
   
·
Net interest income was up £18 million ($41 million), or 4%, and net interest margin increased by 10 basis points to 3.11%. The improvement was driven by the purchase of higher yielding securities, lower cost of funds and higher commercial loan volumes.  Loans and advances were up from the previous quarter due to strong growth in commercial loan volumes partly offset by some continued planned run-off of long-term fixed rate consumer products.
   
·
Non-interest income was up £3 million ($12 million), or 1%, reflecting higher deposit fees and ATM/debit card fees, as a result of new pricing initiatives, and an increase in commercial banking fee income partially offset by lower securities gains.
   
·
Total expenses were up £18 million ($46 million), or 4%, driven by changes in the phasing of bonus expense, mortgage servicing rights impairment and costs related to the implementation of regulatory changes.
   
·
Impairment losses were down £44 million ($70 million), or 40%, reflecting improved credit conditions across the loan portfolio and lower impairments related to securities.  Loan impairments as a percentage of loans and advances improved to 0.5% from 0.7% in the quarter.

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Operating profit fell to £127 million ($206 million) from £129 million ($195 million), a decrease of £2 million (increase of $11 million, due to movements in exchange rates), or 2%.  Excluding a £74 million ($113 million) credit related to changes to the defined benefit pension plan in Q2 2010, operating profit was up £72 million ($124 million), or 56%, substantially driven by lower impairments.
   
·
Net interest income was down £33 million (up $16 million due to movements in exchange rates), or 7%, on an average balance sheet that was £12 billion ($9 billion smaller).  Net interest margin improved by 32 basis points to 3.11% reflecting changes in deposit mix and continued discipline around deposit pricing as well as the positive impact of the balance sheet restructuring programme carried out during Q3 2010 combined with strong commercial loan growth.
   
·
Customer deposits were down £6 billion ($3 billion), or 9%, reflecting the impact of a changed pricing strategy on low margin term and time products offset by strong checking balance growth.  Consumer checking balances grew by 5% while small business checking balances grew by 8% over the year.
   
·
Non-interest income was down £29 million ($12 million), or 11%, reflecting lower deposit fees as a result of Regulation E legislative changes and lower mortgage banking income partially offset by higher commercial banking fee income.
   
·
Total expenses were lower by £56 million ($13 million), or 10%, excluding the defined benefit plan credit booked in Q2 2010, primarily reflecting lower Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) deposit insurance levies.
   
·
Impairment losses declined by £78 million ($107 million), or 54%, reflecting an improved credit environment partially offset by higher impairments related to securities. Loan impairments as a percent of loans and advances improved to 0.5% from 1.1%.

 
43

 
 
US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar) (continued)

Key points (continued)

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Operating profit of £207 million ($335 million) was up £38 million ($77 million), or 22%, from H1 2010. Excluding a £74 million ($113 million) credit related to changes to the defined benefit plan in Q2 2010, operating profit was up £ 112 million ($190 million), or 118%, largely reflecting an improved credit environment. Income and impairment loss drivers are consistent with Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010.
   
·
Excluding the defined benefit plan credit booked in Q2 2010, total expenses were down £89 million ($42 million), or 8%, due to changes in the phasing of bonus expense and lower FDIC deposit insurance levies.
 
 
44

 
 
Global Banking & Markets

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income from banking activities
175 
190 
329 
 
365 
711 
Funding costs of rental assets
(11)
(10)
(9)
 
(21)
(18)
             
Net interest income
164 
180 
320 
 
344 
693 
             
Net fees and commissions receivable
301 
338 
262 
 
639 
548 
Income from trading activities
891 
1,558 
1,517 
 
2,449 
3,527 
Other operating income
194 
304 
(152)
 
498 
             
Non-interest income
1,386 
2,200 
1,627 
 
3,586 
4,078 
             
Total income
1,550 
2,380 
1,947 
 
3,930 
4,771 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(605)
(863)
(631)
 
(1,468)
(1,518)
  - other
(229)
(216)
(200)
 
(445)
(384)
Indirect expenses
(233)
(227)
(202)
 
(460)
(425)
             
 
(1,067)
(1,306)
(1,033)
 
(2,373)
(2,327)
             
Impairment losses
(37)
24 
(164)
 
(13)
(196)
             
Operating profit
446 
1,098 
750 
 
1,544 
2,248 
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Rates - money markets
(41)
(74)
 
(115)
92 
Rates - flow
357 
733 
471 
 
1,090 
1,170 
Currencies
234 
224 
179 
 
458 
474 
Credit and mortgage markets
437 
885 
474 
 
1,322 
1,433 
             
Fixed income & currencies
987 
1,768 
1,128 
 
2,755 
3,169 
Portfolio management and origination
329 
337 
581 
 
666 
1,050 
Equities
234 
275 
238 
 
509 
552 
             
Total income
1,550 
2,380 
1,947 
 
3,930 
4,771 
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Manufacturing and infrastructure
45 
32 
(12)
 
77 
(19)
Property and construction
56 
 
64 
Banks and financial institutions
(23)
110 
 
(21)
126 
Other
(10)
(39)
10 
 
(49)
25 
             
Total impairment losses
37 
(24)
164 
 
13 
196 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross
  customer loans and advances (excluding
  reverse repurchase agreements)
0.2% 
(0.1%)
0.7% 
 
0.4% 
 
 
45

 
 
Global Banking & Markets (continued)

Key metrics
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
8.7% 
20.8% 
14.8% 
 
14.8% 
22.5% 
Net interest margin
0.70% 
0.76% 
1.01% 
 
0.73% 
1.07% 
Cost:income ratio
69% 
55% 
53% 
 
60% 
49% 
Compensation ratio (2)
39% 
36% 
32% 
 
37% 
32% 


 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers
71.2 
70.1 
2% 
 
75.1 
(5%)
Loans and advances to banks
38.6 
46.2 
(16%)
 
44.5 
(13%)
Reverse repos
97.5 
105.1 
(7%)
 
94.8 
3% 
Securities
141.5 
132.2 
7% 
 
119.2 
19% 
Cash and eligible bills
32.8 
33.9 
(3%)
 
38.8 
(15%)
Other
37.5 
35.8 
5% 
 
24.3 
54% 
             
Total third party assets (excluding derivatives
  mark-to-market)
419.1 
423.3 
(1%)
 
396.7 
6% 
Net derivative assets (after netting)
32.2 
34.5 
(7%)
 
37.4 
(14%)
Customer deposits (excluding repos)
35.7 
36.6 
(2%)
 
38.9 
(8%)
Risk elements in lending
1.5 
1.8 
(17%)
 
1.7 
(12%)
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
200% 
191% 
900bp 
 
193% 
700bp 
Risk-weighted assets
139.0 
146.5 
(5%)
 
146.9 
(5%)

Notes:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 10% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
   
(2)
Compensation ratio is based on staff costs as a percentage of total income.

Key points
The uncertain economic environment continued to dampen client activity within Global Banking & Markets (GBM). Weak investor confidence, seen late in Q1 2011, continued into Q2 2011 as European sovereign debt concerns and expectations of weaker global economic growth undermined risk appetite.

GBM has leading positions in its chosen fixed income, currencies and debt capital markets. Despite turbulent market conditions, the division continues to invest to support the existing franchise, improve connectivity and enhance the control infrastructure. In addition, GBM continues to focus on broadening capabilities in equities and emerging markets.

Our strategy is clear and focused, and GBM will continue to build on progress made in H1 2011 during the second half of the year.

 
46

 
 
Global Banking & Markets (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Operating profit fell to £446 million following a marked decline in revenue, partially offset by a lower level of performance-related compensation.
   
·
Revenue fell 35%, mirroring a similar quarter on quarter profile last year, albeit from a lower Q1 2011 base. The decline was driven by Fixed Income & Currencies, which fell 44% in challenging market conditions. A subdued market environment caused smaller declines in Equities and Portfolio Management and Origination.
   
 
Average trading Value-at-Risk (VaR) in the Group’s Core businesses decreased by 44% over the course of the second quarter as GBM managed down its risk positions given a volatile and risk averse environment. In addition, reduction in the volatility of the market data used in its calculation also impacted VaR.
     
 
Money Market activity remained subdued as expectations of interest rate increases in the UK and US receded. Revenue from the underlying business was more than offset by the cost of the division’s funding and liquidity activities.
   
 
Rates Flow fell sharply, compared with a buoyant Q1 2011, reflecting decreased corporate activity in Europe and a subdued trading performance.
   
 
Mortgage and Asset-Backed Security markets, although weaker than prior quarter, continued to be supported by healthy client demand. Revenues, however, fell in Q2 2011 reflecting difficult trading conditions.
   
 
Equities declined as levels of client activity struggled in volatile and thin markets.
   
 
Portfolio Management and Origination remained flat, with a slowdown in the Debt Capital Markets business offset by gains on market derivative values.
   
·
Total costs fell £239 million, driven by lower performance-related pay following the weaker revenue performance in Q2 2011.
   
·
Impairments, at £37 million, remained low and reflected a single specific provision.
   
·
Third party assets were broadly flat and continued to be managed within the targeted range of £400 - £450 billion.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets fell 5% as GBM carefully managed its risk levels and continued to focus on efficient capital deployment.
   
·
Net interest margin continued to be depressed by the lengthening of the division’s funding profile and lower margins in the Money Markets business.
   
·
Return on equity of 9% was primarily impacted by the fall in revenue.
 
 
47

 
 
Global Banking & Markets (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Operating profit declined by 41% as a result of the fall in revenue.
   
·
 
Lower revenue in the Rates businesses primarily stems from lower levels of client activity and reduced appetite for risk. Overall, Fixed Income & Currencies revenue fell by £141 million, or 13%.
   
·
The fall in Portfolio Management and Origination revenue reflects a declining balance sheet as customer repayments outweighed new lending. This was compounded by the negative impact of changes in market derivative values.
   
·
The increase in total costs reflects ongoing investment activities and higher levels of depreciation, driven by investment spend in earlier periods.
   
·
Impairments improved due to a lower level of specific provisions in Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Both H1 2011 and H1 2010 began strongly before weakening as the period progressed.  However, investor confidence has been more fragile in 2011 and operating profit is down 31% as a result.
   
·
Revenue generation has slowed across a range of businesses as investors remained nervous, with Fixed Income & Currencies revenue 13% lower in the first half of 2011 compared with H1 2010.
   
·
Portfolio Management suffered the most significant decline in revenue, from £1,050 million in H1 2010 to £666 million in H1 2011. The reduction was due to a declining balance sheet and reduced levels of origination activity as clients increased cash holdings. This was exacerbated by a swing in market derivative values over the period.
   
·
Increased costs primarily reflect higher levels of investment and expense related to regulatory changes, both at a divisional and Group level.
   
·
During H1 2011 impairments benefited from a low level of specific charges and a latent loss provision release.
 
 
48

 
 
RBS Insurance

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Earned premiums
1,056 
1,065 
1,118 
 
2,121 
2,248 
Reinsurers' share
(60)
(54)
(38)
 
(114)
(72)
             
Net premium income
996 
1,011 
1,080 
 
2,007 
2,176 
Fees and commissions
(81)
(75)
(91)
 
(156)
(181)
Instalment income
35 
35 
40 
 
70 
82 
Investment income
69 
64 
74 
 
133 
125 
Other income
27 
35 
40 
 
62 
78 
             
Total income
1,046 
1,070 
1,143 
 
2,116 
2,280 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff expenses
(70)
(76)
(73)
 
(146)
(143)
  - other expenses
(79)
(87)
(85)
 
(166)
(171)
Indirect expenses
(54)
(56)
(62)
 
(110)
(127)
             
 
(203)
(219)
(220)
 
(422)
(441)
             
Net claims
(704)
(784)
(1,126)
 
(1,488)
(2,092)
 
           
Operating profit/(loss)
139 
67 
(203)
 
206 
(253)
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Personal lines motor excluding broker
           
  - own brands
471 
468 
481 
 
939 
970 
  - partnerships
63 
80 
89 
 
143 
182 
Personal lines home excluding broker*
           
  - own brands
123 
121 
121 
 
243 
242 
  - partnerships
95 
102 
99 
 
198 
206 
Personal lines other excluding broker*
           
  - own brands
47 
47 
47 
 
94 
99 
  - partnerships
50 
48 
56 
 
99 
115 
Other
           
  - commercial
87 
81 
82 
 
168 
167 
  - international
86 
87 
81 
 
173 
166 
  - other (1)
24 
36 
87 
 
59 
133 
             
Total income
1,046 
1,070 
1,143 
 
2,116 
2,280 

* Home response own brands and partnerships income has been restated from personal lines other to personal lines home.
 
Note:
(1)
Other is predominantly made up of the discontinued personal lines broker business.
 
 
49

 
 
RBS Insurance (continued)

Key metrics
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
In-force policies (000’s)
           
Personal lines motor excluding broker
           
  - own brands
3,931 
4,071 
4,424 
 
3,931 
4,424 
  - partnerships
474 
559 
755 
 
474 
755 
Personal lines home excluding broker*
           
  - own brands
1,844 
1,775 
1,818 
 
1,844 
1,818 
  - partnerships
2,524 
2,501 
2,535 
 
2,524 
2,535 
Personal lines other excluding broker*
           
  - own brands
1,932 
1,972 
2,147 
 
1,932 
2,147 
  - partnerships
7,577 
7,909 
6,526 
 
7,577 
6,526 
Other**
           
  - commercial
393 
383 
344 
 
393 
344 
  - international
1,302 
1,234 
1,037 
 
1,302 
1,037 
  - other (1)
211 
418 
988 
 
211 
988 
             
Total in-force policies (2)
20,188 
20,822 
20,574 
 
20,188 
20,574 
             
Gross written premium (£m)
1,034 
1,037 
1,092 
 
2,071
2,182 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (3)
15.4% 
7.0% 
(21.8%)
 
11.4% 
(13.6%)
Loss ratio (4)
71% 
77% 
104% 
 
74% 
96% 
Commission ratio (5)
8% 
7% 
8% 
 
8% 
8% 
Expense ratio (6)
20% 
22% 
20% 
 
21% 
20% 
Combined operating ratio (7)
99% 
106% 
132% 
 
103% 
124% 
             
Balance sheet
           
General insurance reserves - total (£m)
7,484 
7,541 
7,326 
 
7,484 
7,326 

* Home response own brands and partnerships in-force policies (IFPs) have been restated from personal lines other to personal lines home.
** 30 June 2010 comparatives have been restated to reflect the switch of commercial van new business and renewal IFPs from other to commercial.
 
Notes:
(1)
Other is predominantly made up of the discontinued personal lines broker business.
(2)
Total in-force policies include travel and creditor policies sold through RBS Group. These comprise travel policies included in bank accounts e.g. Royalties Gold Account, and creditor policies sold with bank products including mortgage, loan and card repayment payment protection.
(3)
Return on equity is based on annualised divisional operating profit/(loss) after tax divided by divisional average notional equity (based on regulatory capital).
(4)
Loss ratio is based on net claims divided by net premium income.
(5)
Commission ratio is based on fees and commissions divided by gross written premium.
(6)
Expense ratio is based on expenses excluding fees and commissions divided by gross written premium.
(7)
Combined operating ratio is the sum of the loss, expense and commission ratios.
 
 
50

 
 
RBS Insurance (continued)

Key points
RBS Insurance continues to undertake a significant programme of investment, designed to achieve a substantial improvement in financial and operational performance ahead of its planned divestment from the Group. This programme has three phases - recovering profitability; building competitive advantage and driving profitable growth. These results mark significant progress towards the completion of the first phase, with H1 2011 underwriting profit of £495 million, up £432 million versus H1 2010, primarily driven by an improvement in net claims.

The elements of the programme which focus on building competitive advantage have also progressed well in the first half of the year, and are on track to deliver significant benefits in future periods. In H1 2011 RBS Insurance continued to refine and enhance its pricing systems and introduced the first phase of a new claims system. These investments will enable greater pricing sophistication and further improve the control of claims costs, whilst also providing enhanced customer experience. Implementation of the plan, announced in 2010, to rationalise the number of sites occupied is underway. Progress to simplify the legal entity structure, and to ensure compliance with Solvency 2, continues.

RBS Insurance is positioning itself for profitable growth in the future and announced a five-year partnership, on personal lines motor, with Sainsbury’s Finance. RBS Insurance will provide the underwriting, sales, service and claims management support to Sainsbury’s customers. The agreement with Sainsbury’s Finance is an important addition to the partnership channel.

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Operating profit has doubled to £139 million from the previous quarter. This was driven by continuing improvement in the profitability seen in Q1 2011, coupled with the normal seasonal patterns for income and claims, and benign weather conditions in the quarter.
   
·
Net premium income was down 1%, reflecting the earned impact of the reduction in the risk of the book and pricing action taken last year, together with the exit from unprofitable partnerships and personal lines broker business.
   
·
Total expenses were down 7% on the prior quarter primarily due to phasing of marketing and indirect expenses.
   
·
Other income was down £3 million primarily as a result of Tesco Personal Finance run-off and sale of Devitt Insurance Services Limited, the motorcycle insurance broker business, in May 2011.
   
·
Commercial gross written premium grew 8% in Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011.
   
·
Motor income in Q2 2011 was down 4% against Q1 2011, the result of continuing risk reduction. However, the rate of reduction in income has slowed, and in Q2 2011 motor gross written premium grew by 4% compared with Q1 2011. Home gross written premium increased 1% in Q2 2011 in comparison with Q1 2011 and Q2 2010, while home in-force policies grew 2% in Q2 2011 over the previous quarter in a challenging market.

 
51

 
 
RBS Insurance (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Operating profit was £139 million compared with a loss of £203 million for Q2 2010. The loss in 2010 included reserve strengthening for bodily injury including £241 million related to prior years. The improvement in profit was also attributable to the reduction in the risk of the book, selected business line exits, and pricing action taken.
   
·
Total expenses were down 8% on last year primarily due to phasing of marketing and indirect expenses.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Operating profit was £206 million compared with a loss of £253 million for H1 2010, driven by a £604 million improvement in net claims. The loss in 2010 included reserve strengthening for bodily injury, a significant proportion of which related to prior years and has not been repeated in 2011. The remainder of the improvement is attributable to the reduction in the risk of the book, selected business line exits and pricing action.
   
·
Total income was £164 million lower, partially offsetting the claims movement, driven primarily by the exit from personal lines broker and unprofitable partnerships.
   
·
Commercial income fell by £6 million year on year due to the run off of Finsure Premium Finance Limited.
   
·
International continued its growth trend with a 35% increase in gross written premium for H1 2011 versus H1 2010, and a 26% increase in in-force policies, over the same period, driven by strong business performance in Italy, and a new partnership with Fiat. Based on the latest annual data published by ANIA (Italian Insurance Association) for the calendar year 2010, Direct Line Italy is now the leader in the direct motor market with a 27% share. The Italian business makes extensive use of reinsurance to control risk and manage capital.
   
·
Total expenses were down 4% primarily due to phasing of marketing and indirect expenses.
 
 
52

 
 
Central items

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Central items not allocated
47 
(43)
49 
 
386 

Note:
(1)
Costs/charges are denoted by brackets.
 
Funding and operating costs have been allocated to operating divisions based on direct service usage, the requirement for market funding and other appropriate drivers where services span more than one division.

Residual unallocated items relate to volatile corporate items that do not naturally reside within a division.

Key points

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Central items not allocated represented a credit of £47 million against a charge of £43 million in the previous quarter.  This movement was driven by a gain of £108 million on the disposal of an investment in Visa as well as lower interest rate risk management costs in Group Treasury.

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Central items not allocated represented a credit of £47 million, a decrease of £2 million on Q2 2010.

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Central items not allocated represented a credit of £4 million, a decline of £382 million on H1 2010.
   
·
H1 2010 benefited from a £170 million VAT recovery not repeated in H1 2011, as well as unallocated Group Treasury items, including the impact of economic hedges that do not qualify for IFRS hedge accounting.
 
 
53

 
 
Non-Core

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
284 
301 
550 
 
585 
1,118 
Funding costs of rental assets
(51)
(51)
(78)
 
(102)
(147)
             
Net interest income
233 
250 
472 
 
483 
971 
             
Net fees and commissions
47 
47 
150 
 
93 
250 
Income/(loss) from trading activities
231 
(296)
25 
 
(64)
(102)
Insurance net premium income
95 
138 
173 
 
233 
341 
Other operating income
           
  - rental income
257 
243 
259 
 
500 
515 
  - other (1)
115 
104 
(223)
 
219 
(202)
             
Non-interest income
745 
236 
384 
 
981 
802 
             
Total income
978 
486 
856 
 
1,464 
1,773 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(109)
(91)
(202)
 
(200)
(454)
  - operating lease depreciation
(87)
(87)
(109)
 
(174)
(218)
  - other
(68)
(69)
(143)
 
(137)
(299)
Indirect expenses
(71)
(76)
(121)
 
(147)
(243)
             
 
(335)
(323)
(575)
 
(658)
(1,214)
             
Insurance net claims
(90)
(128)
(215)
 
(218)
(348)
Impairment losses
(1,411)
(1,075)
(1,390)
 
(2,486)
(3,094)
             
Operating loss
(858)
(1,040)
(1,324)
 
(1,898)
(2,883)

Note:
(1)
Includes losses on disposals (quarter ended 30 June 2011 - £20 million; quarter ended 31 March 2011 - £34 million; quarter ended 30 June 2010 - £4 million; half year ended 30 June 2011 - £54 million; half year ended 30 June 2010 - £5 million).
 
 
54

 
 
Non-Core (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Analysis of income by business
           
Portfolios & banking
830 
598 
606 
 
1,428 
1,236 
International businesses
137 
89 
243 
 
226 
512 
Markets
11 
(201)
 
(190)
25 
             
Total income
978 
486 
856 
 
1,464 
1,773 
             
Income/(loss) from trading activities
           
Monoline exposures
(67)
(130)
(139)
 
(197)
(139)
Credit derivative product companies
(21)
(40)
(55)
 
(61)
(86)
Asset-backed products (1)
36 
66 
97 
 
102 
42 
Other credit exotics
(168)
47 
 
(160)
58 
Equities
(2)
(6)
 
(1)
(13)
Banking book hedges
(9)
(29)
147 
 
(38)
111 
Other (2)
287 
(66)
 
291 
(75)
             
 
232 
(296)
25 
 
(64)
(102)
             
Impairment losses
           
Portfolios & banking
1,405 
1,058 
1,332 
 
2,463 
2,911 
International businesses
15 
20 
48 
 
35 
116 
Markets
(9)
(3)
10 
 
(12)
67 
             
Total impairment losses
1,411 
1,075 
1,390 
 
2,486 
3,094 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer
  loans and advances (excluding reverse
  repurchase agreements) (3)
           
Portfolios & banking
6.1% 
4.1% 
4.6% 
 
5.3% 
4.9% 
International businesses
1.9% 
2.1% 
2.3% 
 
2.3% 
2.8% 
Markets
(1.2%)
(0.1%)
1.4% 
 
(0.7%)
12.9% 
             
Total
6.0% 
4.0% 
4.4% 
 
5.2% 
4.8% 

Notes:
(1)
Asset-backed products include super senior asset-backed structures and other asset-backed products.
(2)
Q2 2011 includes securities gains of £362 million and profits in RBS Sempra Commodities JV of £1 million (quarter ended 30 June 2010 - £nil and £125 million respectively).
(3)
Includes disposal groups.
 
 
55

 
 
Non-Core (continued)

Key metrics
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Net interest margin
0.87% 
0.90% 
1.23% 
 
0.89% 
1.25% 
Cost:income ratio
34% 
66% 
67% 
 
45% 
68% 

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet (1)
           
Total third party assets (excluding derivatives) (2)
112.6 
124.8 
(10%)
 
137.9 
(18%)
Total third party assets (including derivatives) (2)
134.7 
137.1 
(2%)
 
153.9 
(12%)
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
94.9 
101.0 
(6%)
 
108.4 
(12%)
Customer deposits
5.0 
7.1 
(30%)
 
6.7 
(25%)
Risk elements in lending
24.9 
24.0 
4% 
 
23.4 
6% 
Risk-weighted assets (2)
124.7 
128.5 
(3%)
 
153.7 
(19%)

Notes:
(1)
Includes disposal groups.
(2)
Includes RBS Sempra Commodities JV (30 June 2011 Third party assets, excluding derivatives (TPAs) £1.1 billion, RWAs £1.9 billion; 31 March 2011 TPAs £3.9 billion, RWAs £2.4 billion; 31 December 2010 TPAs £6.7 billion, RWAs £4.3 billion).
 

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Gross customer loans and advances
     
Portfolios & banking
92.1 
98.0 
104.9 
International businesses
2.7 
2.9 
3.5 
Markets
0.1 
0.1 
       
 
94.9 
101.0 
108.4 
       
Risk-weighted assets
     
Portfolios & banking
72.6 
76.5 
83.5 
International businesses
5.2 
5.1 
5.6 
Markets
46.9 
46.9 
64.6 
       
 
124.7 
128.5 
153.7 
 
 
56

 
 
Non-Core (continued)

Third party assets (excluding derivatives)
               
Quarter ended 30 June 2011

 
31 March 
2011 
Run-off 
Disposals/ 
restructuring 
Drawings/ 
roll overs 
Impairments 
FX 
30 June 
2011 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
Commercial real estate
38.7 
(1.1)
(0.3)
0.2 
(1.3)
0.4 
36.6 
Corporate
56.0 
(2.6)
(4.0)
0.6 
0.4 
50.4 
SME
3.1 
(0.4)
2.7 
Retail
8.3 
(0.2)
(0.1)
8.0 
Other
2.5 
(0.2)
2.3 
Markets
12.3 
(0.7)
(0.4)
0.3 
11.5 
               
Total (excluding derivatives)
120.9 
(5.2)
(4.7)
1.1 
(1.4)
0.8 
111.5 
Markets - RBS Sempra
  Commodities JV
3.9 
(0.5)
(2.2)
(0.1)
1.1 
               
Total (1)
124.8 
(5.7)
(6.9)
1.1 
(1.4)
0.7 
112.6 

Quarter ended 31 March 2011
 
31 December 
2010 
Run-off 
Disposals/ 
restructuring 
Drawings/ 
roll overs 
Impairments 
FX 
31 March 
2011 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
Commercial real estate
42.6 
(3.0)
(0.4)
0.2 
(1.0)
0.3 
38.7 
Corporate
59.8 
(1.9)
(2.4)
0.8 
(0.3)
56.0 
SME
3.7 
(0.6)
3.1 
Retail
9.0 
(0.4)
(0.1)
(0.2)
8.3 
Other
2.5 
2.5 
Markets
13.6 
(1.1)
0.1 
(0.3)
12.3 
               
Total (excluding derivatives)
131.2 
(7.0)
(2.8)
1.1 
(1.1)
(0.5)
120.9 
Markets - RBS Sempra
  Commodities JV
6.7 
(0.3)
(2.3)
(0.2)
3.9 
               
Total (1)
137.9 
(7.3)
(5.1)
1.1 
(1.1)
(0.7)
124.8 

Quarter ended 30 June 2010
 
31 March 
2010 
Run-off 
Disposals/ 
restructuring 
Drawings/ 
roll overs 
Impairments 
FX 
30 June 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
Commercial real estate
49.5 
(5.3)
(0.3)
2.8 
(1.1)
(1.5)
44.1 
Corporate
78.8 
(2.6)
(4.5)
0.6 
0.1 
(2.0)
70.4 
SME
4.0 
0.9 
(0.1)
(0.1)
4.7 
Retail
19.8 
(0.5)
(1.7)
(0.2)
(0.6)
16.8 
Other
3.3 
(0.2)
(0.1)
3.0 
Markets
24.1 
(0.6)
(1.4)
0.6 
(0.1)
(0.3)
22.3 
               
Total (excluding derivatives)
179.5 
(8.3)
(8.0)
4.0 
(1.4)
(4.5)
161.3 
Markets - RBS Sempra
  Commodities JV
14.0 
(1.4)
0.1 
12.7 
               
Total (1)
193.5 
(9.7)
(8.0)
4.0 
(1.4)
(4.4)
174.0 

Note:
(1)
£2 billion of disposals have been signed as at 30 June 2011 but are pending closing (31 March 2011 - £7 billion; 30 June 2010 - £2 billion).
 
 
57

 
 
Non-Core (continued)

 
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Impairment losses by donating division
  and sector
           
             
UK Retail
           
Mortgages
(3)
 
(2)
Personal
 
             
Total UK Retail
 
             
UK Corporate
           
Manufacturing and infrastructure
47 
21 
 
47 
16 
Property and construction
36 
13 
150 
 
49 
204 
Transport
26 
20 
(3)
 
46 
(3)
Banking and financial institutions
 
26 
Lombard
25 
18 
29 
 
43 
54 
Other
46 
11 
64 
 
57 
121 
             
Total UK Corporate
181 
65 
263 
 
246 
418 
             
Ulster Bank
           
Mortgages
23 
 
43 
Commercial real estate
           
  - investment
161 
223 
145 
 
384 
244 
  - development
810 
503 
386 
 
1,313 
748 
Other corporate
107 
137 
 
113 
188 
Other EMEA
13 
 
11 
33 
             
Total Ulster Bank
982 
839 
704 
 
1,821 
1,256 
             
US Retail & Commercial
           
Auto and consumer
12 
25 
32 
 
37 
47 
Cards
(3)
(7)
 
(10)
18 
SBO/home equity
58 
53 
67 
 
111 
169 
Residential mortgages
(10)
 
10 
Commercial real estate
11 
19 
42 
 
30 
105 
Commercial and other
(6)
(3)
 
(9)
             
Total US Retail & Commercial
78 
91 
141 
 
169 
349 
             
Global Banking & Markets
           
Manufacturing and infrastructure
(6)
(2)
(281)
 
(8)
(252)
Property and construction
217 
105 
501 
 
322 
973 
Transport
(1)
(6)
 
(7)
Telecoms, media and technology
34 
(11)
11 
 
23 
Banking and financial institutions
(39)
11 
 
(38)
172 
Other
(36)
(8)
24 
 
(44)
125 
             
Total Global Banking & Markets
169 
79 
266 
 
248 
1,019 
             
Other
           
Wealth
(1)
16 
 
44 
Global Transaction Services
(3)
 
(3)
Central items
 
             
Total Other
(3)
16 
 
(2)
47 
             
Total impairment losses
1,411 
1,075 
1,390 
 
2,486 
3,094 

 
58

 
 
Non-Core (continued)

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Gross loans and advances to customers (excluding reverse
  repurchase agreements) by donating division and sector
     
       
UK Retail
     
Mortgages
1.5 
1.6 
1.6 
Personal
0.3 
0.3 
0.4 
       
Total UK Retail
1.8 
1.9 
2.0 
       
UK Corporate
     
Manufacturing and infrastructure
0.3 
0.2 
0.3 
Property and construction
7.2 
8.0 
11.4 
Transport
5.0 
5.1 
5.4 
Banking and financial institutions
0.9 
0.8 
0.8 
Lombard
1.4 
1.5 
1.7 
Other
6.8 
7.5 
7.4 
       
Total UK Corporate
21.6 
23.1 
27.0 
       
Ulster Bank
     
Commercial real estate
     
  - investment
4.1 
3.9 
4.0 
  - development
9.0 
8.9 
8.4 
Other corporate
1.8 
2.0 
2.2 
Other EMEA
0.4 
0.5 
0.4 
       
Total Ulster Bank
15.3 
15.3 
15.0 
       
US Retail & Commercial
     
Auto and consumer
2.2 
2.4 
2.6 
Cards
0.1 
0.1 
0.1 
SBO/home equity
2.7 
2.9 
3.2 
Residential mortgages
0.7 
0.7 
0.7 
Commercial real estate
1.2 
1.4 
1.5 
Commercial and other
0.4 
0.4 
0.5 
       
Total US Retail & Commercial
7.3 
7.9 
8.6 
       
Global Banking & Markets
     
Manufacturing and infrastructure
8.5 
8.9 
8.7 
Property and construction
18.6 
19.1 
19.6 
Transport
4.2 
4.5 
5.5 
Telecoms, media and technology
0.8 
1.1 
0.9 
Banking and financial institutions
8.8 
11.1 
12.0 
Other
7.5 
8.2 
9.0 
       
Total Global Banking & Markets
48.4 
52.9 
55.7 
       
Other
     
Wealth
0.3 
0.4 
0.4 
Global Transaction Services
0.3 
0.2 
0.3 
RBS Insurance
0.1 
0.2 
Central items
(0.3)
(1.0)
(1.0)
       
Total Other
0.3 
(0.3)
(0.1)
       
Gross loans and advances to customers (excluding reverse
  repurchase agreements)
94.7 
100.8 
108.2 
 
 
59

 
 
Non-Core (continued)

Key points
Non-Core continues to make good progress. Third party assets (excluding derivatives) were down £12 billion to £113 billion and the division remains on track to meet its target of reducing third party assets to below £100 billion by the end of 2011.

Momentum continues in 2011 as Non-Core works through the £12 billion pipeline of transactions signed but not completed at the end of 2010. At the end of Q2 2011 £2 billion remained to be completed from last year’s signed deals and the pipeline continues to build.

Headcount continues to fall, from 6,700 at the end of Q1 2011 to 6,300 at 30 June 2011.

Q2 2011 results demonstrate Non-Core’s commitment to delivering results in what is a challenging and complex environment with significant regulatory headwinds.

As Non-Core continues to shrink, income and expenses are falling in line with expectations. The increase in impairments in Q2 2011 principally resulted from additional real estate charges, continuing difficulties in Ireland driven by development real estate values and impairments relating to a small number of large corporates.

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
Non-Core made further progress with third party assets (excluding derivatives) declining by £12 billion to £113 billion, driven by disposals of £7 billion and run-off of £5 billion.
   
·
Risk weighted assets fell by £4 billion in Q2 2011. The reduction principally reflected continued asset sales, run-off and defaults, partially offset by foreign exchange rate movements.
   
·
Non-Core operating loss was £858 million in the second quarter, compared with £1,040 million in Q1 2011. Non-interest income was higher, reflecting gains on a number of securities arising from restructured assets.
   
·
Higher impairments in Q2 2011 resulted from additional real estate charges, continuing difficulties in Ireland driven by development real estate values and impairments relating to a small number of large corporates.
   
·
Expenses increased 4% from Q1 2011. Excluding the impact of one-off changes to expense accruals, expenses were broadly flat in Q2 2011.

Q2 2011 compared with Q2 2010
·
Third party assets (excluding derivatives) declined by £61 billion (35%) since Q2 2010 reflecting disposals (£36 billion) and run-off (£26 billion).
   
·
Risk-weighted assets were £50 billion lower, driven principally by significant disposal activity combined with run-off.
   
·
Offsetting the impact of continuing balance sheet reduction on net interest income, non-interest income was higher as a result of securities gains in Q2 2011 on restructured assets.
   
·
Costs decreased by £240 million primarily reflecting disposal activity and consequent significant headcount reductions across countries, Non-Core insurance and Sempra Commodities.
 
 
60

 
 
Non-Core (continued)

Key points (continued)

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
Non-Core operating loss decreased from £2,883 million in H1 2010 to £1,898 million in H1 2011 driven by lower expenses and impairments.
   
·
Lower costs reflect significant headcount reductions resulting from disposals and run-down of businesses.
   
·
Impairments were £608 million lower, reflecting the overall improvement in the economic environment despite ongoing difficulties in Ireland.

 
61

 
Condensed consolidated income statement
for the half year ended 30 June 2011


 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Interest receivable
5,404 
5,401 
5,888 
 
10,805 
11,580 
Interest payable
(2,177)
(2,100)
(2,212)
 
(4,277)
(4,362)
             
Net interest income
3,227 
3,301 
3,676 
 
6,528 
7,218 
             
Fees and commissions receivable
1,700 
1,642 
2,053 
 
3,342 
4,104 
Fees and commissions payable
(323)
(260)
(579)
 
(583)
(1,151)
Income from trading activities
1,147 
835 
2,110 
 
1,982 
3,876 
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
553 
 
255 
553 
Other operating income (excluding insurance
  premium income)
1,142 
391 
346 
 
1,533 
793 
Insurance net premium income
1,090 
1,149 
1,278 
 
2,239 
2,567 
             
Non-interest income
5,011 
3,757 
5,761 
 
8,768 
10,742 
             
Total income
8,238 
7,058 
9,437 
 
15,296 
17,960 
             
Staff costs
(2,210)
(2,399)
(2,365)
 
(4,609)
(5,054)
Premises and equipment
(602)
(571)
(547)
 
(1,173)
(1,082)
Other administrative expenses
(1,752)
(921)
(1,022)
 
(2,673)
(2,033)
Depreciation and amortisation
(453)
(424)
(519)
 
(877)
(1,001)
             
Operating expenses
(5,017)
(4,315)
(4,453)
 
(9,332)
(9,170)
             
Profit before other operating charges and
  impairment losses
3,221 
2,743 
4,984 
 
5,964 
8,790 
Insurance net claims
(793)
(912)
(1,323)
 
(1,705)
(2,459)
Impairment losses
(3,106)
(1,947)
(2,487)
 
(5,053)
(5,162)
             
Operating (loss)/profit before tax
(678)
(116)
1,174 
 
(794)
1,169 
Tax charge
(222)
(423)
(825)
 
(645)
(932)
             
(Loss)/profit from continuing operations
(900)
(539)
349 
 
(1,439)
237 
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
21 
10 
(1,019)
 
31 
(706)
             
Loss for the period
(879)
(529)
(670)
 
(1,408)
(469)
Non-controlling interests
(18)
946 
 
(17)
602 
Preference share and other dividends
(19)
 
(124)
             
(Loss)/profit attributable to ordinary and B
  shareholders
(897)
(528)
257 
 
(1,425)
             
Basic (loss)/gain per ordinary and B share from
  continuing operations
(0.8p)
(0.5p)
0.8p 
 
(1.3p)
0.6p 
             
Diluted (loss)/gain per ordinary and B share from
  continuing operations
(0.8p)
(0.5p)
0.8p 
 
(1.3p)
0.6p 
             
Basic (loss)/gain per ordinary and B share from
  discontinued operations
 
             
Diluted (loss)/gain per ordinary and B share from
  discontinued operations
 

 
62

 
 
Condensed consolidated statement of comprehensive income
for the half year ended 30 June 2011


 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Loss for the period
(879)
(529)
(670) 
 
(1,408)
(469)
             
Other comprehensive income/(loss)
           
Available-for-sale financial assets (1)
1,406 
(37)
93 
 
1,369 
508 
Cash flow hedges
588 
(227)
1,449 
 
361 
1,254 
Currency translation
59 
(360)
(91)
 
(301)
694 
             
Other comprehensive income/(loss) before tax
2,053 
(624)
1,451 
 
1,429 
2,456 
Tax (charge)/credit
(524)
32 
(331)
 
(492)
(446)
             
Other comprehensive income/(loss) after tax
1,529 
(592)
1,120 
 
937 
2,010 
             
Total comprehensive income/(loss) for the period
650 
(1,121)
450 
 
(471)
1,541 
             
Total comprehensive income/(loss) recognised
  in the statement of changes in equity is
  attributable as follows:
           
Non-controlling interests
(9)
(457)
 
(6)
(132)
Preference shareholders
 
105 
Paid-in equity holders
19 
 
19 
Ordinary and B shareholders
647 
(1,112)
888 
 
(465)
1,549 
             
 
650 
(1,121)
450 
 
(471)
1,541 

Note:
(1)
Analysis provided on page 104.

Key points
·
The Q2 2011 movement in available-for-sale financial assets reflects the movement of £733 million losses on Greek government bonds and a £109 million related interest rate hedge adjustment to profit or loss from available-for-sale reserves. Offsetting this partially were realised gains from routine portfolio management in Group Treasury of £153 million, Non-Core of £31 million and UK Corporate of £16 million. In addition, unrealised gains on securities increased by £781 million in the quarter, primarily in relation to high quality sovereign bonds.
   
·
Gains related to cash flow hedges of £588 million in Q2 2011 result principally from declines in swap rates during the quarter as expectations of an increase in interest rates have been deferred.

 
63

 
 
Condensed consolidated balance sheet
at 30 June 2011


 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Assets
     
Cash and balances at central banks
64,351 
59,591 
57,014 
Net loans and advances to banks
53,133 
59,304 
57,911 
Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing
41,973 
45,148 
42,607 
Loans and advances to banks
95,106 
104,452 
100,518 
Net loans and advances to customers
489,572 
494,148 
502,748 
Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing
56,162 
60,511 
52,512 
Loans and advances to customers
545,734 
554,659 
555,260 
Debt securities
243,645 
231,384 
217,480 
Equity shares
24,951 
22,212 
22,198 
Settlement balances
24,566 
23,006 
11,605 
Derivatives
394,872 
361,048 
427,077 
Intangible assets
14,592 
14,409 
14,448 
Property, plant and equipment
17,357 
15,846 
16,543 
Deferred tax
6,245 
6,299 
6,373 
Prepayments, accrued income and other assets
11,143 
11,355 
12,576 
Assets of disposal groups
3,407 
8,992 
12,484 
       
Total assets
1,445,969 
1,413,253 
1,453,576 
       
Liabilities
     
Bank deposits
71,573 
63,829 
66,051 
Repurchase agreements and stock lending
35,381 
39,615 
32,739 
Deposits by banks
106,954 
103,444 
98,790 
Customer deposits
428,703 
428,474 
428,599 
Repurchase agreements and stock lending
88,822 
90,432 
82,094 
Customer accounts
517,525 
518,906 
510,693 
Debt securities in issue
213,797 
215,968 
218,372 
Settlement balances
22,905 
21,394 
10,991 
Short positions
56,106 
50,065 
43,118 
Derivatives
387,809 
360,625 
423,967 
Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities
24,065 
23,069 
23,089 
Retirement benefit liabilities
2,239 
2,257 
2,288 
Deferred tax
2,092 
2,094 
2,142 
Insurance liabilities
6,687 
6,754 
6,794 
Subordinated liabilities
26,311 
26,515 
27,053 
Liabilities of disposal groups
3,237 
6,376 
9,428 
       
Total liabilities
1,369,727 
1,337,467 
1,376,725 
       
Equity
     
Non-controlling interests
1,498 
1,710 
1,719 
Owners’ equity*
     
  Called up share capital
15,317 
15,156 
15,125 
  Reserves
59,427 
58,920 
60,007 
       
Total equity
76,242 
75,786 
76,851 
       
Total liabilities and equity
1,445,969 
1,413,253 
1,453,576 
       
* Owners’ equity attributable to:
     
Ordinary and B shareholders
70,000 
69,332 
70,388 
Other equity owners
4,744 
4,744 
4,744 
       
 
74,744 
74,076 
75,132 

 
64

 

Commentary on condensed consolidated balance sheet


Total assets of £1,446.0 billion at 30 June 2011 were down £7.6 billion, 1%, compared with 31 December 2010. This is principally driven by the reduction in the mark-to-market value of derivatives in GBM and the continuing planned disposal of Non-Core assets. The decrease is offset in part by higher levels of debt securities held by GBM and Group Treasury, coupled with a rise in settlement balances as a result of increased customer activity from seasonal year-end lows.

Loans and advances to banks decreased by £5.4 billion, 5%, to £95.1 billion. Within this, reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing (‘reverse repos’) were down £0.6 billion, 1%, to £42.0 billion and bank placings declined £4.8 billion, 8%, to £53.1 billion.

Loans and advances to customers declined £9.5 billion, 2%, to £545.7 billion. Within this, reverse repurchase agreements were up £3.7 billion, 7%, to £56.1 billion. Customer lending decreased by £13.2 billion to £489.6 billion, or £10.6 billion to £510.2 billion before impairments. This reflected planned reductions in Non-Core of £13.9 billion, along with declines in GBM, £4.2 billion, UK Corporate, £0.9 billion and Ulster Bank, £0.8 billion. These reductions were partially offset by growth in Global Transaction Services, £4.7 billion, UK Retail, £2.0 billion, US Retail & Commercial, £1.0 billion and Wealth, £0.6 billion, together with the effect of exchange rate and other movements.

Debt securities were up £26.2 billion, 12%, to £243.6 billion, driven mainly by increased holdings of government and financial institution bonds within GBM and Group Treasury.

Settlement balances rose £13.0 billion, to £24.6 billion as a result of increased customer activity from seasonal year-end lows.

Movements in the value of derivative assets down, £32.2 billion, 8%, to £394.9 billion, and liabilities, down £36.2 billion, 9% to £387.8 billion, primarily reflect decreases in interest rate contracts, together with the combined effect of currency movements, with Sterling strengthening against the US dollar but weakening against the Euro.

The reduction in assets and liabilities of disposal groups primarily reflects the continuing disposal of parts of the RBS Sempra Commodities JV business and the sale of certain Non-Core project finance assets.

Deposits by banks increased £8.2 billion, 8%, to £107.0 billion, with higher repurchase agreements and stock lending (‘repos’), up £2.7 billion, 8%, to £35.4 billion combined with an increase in inter-bank deposits, up £5.5 billion, 8%, to £71.6 billion.

Customer accounts increased £6.8 billion, 1%, to £517.5 billion. Within this, repos increased £6.7 billion, 8%, to £88.8 billion.  Excluding repos, customer deposits were up £0.1 billion at £428.7 billion, reflecting growth in Global Transaction Services, £3.6 billion, Wealth, £0.9 billion and Ulster Bank, £0.4 billion, together with exchange and other movements £0.9 billion. This was offset by decreases in GBM, £3.4 billion, Non-Core, £1.8 billion and UK Corporate, £0.5 billion.

Settlement balances rose £11.9 billion to £22.9 billion and short positions were up £13.0 billion, 30%, to £56.1 billion due to increased customer activity from seasonal year-end lows.

 
65

 

Commentary on condensed consolidated balance sheet (continued)

 
Subordinated liabilities decreased by £0.7 billion, 3% to £26.3 billion, primarily reflecting the redemption of £0.2 billion US dollar and £0.4 billion Euro denominated dated loan capital.
 
Owner’s equity decreased by £0.4 billion, 1%, to £74.7 billion, driven by the £1.4 billion attributable loss for the period together with movements in foreign exchange reserves, £0.3 billion, partially offset by increases in available-for-sale reserves, £1.0 billion and cash flow hedging reserves, £0.3 billion.

 
66

 

Average balance sheet


 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
Average yields, spreads and margins of the banking business
 
           
Gross yield on interest-earning assets of banking business
3.28 
3.33 
 
3.31 
3.29 
Cost of interest-bearing liabilities of banking business
(1.66)
(1.61)
 
(1.63)
(1.46)
           
Interest spread of banking business
1.62 
1.72 
 
1.68 
1.83 
Benefit from interest-free funds
0.34 
0.32 
 
0.32 
0.22 
           
Net interest margin of banking business
1.96 
2.04 
 
2.00 
2.05 
           
           
Average interest rates
         
The Group's base rate
0.50 
0.50 
 
0.50 
0.50 
           
London inter-bank three month offered rates
         
  - Sterling
0.82 
0.79 
 
0.81 
0.66 
  - Eurodollar
0.26 
0.31 
 
0.29 
0.35 
  - Euro
1.36 
1.04 
 
1.20 
0.62 

 
67

 

Average balance sheet (continued)


 
Quarter ended
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2011
31 March 2011
 
Average 
   
Average 
   
 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Assets
           
Loans and advances to banks
67,213 
164 
0.98 
64,040 
172 
1.09 
Loans and advances to
  customers
469,814 
4,535 
3.87 
473,616 
4,593 
3.93 
Debt securities
123,521 
705 
2.29 
119,954 
636 
2.15 
             
Interest-earning assets -
  banking business
660,548 
5,404 
3.28 
657,610 
5,401 
3.33 
             
Trading business
284,378 
   
279,164 
   
Non-interest earning assets
558,773 
   
508,177 
   
             
Total assets
1,503,699 
   
1,444,951 
   
             
Liabilities
           
Deposits by banks
65,896 
249 
1.52 
66,671 
259 
1.58 
Customer accounts
331,453 
853 
1.03 
325,160 
831 
1.04 
Debt securities in issue
161,190 
863 
2.15 
164,278 
817 
2.02 
Subordinated liabilities
20,472 
190 
3.71 
24,014 
185 
3.13 
Internal funding of trading
  business
(51,609)
22 
(0.17)
(52,013)
(0.06)
             
Interest-bearing liabilities -
  banking business
527,402 
2,177 
1.66 
528,110 
2,100 
1.61 
             
Trading business
314,099 
   
301,753 
   
Non-interest-bearing liabilities
           
  - demand deposits
64,811 
   
63,701 
   
  - other liabilities
523,039 
   
477,017 
   
Owners’ equity
74,348 
   
74,370 
   
             
Total liabilities and
  owners’ equity
1,503,699
   
1,444,951 
   

Note:
(1)
Interest receivable and interest payable on trading assets and liabilities are included in income from trading activities.

 
68

 
 
Average balance sheet (continued)

 
 
Half year ended
Half year ended
 
30 June 2011
30 June 2010
 
Average 
   
Average 
   
 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Assets
           
Loans and advances to banks
65,627 
336 
1.03 
47,508 
271 
1.15 
Loans and advances to
  customers
471,730 
9,128 
3.90 
522,651 
9,452 
3.65 
Debt securities
121,531 
1,341 
2.23 
139,751 
1,857 
2.68 
             
Interest-earning assets -
  banking business
658,887 
10,805 
3.31 
709,910 
11,580 
3.29 
             
Trading business
281,771 
   
278,527 
   
Non-interest earning assets
533,667 
   
734,494 
   
             
Total assets
1,474,325 
   
1,722,931 
   
             
Liabilities
           
Deposits by banks
66,283 
508 
1.55 
90,189 
715 
1.60 
Customer accounts
328,352 
1,684 
1.03 
342,651 
1,834 
1.08 
Debt securities in issue
162,980 
1,680 
2.08 
188,644 
1,701 
1.82 
Subordinated liabilities
22,235 
375 
3.40 
30,413 
237 
1.57 
Internal funding of trading
  business
(51,811)
30 
(0.12)
(47,609)
 (125)
0.53 
             
Interest-bearing liabilities -
  banking business
528,039 
4,277 
1.63 
604,288 
4,362 
1.46 
             
Trading business
307,926 
   
301,816 
   
Non-interest-bearing liabilities
           
  - demand deposits
64,256 
   
46,937 
   
  - other liabilities
499,745 
   
695,265 
   
Owners’ equity
74,359 
   
74,625 
   
             
Total liabilities and
  owners’ equity
1,474,325 
   
1,722,931 
   

Note:
(1)
Interest receivable and interest payable on trading assets and liabilities are included in income from trading activities.

 
69

 
 
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
for the half year ended 30 June 2011


 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Called-up share capital
           
At beginning of period
15,156 
15,125 
15,031 
 
15,125 
14,630 
Ordinary shares issued
161 
31 
 
192 
401 
Preference shares redeemed
(2)
 
(2)
             
At end of period
15,317 
15,156 
15,029 
 
15,317 
15,029 
             
Paid-in equity
           
At beginning of period
431 
431 
565 
 
431 
565 
Securities redeemed during the period
(132)
 
(132)
Transfer to retained earnings
(2)
 
(2)
             
At end of period
431 
431 
431 
 
431 
431 
             
Share premium account
           
At beginning of period
23,922 
23,922 
23,740 
 
23,922 
23,523 
Ordinary shares issued
 
217 
Redemption of preference shares classified as debt
118 
 
118 
             
At end of period
23,923 
23,922 
23,858 
 
23,923 
23,858 
             
Merger reserve
           
At beginning of period
13,272 
13,272 
13,272 
 
13,272 
25,522 
Transfer to retained earnings
(50)
 
(50)
(12,250)
             
At end of period
13,222 
13,272 
13,272 
 
13,222 
13,272 
             
Available-for-sale reserve
           
At beginning of period
(2,063)
(2,037)
(1,527)
 
(2,037)
(1,755)
Unrealised gains
781 
162 
119 
 
943 
647 
Realised losses/(gains) (1)
626 
(197)
20 
 
429 
(127)
Tax
(370)
(55)
 
(361)
(208)
Recycled to profit or loss on disposal of businesses (2)
(16)
 
(16)
             
At end of period
(1,026)
(2,063)
(1,459)
 
(1,026)
(1,459)
             
Cash flow hedging reserve
           
At beginning of period
(314)
(140)
(272)
 
(140)
(252)
Amount recognised in equity
811 
14 
(47)
 
825 
(58)
Amount transferred from equity to earnings
(223)
(241)
 
(464)
17 
Tax
(161)
53 
19 
 
(108)
Recycled to profit or loss on disposal of businesses (3)
58 
 
-
58 
             
At end of period
113 
(314)
(235)
 
113 
(235)

For the notes to this table refer to page 72.
 
 
70

 
 
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
for the half year ended 30 June 2011 (continued)


 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
  2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
  2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Foreign exchange reserve
           
At beginning of period
4,754 
5,138 
5,229 
 
5,138 
4,528 
Retranslation of net assets
189 
(429)
666 
 
(240)
1,775 
Foreign currency (losses)/gains on hedges of
  net assets
(116)
76 
(189)
 
(40)
(609)
Tax
(31)
60 
 
(24)
72 
Recycled to profit or loss on disposal of businesses
(11)
 
(11)
             
At end of period
4,834 
4,754 
5,755 
 
4,834 
5,755 
             
Capital redemption reserve
           
At beginning of period
198 
198 
170 
 
198 
170 
Preference shares redeemed
 
             
At end of period
198 
198 
172 
 
198 
172 
             
Contingent capital reserve
           
At beginning and end of period
(1,208)
(1,208)
(1,208)
 
(1,208)
(1,208)
             
Retained earnings
           
At beginning of period
20,713 
21,239 
24,164 
 
21,239 
12,134 
(Loss)/profit attributable to ordinary and B
  shareholders and other equity owners
           
  - continuing operations
(899)
(530)
302 
 
(1,429)
163 
  - discontinued operations
(26)
 
(30)
Equity preference dividends paid
 
(105)
Paid-in equity dividends paid, net of tax
(19)
 
(19)
Transfer from paid-in equity
           
  - gross
 
  - tax
(1)
 
(1)
Equity owners gain on withdrawal of minority interest
           
  - gross
40 
 
40 
  - tax
(11)
 
(11)
Redemption of equity preference shares
(2,968)
 
(2,968)
Gain on redemption of equity preference shares
609 
 
609 
Redemption of preference shares classified as debt
(118)
 
(118)
Transfer from merger reserve
50 
 
50 
12,250 
Shares issued under employee share schemes
(166)
(41)
(2)
 
(207)
(9)
Share-based payments
           
  - gross
29 
38 
26 
 
67 
61 
  - tax
(3)
 
             
At end of period
19,726 
20,713 
22,003 
 
19,726 
22,003 
 
 
71

 
 
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
for the half year ended 30 June 2011 (continued)


 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Own shares held
           
At beginning of period
(785)
(808)
(488)
 
(808)
(121)
Shares (purchased)/disposed
(6)
12 
(330)
 
(704)
Shares issued under employee share schemes
11 
 
16 
             
At end of period
(786)
(785)
(816)
 
(786)
(816)
             
Owners’ equity at end of period
74,744 
74,076 
76,802 
 
74,744 
76,802 
             
Non-controlling interests
           
At beginning of period
1,710 
1,719 
10,364 
 
1,719 
16,895 
Currency translation adjustments and other
  movements
(14)
(7)
(557)
 
(21)
(461)
Profit/(loss) attributable to non-controlling interests
           
  - continuing operations
(1)
(9)
47 
 
(10)
74 
  - discontinued operations
19 
(993)
 
27 
(676)
Dividends paid
(39)
(1,497)
 
(39)
(4,171)
Movements in available-for-sale securities
           
  - unrealised (losses)/gains
(1)
(3)
 
22 
  - realised gains
(3)
(12)
 
(3)
(3)
  - tax
 
  - recycled to profit or loss on disposal of
    discontinued operations (4)
(7)
 
(7)
Movements in cash flow hedging reserves
           
  - amounts recognised in equity
30 
 
(165)
  - amounts transferred from equity to earnings
(1)
 
  - tax
(1)
 
47 
  - recycled to profit or loss on disposal of
    discontinued operations (5)
1,036 
 
1,036 
Equity raised
(10)
 
501 
Equity withdrawn and disposals
(176)
(5,868)
 
(176)
(10,561)
Transfer to retained earnings
(40)
 
(40)
             
At end of period
1,498 
1,710 
2,492 
 
1,498 
2,492 
             
Total equity at end of period
76,242 
75,786 
79,294 
 
76,242 
79,294 
             
Total comprehensive income/(loss) recognised
  in the statement of changes in equity is
  attributable as follows:
           
Non-controlling interests
(9)
(457)
 
(6)
(132)
Preference shareholders
 
105 
Paid-in equity holders
19 
 
19 
Ordinary and B shareholders
647 
(1,112)
888 
 
(465)
1,549 
             
 
650 
(1,121)
450 
 
(471)
1,541 

Notes:
(1)
Includes an impairment loss of £733 million in respect of the Group’s holding of Greek government bonds, together with £109 million of related interest rate hedge adjustments, in the quarter ended 30 June 2011 and half year ended 30 June 2011.
(2)
Net of tax (quarter ended 30 June 2010 - £6 million credit; half year ended 30 June 2010 - £6 million credit).
(3)
Net of tax (quarter ended 30 June 2010 - £20 million charge; half year ended 30 June 2010 - £20 million charge).
(4)
Net of tax (quarter ended 30 June 2010 - £2 million credit; half year ended 30 June 2010 - £2 million credit).
(5)
Net of tax (quarter ended 30 June 2010 - £346 million charge; half year ended 30 June 2010 - £346 million charge).

 
72

 
 
Condensed consolidated cash flow statement
for the half year ended 30 June 2011

 
 
First half 
2011 
First half 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
     
Operating activities
   
Operating (loss)/profit before tax
(794)
1,169 
Operating profit/(loss) before tax on discontinued operations
38 
(618)
Adjustments for non-cash items
1,503 
2,571 
     
Net cash inflow from trading activities
747 
3,122 
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
7,595 
(13,954)
     
Net cash flows from operating activities before tax
8,342 
(10,832)
Income taxes (paid)/received
(90)
411 
     
Net cash flows from operating activities
8,252 
(10,421)
     
Net cash flows from investing activities
(4,362)
822 
     
Net cash flows from financing activities
(1,212)
(12,795)
     
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
482 
(355)
     
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
3,160 
(22,749)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
152,530 
144,186 
     
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
155,690 
121,437 

 
73

 

Notes

1. Basis of preparation
The Group’s business activities and financial position, and the factors likely to affect its future development and performance are discussed on pages 5 to 120. Its objectives and policies in managing the financial risks to which it is exposed and its capital are discussed in the risk and balance sheet management sections on pages 121 to 174. A summary of the risk factors which could materially affect the Group’s future results are described on pages 175 to 178. The Group’s regulatory capital resources are set on page 122. Pages 125 to 133 describe the Group’s funding and liquidity management.
 
The condensed financial statements comprise the condensed consolidated income statement, condensed consolidated statement of comprehensive income, condensed consolidated balance sheet, condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity, condensed consolidated cash flow statement and related explanatory notes 1 to 21 and have been prepared in accordance with IAS 34 ‘Interim Financial Reporting’.

Having reviewed the Group’s forecasts, projections and other relevant evidence, the directors have a reasonable expectation that the Group will continue in operational existence for the foreseeable future. Accordingly, the interim financial statements for the six months ended 30 June 2011 have been prepared on a going concern basis.

In line with the Group’s policy of providing users of its financial reports with relevant and transparent disclosures, it has adopted the British Bankers’ Association Code for Financial Reporting Disclosure published in September 2010. The code sets out five disclosure principles together with supporting guidance: the overarching principle being a commitment to provide high quality, meaningful and decision-useful disclosures.

2. Accounting policies
The annual accounts are prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) and interpretations issued by the International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC) of the IASB as adopted by the European Union (EU) (together IFRS). There have been no significant changes to the Group’s principal accounting policies as set out on pages 216 to 224 of the 2010 Form 20-F.

Recent developments in IFRS
In May 2011, the IASB issued six new or revised standards:

IFRS 10 Consolidated Financial Statements which replaces SIC-12 Consolidation - Special Purpose Entities and the consolidation elements of the existing IAS 27 Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements.  The new standard adopts a single definition of control: a reporting entity controls another entity when the reporting entity has the power to direct the activities of that other entity to generate returns for the reporting entity.

IAS 27 Separate Financial Statements which comprises those parts of the existing IAS 27 that dealt with separate financial statements.

 
74

 

Notes (continued)

 
2. Accounting policies (continued)

IFRS 11 Joint Arrangements which supersedes IAS 31 Interests in Joint Ventures. IFRS 11 distinguishes between joint operations and joint ventures. Joint operations are accounted for by the investor recognising its assets and liabilities including its share of any assets held and liabilities incurred jointly and its share of revenues and costs. Joint ventures are accounted for in the investor’s consolidated accounts using the equity method.

IAS 28 Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures covers joint ventures as well as associates; both must be accounted for using the equity method.  The mechanics of the equity method are unchanged.

IFRS 12 Disclosure of Interests in Other Entities covers disclosures for entities reporting under IFRS 10 and IFRS 11 replacing those in IAS 28 and IAS 27.  Entities are required to disclose information that helps financial statement readers evaluate the nature, risks and financial effects associated with an entity’s interests in subsidiaries, in associates and joint arrangements and in unconsolidated structured entities.

IFRS 13 Fair Value Measurement which sets out a single IFRS framework for defining and measuring fair value and requiring disclosures about fair value measurements.

These standards are effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013.  Earlier application is permitted.  The Group is reviewing the standards to determine their effect on the Group’s financial reporting.

In June 2011, the IASB issued amendments to two standards:

Amendments to IAS 1 Presentation of Items of Other Comprehensive Income that require items that will never be recognised in profit or loss to be presented separately in other comprehensive income from those that are subject to subsequent reclassification.

Amendments IAS 19 Employee Benefits - these require the immediate recognition of all actuarial gains and losses eliminating the ‘corridor approach’; interest cost to be calculated on the net pension liability or asset at the appropriate corporate bond rate; and all past service costs to be recognised immediately when a scheme is curtailed or amended.

These amendments are effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013.  Earlier application is permitted.  The Group is reviewing the amendments to determine their effect on the Group’s financial reporting.

 
75

 
 
Notes (continued)


3. Analysis of income, expenses and impairment losses

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
  2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Loans and advances to customers
4,535 
4,593 
4,754 
 
9,128 
9,451 
Loans and advances to banks
164 
172 
131 
 
336 
271 
Debt securities
705 
636 
1,003 
 
1,341 
1,858 
             
Interest receivable
5,404 
5,401 
5,888 
 
10,805 
11,580 
             
Customer accounts
853 
831 
966 
 
1,684 
1,834 
Deposits by banks
249 
259 
418 
 
508 
715 
Debt securities in issue
863 
817 
824 
 
1,680 
1,678 
Subordinated liabilities
190 
185 
60 
 
375 
260 
Internal funding of trading businesses
22 
 (56)
 
30 
(125)
             
Interest payable
2,177 
2,100 
2,212 
 
4,277 
4,362 
             
Net interest income
3,227 
3,301 
3,676 
 
6,528 
7,218 
             
Fees and commissions receivable
1,700 
1,642 
2,053 
 
3,342 
4,104 
Fees and commissions payable
           
  - banking
(238)
(181)
(541)
 
(419)
(1,007)
  - insurance related
(85)
(79)
(38)
 
(164)
(144)
             
Net fees and commissions
1,377 
1,382 
1,474 
 
2,759 
2,953 
             
Foreign exchange
375 
203 
383 
 
578 
832 
Interest rate
649 
207 
 
651 
1,161 
Credit
562 
(248)
1,231 
 
314 
1,208 
Other
208 
231 
289 
 
439 
675 
             
Income from trading activities
1,147 
835 
2,110 
 
1,982 
3,876 
             
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
553 
 
255 
553 
             
Operating lease and other rental income
350 
322 
344 
 
672 
687 
Changes in fair value of own debt
228 
(294)
515 
 
(66)
305 
Changes in the fair value of securities and other
  financial assets and liabilities
224 
68 
(165)
 
292 
(151)
Changes in the fair value of investment properties
(27)
(25)
(105)
 
(52)
(108)
Profit on sale of securities
193 
236 
 
429 
154 
Profit on sale of property, plant and equipment
11 
11 
 
22 
12 
Profit/(loss) on sale of subsidiaries and associates
55 
(29)
(428)
 
26 
(358)
Life business (losses)/profits
(3)
(2)
(23)
 
(5)
12 
Dividend income
18 
15 
21 
 
33 
41 
Share of profits less losses of associated entities
26 
 
15 
48 
Other income
85 
82 
152 
 
167 
151 
             
Other operating income
1,142 
391 
346 
 
1,533 
793 

 
76

 

Notes (continued)


3. Analysis of income, expenses and impairment losses (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
  2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
  2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Non-interest income (excluding insurance net
  premium income)
3,921 
2,608 
4,483 
 
6,529 
8,175 
Insurance net premium income
1,090 
1,149 
1,278 
 
2,239 
2,567 
             
Total non-interest income
5,011 
3,757 
5,761 
 
8,768 
10,742 
             
Total income
8,238 
7,058 
9,437 
 
15,296 
17,960 
             
Staff costs
           
  - wages, salaries and other staff costs
1,923 
2,059 
2,079 
 
3,982 
4,373 
  - bonus tax
11 
11 
15 
 
22 
69 
  - social security costs
168 
192 
158 
 
360 
352 
  - pension costs
108 
137 
113 
 
245 
260 
             
Total staff costs
2,210 
2,399 
2,365 
 
4,609 
5,054 
Premises and equipment
602 
571 
547 
 
1,173 
1,082 
Other
1,752 
921 
1,022 
 
2,673 
2,033 
             
Administrative expenses
4,564 
3,891 
3,934 
 
8,455 
8,169 
Depreciation and amortisation
453 
424 
519 
 
877 
1,001 
             
Operating expenses
5,017 
4,315 
4,453 
 
9,332 
9,170 
             
General insurance
793 
912 
1,348 
 
1,705 
2,455 
Bancassurance
(25)
 
             
Insurance net claims
793 
912 
1,323 
 
1,705 
2,459 
             
Loan impairment losses
2,237 
1,898 
2,479 
 
4,135 
5,081 
Securities impairment losses
           
  - sovereign debt impairment and related interest
    rate hedge adjustments
842 
 
842 
  - other
27 
49 
 
76 
81 
             
Impairment losses
3,106 
1,947 
2,487 
 
5,053 
5,162 

 
77

 

Notes (continued)

 
4. Loan impairment provisions
Operating (loss)/profit is stated after charging loan impairment losses of £2,237 million (Q1 2011 - £1,898 million; Q2 2010 - £2,479 million). The balance sheet loan impairment provisions increased in the quarter ended 30 June 2011 from £19,258 million to £20,759 million and the movements thereon were:

 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
30 June 2010
 
Core 
Non-Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                         
At beginning of period
8,416 
10,842 
19,258 
 
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 
 
7,397 
9,430 
16,827 
Transfers to disposal groups
 
(9)
(9)
 
(38)
(38)
Intra-group transfers
 
177 
(177)
 
Currency translation and other
  adjustments
33 
145 
178 
 
56 
95 
151 
 
(309)
(66)
(375)
Disposals
11 
11 
 
 
(17)
(17)
Amounts written-off
(504)
(474)
(978)
 
(514)
(438)
(952)
 
(562)
(2,122)
(2,684)
Recoveries of amounts
  previously written-off
41 
126 
167 
 
39 
80 
119 
 
59 
21 
80 
Charge to income statement
                       
  - continued
810 
1,427 
2,237 
 
852 
1,046 
1,898 
 
1,096 
1,383 
2,479 
  - discontinued
(11)
(11)
 
 
Unwind of discount
(44)
(68)
(112)
 
(60)
(71)
(131)
 
(48)
(58)
(106)
                         
At end of period
8,752 
12,007 
20,759 
 
8,416 
10,842 
19,258 
 
7,633 
8,533 
16,166 


 
Half year ended
 
30 June 2011
 
30 June 2010
 
Core 
Non-Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
At beginning of period
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 
 
6,921 
8,252 
2,110 
17,283 
Transfers to disposal groups
 
(67)
(67)
Intra-group transfers
177 
(177)
 
Currency translation and other
  adjustments
89 
240 
329 
 
(279)
119 
(160)
Disposals
11 
11 
 
(17)
(2,152)
(2,169)
Amounts written-off
(1,018)
(912)
(1,930)
 
(1,063)
(2,718)
(3,781)
Recoveries of amounts previously
  written-off
80 
206 
286 
 
104 
46 
150 
Charge to income statement
                 
  - continuing
1,662 
2,473 
4,135 
 
2,046 
3,035 
5,081 
  - discontinued
(11)
(11)
 
42 
42 
Unwind of discount
(104)
(139)
(243)
 
(96)
(117)
(213)
                   
At end of period
8,752 
12,007 
20,759 
 
7,633 
8,533 
16,166 

Provisions at 30 June 2011 include £132 million (31 March 2011 - £130 million; 30 June 2010 - £139 million) in respect of loans and advances to banks.

The table above excludes impairments relating to securities.

 
78

 
 
Notes (continued)


5. Strategic disposals
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Gain/(loss) on sale and provision for loss on disposal
  of investments in:
           
  - RBS Asset Management’s investment strategies
    business
 
80 
  - Global Merchant Services
47 
 
47 
  - Non-Core project finance assets
(4)
 
(4)
  - Life assurance business
(235)
 
(235)
  - Other
54 
(70)
(176)
 
(16)
(203)
             
 
50 
(23)
(411)
 
27 
(358)

6. Pensions
The Group and the Trustees of The Royal Bank of Scotland Group Pension Fund (which is the main defined benefit scheme of the Group) have recently agreed the funding valuation of the Main Scheme as at 31 March 2010 which shows that the value of liabilities exceeded the value of assets by £3.5 billion as at 31 March 2010, a ratio of assets to liabilities of 84%.

In order to eliminate this deficit, the Group will pay additional contributions each year over the period 2011 to 2018. These contributions will start at £375 million per annum in 2011, increase to £400 million per annum in 2013 and from 2016 onwards be further increased in line with price inflation.  These contributions are in addition to the regular contributions of around £300 million for future accrual of benefits.

7. Bank Levy
The Finance (No. 3) Act 2011 introduced an annual bank levy in the UK The levy will be collected through the existing quarterly Corporation Tax collection mechanism starting with payment dates on or after 19 July 2011.

The levy is based on the total chargeable equity and liabilities as reported in the balance sheet at the end of a chargeable period. The first chargeable period for RBS is the year ending 31 December 2011. In determining the chargeable equity and liabilities the following amounts are excluded: adjusted Tier 1 capital; certain “protected deposits” (for example those protected under the Financial Services Compensation Scheme); liabilities that arise from certain insurance business within banking groups; liabilities in respect of currency notes in circulation; Financial Services Compensation Scheme liabilities; liabilities representing segregated client money; and deferred tax liabilities, current tax liabilities, liabilities in respect of the levy, revaluation of property liabilities, liabilities representing the revaluation of business premises and defined benefit retirement liabilities. It is also permitted in specified circumstances to reduce certain liabilities: by netting them against certain assets; offsetting assets on the relevant balance sheets that would qualify as high quality liquid assets (in accordance with the FSA definition); and repo liabilities secured against sovereign and supranational debt.
 
 
79

 

Notes (continued)


7. Bank Levy (continued)
The levy will be set at a rate of 0.075 per cent from 2011. Three different rates apply during 2011, these average to 0.075 per cent. Certain liabilities are subject to only a half rate, namely any deposits not otherwise excluded, (except for those from financial institutions and financial traders) and liabilities with a maturity greater than one year at the balance sheet date. The levy is not charged on the first £20 billion of chargeable liabilities.

If the levy had been applied to the balance sheet at 30 June 2011, the cost of the levy to RBS would be a full year charge of approximately £330 million. Under IFRS, no liability for the bank levy arises until the measurement date, 31 December 2011. Accordingly, no accrual was made for the estimated cost of the levy at 30 June 2011.

8. Tax
The charge for tax differs from the tax credit/(charge) computed by applying the standard UK corporation tax rate of 26.5% (2010 - 28%) as follows:

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
(Loss)/profit before tax
(678)
(116)
1,174 
 
(794)
1,169 
             
Tax credit/(charge) based on the standard UK
  corporation tax rate of 26.5% (2010 - 28%)
179 
31 
(329)
 
210 
(327)
Sovereign debt impairment and related interest
  rate hedge adjustments where no deferred tax
  asset recognised
(219)
 
(219)
Losses in period where no deferred tax asset
  recognised
(66)
(166)
(280)
 
(232)
(355)
Foreign profits taxed at other rates
(100)
(200)
(210)
 
(300)
(338)
UK tax rate change - deferred tax impact
(87)
 
(87)
Unrecognised timing differences
(15)
52 
 
(10)
Items not allowed for tax
           
  - losses on strategic disposals and write downs
(7)
(3)
(134)
 
(10)
(145)
  - other disallowable items
(70)
(40)
(59)
 
(110)
(84)
Non-taxable items
           
  - gain on sale of Global Merchant Services
12 
 
12 
  - gain on redemption of own debt
12 
 
12 
  - other non taxable items
12 
62 
 
21 
64 
Taxable foreign exchange movements
(2)
 
Losses brought forward and utilised
13 
16 
 
29 
11 
Adjustments in respect of prior periods
56 
(5)
51 
 
51 
223 
             
Actual tax charge
(222)
(423)
(825)
 
(645)
(932)

The high charge in the first six months of 2011 reflects profits in high tax regimes (principally US) and losses in low tax regimes (principally Ireland), losses in overseas subsidiaries for which a deferred tax asset has not been recognised (principally Ireland and the Netherlands) and the effect of the reduction of 1% in the rate of UK Corporation Tax enacted in March 2011 on the net deferred tax balance.

 
80

 
 
Notes (continued)


8. Tax (continued)

The combined effect of losses in Ireland and the Netherlands (including the sovereign debt impairment and related interest rate hedge adjustments) in the half year ended 30 June 2011 for which no deferred tax asset has been recognised and the 1% change in the standard rate of UK corporation tax accounts for £691 million (81%) of the difference between the actual tax charge and the tax credit derived from applying the standard UK Corporation Tax rate to the results for the period.

The Group has recognised a deferred tax asset at 30 June 2011 of £6,245 million (31 March 2011 -£6,299 million; 31 December 2010 - £6,373 million), of which £3,880 million (31 March 2011 - £3,770 million; 31 December 2010 - £3,849 million) relates to carried forward trading losses in the UK. Under UK tax legislation, these UK losses can be carried forward indefinitely to be utilised against profits arising in the future. The Group has considered the carrying value of this asset as at 30 June 2011 and concluded that it is recoverable based on future profit projections.

9. Profit/(loss) attributable to non-controlling interests

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
  2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
  2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Trust preferred securities
-
 
10 
RBS Sempra Commodities JV
(9)
20 
 
(5)
20 
ABN AMRO
           
  - RFS Holdings minority interest
14 
10 
(976)
 
24 
(644)
  - other
 
RBS Life Holdings
 
11 
Other
(2)
 
(2)
             
Profit/(loss) attributable to non-controlling interests
18 
(1)
(946)
 
17 
(602)

10. Dividends
The Group has undertaken that, unless otherwise agreed with the European Commission, neither the company nor any of its direct or indirect subsidiaries (other than companies in the RBS Holdings N.V. group, which are subject to different restrictions) will pay external investors any dividends or coupons on existing hybrid capital instruments (including preference shares, B shares and upper and lower tier 2 instruments) from 30 April 2010 and for a period of two years thereafter ("the Deferral period"), or exercise any call rights in relation to these capital instruments between 24 November 2009 and the end of the deferral period, unless there is a legal obligation to do so. Hybrid capital instruments issued after 24 November 2009 will generally not be subject to the restriction on dividend or coupon payments or call options.

 
81

 
 
Notes (continued)


11. Earnings per ordinary and B share
Earnings per ordinary and B share have been calculated based on the following:

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Earnings
           
(Loss)/profit from continuing operations attributable
  to ordinary and B shareholders
(899)
(530)
283 
 
(1,429)
39 
Gain on redemption of preference shares and
  paid-in equity
610 
 
610 
             
Adjusted (loss)/profit from continuing operations
  attributable to ordinary and B shareholders
(899)
(530)
893 
 
(1,429)
649 
             
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations attributable
  to ordinary and B shareholders
(26)
 
(30)
             
Ordinary shares in issue during the period (millions)
56,973 
56,798 
56,413 
 
56,886 
56,326 
B shares in issue during the period (millions)
51,000 
51,000 
51,000 
 
51,000 
51,000 
             
Weighted average number of ordinary and B
  shares in issue during the period (millions)
107,973 
107,798 
107,413 
 
107,886 
107,326 
Effect of dilutive share options and convertible
  securities
521 
 
536 
             
Diluted weighted average number of ordinary and
  B shares in issue during the period (1)
107,973 
107,798 
107,934 
 
107,886 
107,862 
             
Basic (loss)/earnings per ordinary and B share
  from continuing operations
(0.8p)
(0.5p)
0.8p 
 
(1.3p)
0.6p 
             
Diluted (loss)/earnings per ordinary and B share
  from continuing operations
(0.8p)
(0.5p)
0.8p 
 
(1.3p)
0.6p 

Note:
(1)
Following reconsideration of the terms of the B Share agreement with HM Treasury, it is no longer treated as dilutive. The comparative amount for the half year ended 30 June 2010 has been restated.

 
82

 
 
Notes (continued)


12. Segmental analysis
There have been no significant changes in the Group’s divisions as set out on page 318 of the 2010 Form 20-F. Operating profit/(loss) before tax, total revenue and total assets by division are shown in the tables below.

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss)
The following tables provide an analysis of the divisional profit/(loss) for the quarters ended 30 June 2011, 31 March 2011 and 30 June 2010 and the half years ended 30 June 2011 and 30 June 2010 by main income statement captions.

 
Net 
interest 
 income 
Non- 
interest 
 income 
 
Total 
 income 
 
Operating 
 expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
 losses 
 
Operating 
 profit/(loss)
Quarter ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
1,086 
333 
1,419 
(688)
(208)
523 
UK Corporate
641 
325 
966 
(403)
(218)
345 
Wealth
182 
115 
297 
(220)
(3)
74 
Global Transaction Services
263 
297 
560 
(342)
(54)
164 
Ulster Bank
171 
51 
222 
(142)
(269)
(189)
US Retail & Commercial
469 
246 
715 
(522)
(66)
127 
Global Banking & Markets
164 
1,386 
1,550 
(1,067)
(37)
446 
RBS Insurance
89 
957 
1,046 
(203)
(704)
139 
Central items
(65)
79 
14 
30 
47 
               
Core
3,000 
3,789 
6,789 
(3,557)
(703)
(853)
1,676 
Non-Core
233 
745 
978 
(335)
(90)
(1,411)
(858)
               
 
3,233 
4,534 
7,767 
(3,892)
(793)
(2,264)
818 
Reconciling items:
             
Fair value of own debt (1)
339 
339 
339 
Asset Protection Scheme credit
  default swap - fair value changes (2)
(168)
(168)
(168)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(850)
 - 
(850)
Sovereign debt impairment and related
  interest rate hedge adjustments
(842)
(842)
Amortisation of purchased intangible
  assets
(56)
(56)
Integration and restructuring costs
(209)
(208)
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
255 
255 
Strategic disposals
50 
50 
50 
Bonus tax
(11)
(11)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(6)
(6)
(5)
               
Total statutory
3,227 
5,011 
8,238 
(5,017)
(793)
(3,106)
(678)

Notes:
(1)
Comprises £111 million gain included in ‘Income from trading activities’ and £228 million gain included in ‘Other operating income’.
(2)
Included in ‘Income from trading activities’.

 
83

 
 
Notes (continued)


12. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
 income 
Non- 
interest 
 income 
 
Total 
 income 
 
Operating 
 expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
 losses 
 
Operating 
 profit/(loss)
Quarter ended 31 March 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
1,076 
304 
1,380 
(678)
(194)
508 
UK Corporate
689 
332 
1,021 
(423)
(105)
493 
Wealth
167 
114 
281 
(196)
(5)
80 
Global Transaction Services
260 
282 
542 
(335)
(20)
187 
Ulster Bank
169 
51 
220 
(136)
(461)
(377)
US Retail & Commercial
451 
243 
694 
(504)
(110)
80 
Global Banking & Markets
180 
2,200 
2,380 
(1,306)
24 
1,098 
RBS Insurance
88 
982 
1,070 
(219)
(784)
67 
Central items
(28)
(13)
(41)
(1)
(1)
(43)
               
Core
3,052 
4,495 
7,547 
(3,798)
(784)
(872)
2,093 
Non-Core
250 
236 
486 
(323)
(128)
(1,075)
(1,040)
               
 
3,302 
4,731 
8,033 
(4,121)
(912)
(1,947)
1,053 
Reconciling items:
             
Fair value of own debt (1)
(480)
(480)
(480)
Asset Protection Scheme credit
  default swap - fair value changes (2)
(469)
(469)
(469)
Amortisation of purchased
  intangible assets
(44)
(44)
Integration and restructuring costs
(2)
(4)
(6)
(139)
(145)
Strategic disposals
(23)
(23)
(23)
Bonus tax
(11)
(11)
RFS Holdings minority interest
               
Total statutory
3,301 
3,757 
7,058 
(4,315)
(912)
(1,947)
(116)

Notes:
(1)
Comprises £186 million loss included in ‘Income from trading activities’ and £294 million loss included in ‘Other operating income’.
(2)
Included in ‘Income from trading activities’.

 
84

 

Notes (continued)


12. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
 income 
Non- 
interest 
 income 
 
Total 
 income 
 
Operating 
 expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
 losses 
 
Operating 
 profit/(loss) 
Quarter ended 30 June 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
1,001 
297 
1,298 
(747)
25 
(300)
276 
UK Corporate
647 
340 
987 
(399)
(198)
390 
Wealth
150 
116 
266 
(178)
(7)
81 
Global Transaction Services
237 
411 
648 
(366)
(3)
279 
Ulster Bank
194 
53 
247 
(143)
(281)
(177)
US Retail & Commercial
502 
275 
777 
(504)
(144)
129 
Global Banking & Markets
320 
1,627 
1,947 
(1,033)
(164)
750 
RBS Insurance
95 
1,048 
1,143 
(220)
(1,126)
(203)
Central items
66 
(72)
(6)
62 
(7)
49 
               
Core
3,212 
4,095 
7,307 
(3,528)
(1,108)
(1,097)
1,574 
Non-Core
472 
384 
856 
(575)
(215)
(1,390)
(1,324)
               
 
3,684 
4,479 
8,163 
(4,103)
(1,323)
(2,487)
250 
Reconciling items:
             
Fair value of own debt (1)
619 
619 
619 
Asset Protection Scheme credit
  default swap - fair value changes (2)
500 
500 
500 
Amortisation of purchased
  intangible assets
(85)
(85)
Integration and restructuring costs
(254)
(254)
Gain on redemption of own debt
553 
553 
553 
Strategic disposals
(411)
(411)
(411)
Bonus tax
(15)
(15)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(8)
21 
13 
17 
               
Total statutory
3,676 
5,761 
9,437 
(4,453)
(1,323)
(2,487)
1,174 

Notes:
(1)
Comprises £104 million gain included in ‘income from trading activities’ and £515 million gain included in ‘Other operating income’.
(2)
Included in ‘Income from trading activities’.

 
85

 

Notes (continued)


12. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
 income 
Non- 
interest 
 income 
 
Total 
 income 
 
Operating 
 expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
 losses 
 
Operating 
 profit/(loss) 
Half year ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
2,162 
637 
2,799 
(1,366)
(402)
1,031 
UK Corporate
1,330 
657 
1,987 
(826)
(323)
838 
Wealth
349 
229 
578 
(416)
(8)
154 
Global Transaction Services
523 
579 
1,102 
(677)
(74)
351 
Ulster Bank
340 
102 
442 
(278)
(730)
(566)
US Retail & Commercial
920 
489 
1,409 
(1,026)
(176)
207 
Global Banking & Markets
344 
3,586 
3,930 
(2,373)
(13)
1,544 
RBS Insurance
177 
1,939 
2,116 
(422)
(1,488)
206 
Central items
(93)
66 
(27)
29 
               
Core
6,052 
8,284 
14,336 
(7,355)
(1,487)
(1,725)
3,769 
Non-Core
483 
981 
1,464 
(658)
(218)
(2,486)
(1,898)
               
 
6,535 
9,265 
15,800 
(8,013)
(1,705)
(4,211)
1,871 
Reconciling items:
             
Fair value of own debt (1)
(141)
(141)
(141)
Asset Protection Scheme credit default
  swap - fair value changes (2)
(637)
(637)
(637)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(850)
(850)
Sovereign debt impairment and related
  interest rate hedge adjustments
(842)
(842)
Amortisation of purchased
  intangible assets
(100)
(100)
Integration and restructuring costs
(2)
(3)
(5)
(348)
(353)
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
255 
255 
Strategic disposals
27 
27 
27 
Bonus tax
(22)
(22)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(5)
(3)
(2)
               
Total statutory
6,528 
8,768 
15,296 
(9,332)
(1,705)
(5,053)
(794)

Notes:
(1)
Comprises £75 million loss included in ‘Income from trading activities’ and £66 million loss included in ‘Other operating income’.
(2)
Included in ‘Income from trading activities’.

 
86

 

Notes (continued)

 
12. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
 income 
Non- 
interest 
 income 
 
Total 
 income 
 
Operating 
 expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
 losses 
 
Operating 
 profit/(loss) 
Half year ended 30 June 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
1,934 
643 
2,577 
(1,470)
(4)
(687)
416 
UK Corporate
1,257 
669 
1,926 
(834)
(384)
708 
Wealth
293 
228 
521 
(367)
(11)
143 
Global Transaction Services
454 
801 
1,255 
(740)
(3)
512 
Ulster Bank
382 
106 
488 
(303)
(499)
(314)
US Retail & Commercial
970 
527 
1,497 
(1,041)
(287)
169 
Global Banking & Markets
693 
4,078 
4,771 
(2,327)
(196)
2,248 
RBS Insurance
191 
2,089 
2,280 
(441)
(2,092)
(253)
Central items
73 
125 
198 
204 
(15)
(1)
386 
               
Core
6,247 
9,266 
15,513 
(7,319)
(2,111)
(2,068)
4,015 
Non-Core
971 
802 
1,773 
(1,214)
(348)
(3,094)
(2,883)
               
 
7,218 
10,068 
17,286 
(8,533)
(2,459)
(5,162)
1,132 
Reconciling items:
             
Fair value of own debt (1)
450 
450 
450 
Amortisation of purchased
  intangible assets
(150)
(150)
Integration and restructuring costs
(422)
(422)
Gain on redemption of own debt
553 
553 
553 
Strategic disposals
(358)
(358)
(358)
Bonus tax
(69)
(69)
RFS Holdings minority interest
29 
29 
33 
               
Total statutory
7,218 
10,742 
17,960 
(9,170)
(2,459)
(5,162)
1,169 

Note:
(1)
Comprises £145 million gain included in ‘Income from trading activities’ and £305 million gain included in ‘Other operating income’.

 
87

 

Notes (continued)


12. Segmental analysis (continued)

Total revenue by division

 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
30 June 2010
 
External 
Inter 
 segment 
Total 
 
External 
Inter 
 segment 
Total 
 
External 
Inter 
segment 
Total 
Total revenue
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
UK Retail
1,744 
88 
1,832 
 
1,696 
116 
1,812 
 
1,700 
93 
1,793 
UK Corporate
1,112 
17 
1,129 
 
1,153 
19 
1,172 
 
1,100 
23 
1,123 
Wealth
253 
185 
438 
 
248 
168 
416 
 
238 
150 
388 
Global Transaction Services
410 
28 
438 
 
382 
12 
394 
 
748 
748 
Ulster Bank
309 
311 
 
327 
327 
 
407 
40 
447 
US Retail & Commercial
826 
51 
877 
 
822 
54 
876 
 
984 
76 
1,060 
Global Banking & Markets
2,097 
1,967 
4,064 
 
2,813 
1,792 
4,605 
 
2,220 
1,385 
3,605 
RBS Insurance
1,187 
1,189 
 
1,199 
1,201 
 
1,273 
1,275 
Central items
762 
3,062 
3,824 
 
693 
2,970 
3,663 
 
753 
2,131 
2,884 
                       
Core
8,700 
5,402 
14,102 
 
9,333 
5,133 
14,466 
 
9,423 
3,900 
13,323 
Non-Core
1,632 
116 
1,748 
 
1,122 
55 
1,177 
 
1,582 
178 
1,760 
                       
 
10,332 
5,518 
15,850 
 
10,455 
5,188
15,643 
 
11,005 
4,078 
15,083 
Reconciling items
                     
Fair value of own debt
339 
339 
 
(480)
(480)
 
619 
619 
Asset Protection Scheme
  credit default swap -
  fair value changes
(168)
(168)
 
(469)
(469)
 
500 
500 
Integration and restructuring
  costs
 
(6)
(6)
 
Gain on redemption of
  own debt
255 
255 
 
 
553 
553 
Strategic disposals
50 
50 
 
(23)
(23)
 
(411)
(411)
RFS Holdings minority
  interest
(6)
(6)
 
 
25 
25 
Elimination of intra-group
  transactions
(5,518)
(5,518)
 
(5,188)
(5,188)
 
(4,078)
(4,078)
                       
 
10,803 
10,803 
 
9,480 
9,480 
 
12,291 
12,291 

 
88

 

Notes (continued)

 
12. Segmental analysis (continued)

Total revenue by division (continued)

 
Half year ended
30 June 2011
 
Half year ended
30 June 2010
 
External 
Inter 
 segment 
Total 
 
External 
Inter 
 segment 
Total 
Total revenue
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
3,440 
204 
3,644 
 
3,391 
183 
3,574 
UK Corporate
2,265 
36 
2,301 
 
2,151 
47 
2,198 
Wealth
501 
353 
854 
 
467 
296 
763 
Global Transaction Services
792 
40 
832 
 
1,454 
1,455 
Ulster Bank
636 
638 
 
753 
70 
823 
US Retail & Commercial
1,648 
105 
1,753 
 
1,932 
148 
2,080 
Global Banking & Markets
4,910 
3,759 
8,669 
 
5,489 
2,517 
8,006 
RBS Insurance
2,386 
2,390 
 
2,533 
2,538 
Central items
1,455 
6,032 
7,487 
 
1,233 
5,106 
6,339 
               
Core
18,033 
10,535 
28,568 
 
19,403 
8,373 
27,776 
Non-Core
2,754 
171 
2,925 
 
3,517 
71 
3,588 
               
 
20,787 
10,706 
31,493 
 
22,920 
8,444 
31,364 
Reconciling items
             
Fair value of own debt
(141)
(141)
 
450 
450 
Asset Protection Scheme credit
  default swap - fair value changes
(637)
(637)
 
Integration and restructuring costs
(5)
(5)
 
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
255 
 
553 
553 
Strategic disposals
27 
27 
 
(358)
(358)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(3)
(3)
 
29 
29 
Elimination of intra-group transactions
(10,706)
(10,706)
 
(8,444)
(8,444)
               
 
20,283 
20,283 
 
23,594 
23,594 

Total assets by division
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
 2010 
Total assets
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
UK Retail
113,578 
113,303 
111,793 
UK Corporate
113,565 
115,029 
114,550 
Wealth
22,038 
21,500 
21,073 
Global Transaction Services
30,206 
27,091 
25,221 
Ulster Bank
38,690 
39,431 
40,081 
US Retail & Commercial
70,872 
70,559 
71,173 
Global Banking & Markets
787,655 
767,993 
802,578 
RBS Insurance
12,901 
12,673 
12,555 
Central items
120,734 
107,518 
99,728 
       
Core
1,310,239 
1,275,097 
1,298,752 
Non-Core
134,692 
137,135 
153,882 
       
 
1,444,931 
1,412,232 
1,452,634 
RFS Holdings minority interest
1,038 
1,021 
942 
       
 
1,445,969 
1,413,253 
1,453,576 

 
89

 
 
Notes (continued)

 
13. Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups

Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
  2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
  2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
Discontinued operations
           
Total income
 
17 
1,435 
Operating expenses
(1)
 
(1)
(820)
Insurance net claims
 
(163)
Impairment recoveries/(losses)
11 
 
11 
(39)
             
Profit before tax
20 
 
27 
413 
Gain on disposal before recycling of reserves
57 
 
57 
Recycled reserves
(1,076)
 
(1,076)
             
Operating profit/(loss) before tax
20 
(1,019)
 
27 
(606)
Tax on profit/(loss)
(4)
(3)
 
(7)
(88)
             
Profit/(loss) after tax
16 
(1,019)
 
20 
(694)
             
Businesses acquired exclusively with a view
  to disposal
           
Profit/(loss) after tax
6  
 
11 
(12)
             
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
21 
10 
(1,019)
 
31 
(706)

Discontinued operations reflect the results of the State of the Netherlands and Santander in RFS Holdings following the legal separation of ABN AMRO Bank N.V. on 1 April 2010.

 
90

 

Notes (continued)


13. Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups (continued)

 
30 June 2011
31 March 
2011 
£m 
31 December 
2010 
£m 
 
Sempra 
Other 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Assets of disposal groups
         
Cash and balances at central banks
155 
155 
126 
184 
Loans and advances to banks
316 
28 
344 
612 
651 
Loans and advances to customers
82 
1,405 
1,487 
3,579 
5,013 
Debt securities and equity shares
13 
16 
32 
20 
Derivatives
505 
20 
525 
2,917 
5,148 
Settlement balances
157 
157 
157 
555 
Property, plant and equipment
15 
17 
766 
18 
Other assets
50 
423 
473 
585 
704 
           
Discontinued operations and other disposal groups
1,125 
2,049 
3,174 
8,774 
12,293 
Assets acquired exclusively with a view to disposal
233 
233 
218 
191 
           
 
1,125 
2,282 
3,407 
8,992 
12,484 
           
Liabilities of disposal groups
         
Deposits by banks
80 
86 
485 
266 
Customer accounts
57 
1,831 
1,888 
1,976 
2,267 
Derivatives
480 
18 
498 
2,963 
5,042 
Settlement balances
505 
505 
452 
907 
Other liabilities
145 
94 
239 
481 
925 
           
Discontinued operations and other disposal groups
1,193 
2,023 
3,216 
6,357 
9,407 
Liabilities acquired exclusively with a view  to disposal
21 
21 
19 
21 
           
 
1,193 
2,044 
3,237 
6,376 
9,428 

The Group substantially completed the disposal of the RBS Sempra Commodities JV in 2010. Certain contracts of the RBS Sempra Commodities JV were sold in risk transfer transactions prior to being novated to the purchaser. They comprise substantially all of its residual assets at 30 June 2011, 31 March 2011 and 31 December 2010 with the other assets and liabilities of disposal groups including project finance assets to be sold to The Bank of Tokyo-Mitsubishi UFJ, Ltd and Non-Core interests in Latin America and the Middle East.

 
91

 

Notes (continued)

 
14. Financial instruments

Classification
The following tables analyse the Group’s financial assets and liabilities in accordance with the categories of financial instruments in IAS 39 with assets and liabilities outside the scope of IAS 39 shown separately.
 
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
financial 
instruments 
(amortised 
cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Assets
               
Cash and balances at central
  banks
64,351 
     
64,351 
Loans and advances to banks
               
  - reverse repos
36,120 
5,853 
     
41,973 
  - other
21,733 
31,400 
     
53,133 
Loans and advances to
  customers
               
  - reverse repos
43,641 
12,521 
     
56,162 
  - other
19,971 
1,038 
458,553 
 
10,010 
 
489,572 
Debt securities
118,169 
213 
118,668 
6,595 
     
243,645 
Equity shares
21,873 
1,049 
2,029 
     
24,951 
Settlement balances
24,566 
     
24,566 
Derivatives (5)
394,872 
           
394,872 
Intangible assets
           
14,592 
14,592 
Property, plant and equipment
           
17,357 
17,357 
Deferred tax
           
6,245 
6,245 
Prepayments, accrued
  income and other assets
1,160 
   
9,983 
11,143 
Assets of disposal groups
           
3,407 
3,407 
                 
 
656,379 
2,300 
120,697 
604,999 
 
10,010 
51,584 
1,445,969 
                 
Liabilities
               
Deposits by banks
               
  - repos
19,898 
   
15,483 
   
35,381 
  - other
28,177 
   
43,396 
   
71,573 
Customer accounts
               
  - repos
57,716 
   
31,106 
   
88,822 
  - other
16,043 
5,566 
   
407,094 
   
428,703 
Debt securities in issue
10,474 
42,395 
   
160,928 
   
213,797 
Settlement balances
   
22,905 
   
22,905 
Short positions
56,106 
         
56,106 
Derivatives (5)
387,809 
           
387,809 
Accruals, deferred income
  and other liabilities
   
1,541 
467 
22,057 
24,065 
Retirement benefit liabilities
       
 
2,239 
2,239 
Deferred tax
       
 
2,092 
2,092 
Insurance liabilities
       
 
6,687 
6,687 
Subordinated liabilities
1,092 
   
25,219 
   
26,311 
Liabilities of disposal groups
           
3,237 
3,237 
                 
 
576,223 
49,053 
   
707,672 
467 
36,312 
1,369,727 
                 
Equity
             
76,242 
                 
               
1,445,969 

For the notes to this table refer to page 94.

 
92

 
 
Notes (continued)


14. Financial instruments (continued)

Classification (continued)

 
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
 financial 
instruments 
(amortised 
 cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
31 March 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Assets
               
Cash and balances at central banks
59,591 
     
59,591 
Loans and advances to banks
               
  - reverse repos
39,838 
5,310 
     
45,148 
  - other
26,377 
32,921 
     
59,304 
Loans and advances to customers
               
  - reverse repos
49,007 
11,504 
     
60,511 
  - other
17,540 
1,053 
465,673 
 
9,882 
 
494,148 
Debt securities
113,139 
332 
111,128 
6,785 
     
231,384 
Equity shares
19,134 
1,051 
2,027 
     
22,212 
Settlement balances
23,006 
     
23,006 
Derivatives (5)
361,048 
           
361,048 
Intangible assets
           
14,409 
14,409 
Property, plant and equipment
           
15,846 
15,846 
Deferred tax
           
6,299 
6,299 
Prepayments, accrued income and other assets
1,381 
   
9,974 
11,355 
Assets of disposal groups
           
8,992 
8,992 
                 
 
626,083 
2,442 
113,155 
606,171 
 
9,882 
55,520 
1,413,253 
                 
Liabilities
               
Deposits by banks
               
  - repos
24,204 
   
15,411 
   
39,615 
  - other
25,234 
   
38,595 
   
63,829 
Customer accounts
               
  - repos
59,246 
   
31,186 
   
90,432 
  - other
13,704 
4,933 
   
409,837 
   
428,474 
Debt securities in issue
9,383 
43,681 
   
162,904 
   
215,968 
Settlement balances
   
21,394 
   
21,394 
Short positions
50,065 
         
50,065 
Derivatives (5)
360,625 
           
360,625 
Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities
   
1,560 
476 
21,033 
23,069 
Retirement benefit liabilities
       
 
2,257 
2,257 
Deferred tax
       
 
2,094 
2,094 
Insurance liabilities
       
 
6,754 
6,754 
Subordinated liabilities
1,064 
   
25,451 
 
26,515 
Liabilities of disposal groups
           
6,376 
6,376 
                 
 
542,461 
49,678 
   
706,338 
476 
38,514 
1,337,467 
                 
Equity
             
75,786 
                 
               
1,413,253 

For the notes to this table refer to page 94.

 
93

 

Notes (continued)


14. Financial instruments (continued)

Classification (continued)
 
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
 financial 
 instruments 
(amortised 
 cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Assets
               
Cash and balances at
  central banks
57,014 
     
57,014 
Loans and advances to banks
               
  - reverse repos
38,215 
4,392 
     
42,607 
  - other
26,082 
31,829 
     
57,911 
Loans and advances to customers
               
  - reverse repos
41,110 
11,402 
     
52,512 
  - other
19,903 
1,100 
471,308 
 
10,437 
 
502,748 
Debt securities
98,869 
402 
111,130 
7,079 
     
217,480 
Equity shares
19,186 
1,013 
1,999 
     
22,198 
Settlement balances
11,605 
     
11,605 
Derivatives (5)
427,077 
           
427,077 
Intangible assets
           
14,448 
14,448 
Property, plant and equipment
           
16,543 
16,543 
Deferred tax
           
6,373 
6,373 
Prepayments, accrued income and other assets
1,306 
   
11,270 
12,576 
Assets of disposal groups
           
12,484 
12,484 
                 
 
670,442 
2,515 
113,129 
595,935 
 
10,437 
61,118 
1,453,576 
                 
Liabilities
               
Deposits by banks
               
  - repos
20,585 
   
12,154 
   
32,739 
  - other
28,216 
   
37,835 
   
66,051 
Customer accounts
               
  - repos
53,031 
   
29,063 
   
82,094 
  - other
14,357 
4,824 
   
409,418 
   
428,599 
Debt securities in issue
7,730 
43,488 
   
167,154 
   
218,372 
Settlement balances
   
10,991 
   
10,991 
Short positions
43,118 
         
43,118 
Derivatives (5)
423,967 
           
423,967 
Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities
   
1,793 
458 
20,838 
23,089 
Retirement benefit liabilities
       
 
2,288 
2,288 
Deferred tax
       
 
2,142 
2,142 
Insurance liabilities
       
 
6,794 
6,794 
Subordinated liabilities
1,129 
   
25,924 
   
27,053 
Liabilities of disposal groups
           
9,428 
9,428 
                 
 
591,004 
49,441 
   
694,332 
458 
41,490 
1,376,725 
                 
Equity
             
76,851 
                 
               
1,453,576 
Notes:
(1)
Held-for-trading.
(2)
Designated as at fair value.
(3)
Available-for-sale.
(4)
Loans and receivables.
(5)
Held-for-trading derivatives include hedging derivatives.

 
94

 
 
Notes (continued)


14. Financial instruments (continued)

Reclassifications
There were no reclassifications in 2011 or 2010.

Financial instruments carried at fair value
Refer to Note 12 Financial instruments - valuation of the Group’s 2010 Form 20-F for valuation techniques. Certain aspects relating to the valuation of financial instruments carried at fair value are discussed below.

Valuation reserves
When valuing financial instruments in the trading book, adjustments are made to mid-market valuations to cover bid-offer spread, liquidity and credit risk.

The table below shows the valuation reserves and adjustments.
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Credit valuation adjustments (CVA)
     
  Monoline insurers
2,321 
2,178 
2,443 
  Credit derivative product companies (CDPCs)
532 
445 
490 
  Other counterparties
1,719 
1,629 
1,714 
       
 
4,572 
4,252 
4,647 
Bid-offer, liquidity  and other reserves
2,572 
2,931 
2,797 
       
 
7,144 
7,183 
7,444 

CVA represent an estimate of the adjustment to fair value that a market participant would make to incorporate the credit risk inherent in counterparty derivative exposures.

Key points

30 June 2011 compared with 31 March 2011
·
The increase in monoline CVA primarily reflected higher exposure, due to lower prices of underlying reference instruments, and wider credit spreads.
   
·
CDPC CVA increased due to higher exposure resulting from wider credit spreads of the underlying reference loans and bonds. This was partially offset by a decrease in the relative value of senior tranches compared with the underlying reference portfolios.
   
·
The CVA held against exposures to other counterparties increased over the period due to several factors including changes in credit spreads and counterparty exposures due to market moves, together with the impact of counterparty rating downgrades.
   
·
The decrease in bid-offer, liquidity and other reserves primarily reflects Non-Core de-risking.

 
95

 

Notes (continued)


14. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation reserves (continued)

Key points (continued)

30 June 2011 compared with 31 December 2010
·
Monoline CVA decreased primarily driven by a reduction in exposure due to higher prices of underlying reference instruments and sterling strengthening against the US dollar.
   
·
CDPC CVA was higher primarily due to an increase in the estimated cost of hedging expected underlying portfolio default losses in excess of the capital available in each vehicle.
   
·
The CVA held against exposures to other counterparties was stable over the period with the impact of several factors offsetting including changes in credit spreads and counterparty exposures due to market moves, together with the impact of realised defaults and counterparty rating downgrades.
   
·
The decrease in bid-offer, liquidity and other reserves primarily reflects Non-Core de-risking.

Own credit
Cumulative own credit adjustment
Debt 
securities 
in issue 
£m 
Subordinated 
liabilities 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Derivatives 
£m 
Total 
£m 
           
30 June 2011
1,933 
377 
2,310 
434 
2,744 
31 March 2011
1,566 
372 
1,938 
447 
2,385 
31 December 2010
2,091 
325 
2,416 
534 
2,950 
           
           
Carrying values of underlying liabilities
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
   
           
30 June 2011
52.9 
1.1 
54.0 
   
31 March 2011
53.1 
1.1 
54.2 
   
31 December 2010
51.2 
1.1 
52.3 
   

 
96

 
 
Notes (continued)

 
14. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy

 
30 June 2011
     
Level 3 sensitivity (6)
 
Total 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Loans and advances to banks
             
  - reverse repos
36.1 
36.1 
 
  - collateral
20.7 
20.7 
 
  - other
1.1 
0.5 
0.6 
 
70 
(60)
               
 
57.9 
57.3 
0.6 
 
70 
(60)
               
Loans and advances to customers
             
  - reverse repos
43.5 
43.5 
 
  - collateral
15.8 
15.8 
 
  - other
5.3 
4.8 
0.5 
 
30 
(30)
               
 
64.6 
64.1 
0.5 
 
30 
(30)
               
Debt securities
             
  - government
139.8 
125.0 
14.8 
 
     - MBS (1)
56.2 
55.6 
0.6 
 
30 
(20)
  - CDOs (2)
3.4 
0.9 
2.5 
 
170 
(30)
  - CLOs (3)
5.0 
3.6 
1.4 
 
110 
(30)
  - other ABS (4)
4.3 
3.2 
1.1 
 
90 
(30)
  - corporate
8.0 
7.6 
0.4 
 
40 
(40)
  - financial institutions
20.0 
3.1 
16.3 
0.6 
 
30 
(50)
  - other
0.3 
0.3 
 
               
 
237.0 
128.1 
102.3 
6.6 
 
470 
(200)
               
Equity shares
25.0 
21.7 
2.1 
1.2 
 
210 
(240)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
72.7 
71.9 
0.8 
 
30 
 (30)
  - interest rate
284.1 
0.3 
282.7 
1.1 
 
60 
(60)
  - equities and commodities
5.7 
5.5 
0.2 
 
  - credit
32.4 
29.9 
2.5 
 
510 
(130)
               
 
394.9 
0.3 
390.0 
4.6 
 
600 
(220)
               
Total
779.4 
150.1 
615.8 
13.5 
 
1,380 
(750)
               
Proportion
100% 
19.3% 
79.0% 
1.7% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
742.7 
148.7 
587.8 
6.2 
     
Non-Core
36.7 
1.4 
28.0 
7.3 
     
               
Total
779.4 
150.1 
615.8 
13.5 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 101.

 
97

 
 
Notes (continued)


14. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Total 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
 
Total 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
                   
Loans and advances to banks
                 
- reverse repos
39.8 
39.8 
 
38.2 
38.2 
- collateral
25.3 
25.3 
 
25.1 
25.1 
- other
1.1 
0.4 
0.7 
 
1.0 
0.6 
0.4 
                   
 
66.2 
65.5 
0.7 
 
64.3 
63.9 
0.4 
                   
Loans and advances to customers
           
 
   
- reverse repos
49.0 
49.0 
 
41.1 
41.1 
- collateral
12.8 
12.8 
 
14.4 
14.4 
- other
5.8 
5.3 
0.5 
 
6.6 
6.2 
0.4 
                   
 
67.6 
67.1 
0.5 
 
62.1 
61.7 
0.4 
                   
Debt securities
                 
- government
135.0 
117.2 
17.8 
 
123.9 
110.2 
13.7 
- MBS (1)
53.3 
52.9 
0.4 
 
50.2 
49.5 
0.7 
- CDOs (2)
3.3 
0.9 
2.4 
 
3.4 
1.0 
2.4 
- CLOs (3)
5.5 
3.4 
2.1 
 
5.7 
3.6 
2.1 
- other ABS (4)
4.8 
3.6 
1.2 
 
5.4 
4.0 
1.4 
- corporate
6.8 
6.7 
0.1 
 
6.2 
5.9 
0.3 
- financial institutions
15.4 
0.1 
14.3 
1.0 
 
15.4 
0.1 
14.0 
1.3 
- other
0.5 
0.5 
 
0.2 
0.2 
                   
 
224.6 
117.3 
100.1 
7.2 
 
210.4 
110.3 
91.9 
8.2 
                   
Equity shares
22.2 
18.6 
2.6 
1.0 
 
22.2 
18.4 
2.8 
1.0 
                   
Derivatives
                 
- foreign exchange
73.6 
73.5 
0.1 
 
83.3 
83.2 
0.1 
- interest rate
259.0 
0.2 
257.4 
1.4 
 
311.7 
1.7 
308.3 
1.7 
- equities and commodities
5.7 
5.2 
0.5 
 
5.2 
0.1 
4.9 
0.2 
- credit - APS (5)
0.1 
0.1 
 
0.6 
0.6 
- credit - other
22.6 
20.0 
2.6 
 
26.3 
23.2 
3.1 
                   
 
361.0 
0.2 
356.1 
4.7 
 
427.1 
1.8 
419.6 
5.7 
                   
Total
741.6 
136.1 
591.4 
14.1 
 
786.1 
130.5 
639.9 
15.7 
                   
Proportion
100% 
18.4% 
79.7% 
1.9% 
 
100% 
16.6% 
81.4% 
2.0% 
                   
Of which
                 
Core
714.0 
134.9 
572.6 
6.5 
 
754.2 
129.4 
617.6 
7.2 
Non-Core
27.6 
1.2 
18.8 
7.6 
 
31.9 
1.1 
22.3 
8.5 
                   
Total
741.6 
136.1 
591.4 
14.1 
 
786.1 
130.5 
639.9 
15.7 

For the notes to this table refer to page 101.

 
98

 
 
Notes (continued)


14. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

The following table details AFS assets included within total assets on page 97.

 
30 June 2011
     
Level 3 Sensitivity (6)
 
Total 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Debt securities
             
  - government
65.5 
59.5 
6.0 
 
  - MBS (1)
33.7 
33.4 
0.3 
 
20 
 (10)
  - CDOs (2)
2.0 
0.5 
1.5 
 
90 
 (10)
  - CLOs (3)
4.2 
3.4 
0.8 
 
50 
 (10)
  - other ABS (4)
3.4 
2.4 
1.0 
 
50 
 (30)
  - corporate
1.9 
1.9 
 
  - financial institutions
8.0 
0.2 
7.8 
 
               
 
118.7 
59.7 
55.4 
3.6 
 
210 
 (60)
Equity shares
2.0 
0.3 
1.3 
0.4 
 
70 
 (80)
               
Total
120.7 
60.0 
56.7 
4.0 
 
280 
(140)
               
Of which
             
Core
111.3 
59.5 
50.8 
1.0 
     
Non-Core
9.4 
0.5 
5.9 
3.0 
     
               
Total
120.7 
60.0 
56.7 
4.0 
     


 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Total 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
 
Total 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
                   
Debt securities
                 
  - government
58.4 
51.3 
7.1 
 
59.4 
53.0 
6.4 
  - MBS (1)
33.0 
32.8 
0.2 
 
31.5 
31.1 
0.4 
  - CDOs (2)
1.9 
0.5 
1.4 
 
2.0 
0.6 
1.4 
  - CLOs (3)
4.4 
3.2 
1.2 
 
5.0 
3.5 
1.5 
  - other ABS (4)
3.6 
2.5 
1.1 
 
4.0 
2.9 
1.1 
  - corporate
1.8 
1.8 
 
1.4 
1.4 
  - financial institutions
8.0 
0.1 
7.9 
 
7.8 
0.1 
7.7 
                   
 
111.1 
51.4 
55.8 
3.9 
 
111.1 
53.1 
53.6 
4.4 
Equity shares
2.0 
0.3 
1.4 
0.3 
 
2.0 
0.3 
1.4 
0.3 
                   
Total
113.1 
51.7 
57.2 
4.2 
 
113.1 
53.4 
55.0 
4.7 
                   
Of which
                 
Core
103.7 
51.4 
51.4 
0.9 
 
103.0 
52.8 
49.2 
1.0 
Non-Core
9.4 
0.3 
5.8 
3.3 
 
10.1 
0.6 
5.8 
3.7 
                   
Total
113.1 
51.7 
57.2 
4.2 
 
113.1 
53.4 
55.0 
4.7 

For the notes to this table refer to page 101.

 
99

 
 
Notes (continued)


14. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
30 June 2011
     
Level 3 Sensitivity (6)
 
Total 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Liabilities
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Deposits by banks
             
  - repos
19.9 
19.9 
 
  - collateral
25.5 
25.5 
 
  - other
2.7 
2.7 
 
               
 
48.1 
48.1 
 
               
Customer accounts
             
  - repos
57.7 
57.7 
 
  - collateral
11.1 
11.1 
 
  - other
10.5 
10.4 
0.1 
 
50 
(50)
               
 
79.3 
79.2 
0.1 
 
50 
(50)
               
Debt securities in issue
52.9 
50.6 
2.3 
 
110 
(90)
               
Short positions
56.1 
44.2 
11.1 
0.8 
 
20 
(60)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
78.0 
77.6 
0.4 
 
20 
(20)
  - interest rate
269.7 
0.2 
269.2 
0.3 
 
20 
(30)
  - equities and commodities
9.2 
8.6 
0.6 
 
10 
(10)
  - credit - APS (5)
0.1 
0.1 
 
500 
(220)
  - credit - other
30.8 
29.7 
1.1 
 
40 
(100)
               
 
387.8 
0.2 
385.1 
2.5 
 
590 
(380)
               
Subordinated liabilities
1.1 
1.1 
 
               
Total
625.3 
44.4 
575.2 
5.7 
 
770 
(580)
               
Proportion
100% 
7.1% 
92.0% 
0.9% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
606.8 
44.4 
558.6 
3.8 
     
Non-Core
18.5 
16.6 
1.9 
     
               
Total
625.3 
44.4 
575.2 
5.7 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 101.

 
100

 
 
Notes (continued)


14. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Total 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
 
Total 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Liabilities
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
                   
Deposits by banks
                 
  - repos
24.2 
24.2 
 
20.6 
20.6 
  - collateral
23.6 
23.6 
 
26.6 
26.6 
  - other
1.6 
1.6 
 
1.6 
1.6 
                   
 
49.4 
49.4 
 
48.8 
48.8 
                   
Customer accounts
                 
  - repos
59.2 
59.2 
 
53.0 
53.0 
  - collateral
8.5 
8.5 
 
10.4 
10.4 
  - other
10.1 
10.0 
0.1 
 
8.8 
8.7 
0.1 
                   
 
77.8 
77.7 
0.1 
 
72.2 
72.1 
0.1 
                   
Debt securities in issue
53.1 
50.5 
2.6 
 
51.2 
49.0 
2.2 
                   
Short positions
50.1 
40.4 
8.8 
0.9 
 
43.1 
35.0 
7.3 
0.8 
                   
Derivatives
                 
  - foreign exchange
79.0 
78.7 
0.3 
 
89.4 
0.1 
89.3 
  - interest rate
250.5 
0.1 
249.9 
0.5 
 
299.2 
0.2 
298.0 
1.0 
  - equities and commodities
9.4 
8.7 
0.7 
 
10.1 
0.1 
9.6 
0.4 
  - credit
21.7 
21.4 
0.3 
 
25.3 
25.0 
0.3 
                   
 
360.6 
0.1 
358.7 
1.8 
 
424.0 
0.4 
421.9 
1.7 
                   
Subordinated liabilities
1.1 
1.1 
 
1.1 
1.1 
                   
Total
592.1 
40.5 
546.2 
5.4 
 
640.4 
35.4 
600.2 
4.8 
                   
Proportion
100% 
6.9% 
92.2% 
0.9% 
 
100% 
5.5% 
93.7% 
0.8% 
                   
Of which
                 
Core
581.1 
40.5 
536.2 
4.4 
 
626.1 
35.4 
586.9 
3.8 
Non-Core
11.0 
10.0 
1.0 
 
14.3 
13.3 
1.0 
                   
Total
592.1 
40.5 
546.2 
5.4 
 
640.4 
35.4 
600.2 
4.8 

Notes:
(1)
Mortgage-backed securities.
(2)
Collateralised debt obligations.
(3)
Collateralised loan obligations.
(4)
Asset-backed securities.
(5)
Asset Protection Scheme.
(6)
Sensitivity represents the reasonably possible favourable and unfavourable effect respectively on the income statement or the statement of comprehensive income due to reasonably possible changes to valuations using reasonably possible alternative inputs to the Group’s valuation techniques or models. The level 3 sensitivities are calculated at a sub-portfolio level and hence these aggregated figures do not reflect the correlation between some of the sensitivities.

 
101

 
 
Notes (continued)


14. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

30 June 2011 compared with 31 March 2011
·
Total assets carried at fair value increased by £37.8 billion to £779.4 billion. This principally reflected interest rate and credit derivatives (£34.9 billion) due to changes in market parameters and the effect of Non-Core hedging trades respectively and increases in government and US agency debt securities in GBM (£9.4 billion).
   
·
Total liabilities carried at fair value increased by £33.2 billion to £625.3 billion mainly in interest rate and credit derivatives (£28.3 billion) reflecting market parameter changes as well as increases in GBM’s sovereign short positions (£6.0 billion).
   
·
Level 3 assets decreased by £0.6 billion largely due to bond disposals. The APS derivative was a liability at 30 June 2011 compared with an asset of £81 million at 31 March 2011.
   
·
Level 3 liabilities increased by £0.3 billion primarily in Non-Core’s credit derivatives.

30 June 2011 compared with 31 December 2010
·
Total assets carried at fair value decreased by £6.7 billion in the period to £779.4 billion, with a decrease in derivatives of £32.2 billion mainly reflecting changes in market parameters and netting arrangements. This was partly offset by an increase in debt securities of £26.6 billion primarily reflecting GBM’s HFT sovereign bond holdings.
   
·
Total liabilities carried at fair value decreased by £15.1 billion to £625.3 billion, with a decrease in derivatives of £36.2 billion partly offset by increases in short positions (£13.0 billion) in GBM and, financial institution repos and other customer balances (£7.1 billion).
   
·
Level 3 assets decreased by £2.2 billion mainly reflecting bond disposals and transfers to level 2 based on improved observability. The APS derivative asset of £550 million at 31 December 2010 decreased to a liability of £87 million at 30 June 2011.
   
·
Level 3 liabilities have increased by £0.9 billion, primarily derivatives.
   
·
There were no significant transfers between level 1 and 2.
   
·
Favourable and unfavourable effects of reasonably possible alternative assumptions on level 3 instruments at 30 June 2011 were £2,150 million (31 December 2010 - £2,600 million) and £1,330 million (31 December 2010 - £2,180 million) respectively. These total sensitivities are an aggregation of portfolio level sensitivities and hence do not reflect the correlation between some of the sensitivities.
   
·
Net losses of £1.4 billion on level 3 derivative assets held at 30 June 2011 included:
·  the decrease in APS credit derivative (£0.6 billion);
·  Non-Core: relating to monolines, CDPCs and other exotic products in Structured Credit Products and other areas (£0.5 billion); and
·  GBM: various small amounts across businesses (£0.3 billion).

 
102

 

Notes (continued)


14. Financial instruments (continued)

Movement in level 3 portfolios

 
1 January 
 2011 
Gains or 
 losses (1)
Transfers 
in/(out) of 
level 3 
Purchases 
 and issues 
Sales and 
settlements 
FX (2) 
30 June 
 2011 
Gains/(losses)
relating to 
instruments 
held at 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Assets
               
Fair value through profit
  or loss:
               
Loans and advances
843 
75 
182 
67 
(78)
(15)
1,074 
83 
Debt securities
3,784 
121 
(466)
957 
(1,339)
(21)
3,036 
(15)
Equity shares
716 
(6)
83 
39 
(50)
784 
(10)
Derivatives
5,737 
(1,356)
96 
541 
(418)
(4)
4,596 
(1,422)
                 
 
11,080 
(1,166)
(105)
1,604 
(1,885)
(38)
9,490 
(1,364)
                 
AFS:
               
Debt securities
4,379 
143 
(624)
97 
(368)
3,633 
(92)
Equity shares
279 
31 
112 
(14)
(7)
408 
                 
 
4,658 
174 
(512)
104 
(382)
(1)
4,041 
(88)
                 
Total
15,738 
(992)
(617)
1,708 
(2,267)
(39)
13,531 
(1,452)
                 
Liabilities
               
Deposits
84 
17 
(8)
94 
17 
Debt securities in issue
2,203 
29 
(255)
578 
(345)
42 
2,252 
36 
Short positions
776 
(201)
67 
195 
(55)
782 
(200)
Derivatives
1,740 
(176)
208 
1,131 
(382)
10 
2,531 
(118)
Other
                 
Total
4,804 
(331)
12 
1,904 
(782)
53 
5,660 
(265)

Notes:
(1)
Net gains/(losses) recognised in the income statement and statement of comprehensive income during the period were (£921) million and £260 million respectively.
(2)
Foreign exchange movements.

 
103

 

Notes (continued)


15. Available-for-sale financial assets
The Q2 2011 movement in available-for-sale financial assets reflects the movement of £733 million losses on Greek government bonds and a £109 million related interest rate hedge adjustment to profit or loss from available-for-sale reserves. Offsetting this partially were realised gains from routine portfolio management in Group Treasury of £153 million, Non-Core of £31 million and UK Corporate of £16 million. In addition, unrealised gains on securities increased by £781 million in the quarter, primarily in relation to high quality sovereign bonds.

 
Quarter ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
Available-for-sale reserve
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
             
At beginning of period
(2,063)
(2,037)
(1,527)
 
(2,037)
(1,755)
Unrealised gains
781 
162 
119 
 
943 
647 
Realised losses/(gains)
626 
(197)
20 
 
429 
(127)
Tax
(370)
(55)
 
(361)
(208)
Recycled to profit or loss on disposal of businesses (1)
(16)
 
(16)
             
At end of period
(1,026)
(2,063)
(1,459)
 
(1,026)
(1,459)

Note:
(1)
Net of tax - £6 million credit.

As a result of the deterioration in Greece’s fiscal position and the announcement of the proposals to restructure Greek government debt, an impairment loss of £733 million has been recorded in respect of Greek government bonds, along with £109 million related interest rate hedge adjustments. Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain are facing less acute fiscal difficulties and the Group’s sovereign exposures to these countries were not considered impaired at 30 June 2011.

16. Contingent liabilities and commitments

 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Contingent liabilities
                     
Guarantees and assets pledged as collateral security
27,090 
1,703 
28,793 
 
26,849 
3,156 
30,005 
 
28,859 
2,242 
31,101 
Other contingent liabilities
11,883 
296 
12,179 
 
11,407 
469 
11,876 
 
11,833 
421 
12,254 
                       
 
38,973 
1,999 
40,972 
 
38,256 
3,625 
41,881 
 
40,692 
2,663 
43,355 
                       
Commitments
                     
Undrawn formal standby facilities, credit lines and other commitments to lend
233,795 
16,493 
250,288 
 
236,096 
18,460 
254,556 
 
245,425 
21,397 
266,822 
Other commitments
1,141 
2,315 
3,456 
 
953 
2,494 
3,447 
 
1,560 
2,594 
4,154 
                       
 
234,936 
18,808 
253,744 
 
237,049 
20,954 
258,003 
 
246,985 
23,991 
270,976 
                       
Total contingent liabilities and commitments
273,909 
20,807 
294,716 
 
275,305 
24,579 
299,884 
 
287,677 
26,654 
314,331 

Additional contingent liabilities arise in the normal course of the Group’s business. It is not anticipated that any material loss will arise from these transactions.

 
104

 
 
Notes (continued)


17. Litigation and Investigations

Litigation
As a participant in the financial services industry, the Group operates in a legal and regulatory environment that exposes it to potentially significant litigation risks. As a result, the Group and its members are involved in various disputes and legal proceedings in the United Kingdom, the United States and other jurisdictions, including litigation. Such cases are subject to many uncertainties, and their outcome is often difficult to predict, particularly in the earlier stages of a case.

Other than as set out in this note (excluding the sub-heading “Summary of other disputes, legal proceedings and litigation”), neither RBS nor any member of the Group is or has been involved in any governmental, legal or arbitration proceedings (including any such proceedings which are pending or threatened of which RBS is aware) during the 12 months prior to the date of this document which may have, or have had in the recent past, significant effects on the financial position or profitability of RBS and/or the Group taken as a whole.

Shareholder litigation
RBS and certain of its subsidiaries, together with certain current and former individual officers and directors have been named as defendants in class actions filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York. There are parallel proceedings involving holders of RBS preferred shares (the “Preferred Shares litigation”) and holders of American Depository Receipts (the “ADR claims”).

In the Preferred Shares litigation, the consolidated amended complaint alleges certain false and misleading statements and omissions in public filings and other communications during the period 1 March 2007 to 19 January 2009, and variously asserts claims under Sections 11, 12 and 15 of the US Securities Act of 1933. The putative class is composed of all persons who purchased or otherwise acquired the Group Series Q, R, S, T and/or U non-cumulative dollar preference shares issued pursuant or traceable to the 8 April 2005 US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) registration statement and were damaged thereby. Plaintiffs seek unquantified damages on behalf of the putative class. The defendants have moved to dismiss the complaint.  Briefing on this motion is expected to be completed by September 2011.

With respect to the ADR claims, a complaint was filed in January 2011 and a further complaint was filed in February 2011 asserting claims under Sections 10 and 20 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 on behalf of all persons who purchased or otherwise acquired the Group US American Depositary Receipts (“ADRs”) between 1 March 2007 and 19 January 2009. There is a motion pending to consolidate these cases, as well as various motions for appointment of lead plaintiff and counsel.

The Group has also received notification of similar prospective claims in the United Kingdom and elsewhere but no court proceedings have been commenced in relation to these claims.

The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to the remaining and prospective claims and will defend them vigorously. The Group cannot predict the outcome of these claims at this stage and is unable reliably to estimate the liability, if any, that might arise or its effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

 
105

 
 
Notes (continued)


17. Litigation and Investigations

Other securitisation and securities related litigation in the United States
Group companies have been named as defendants in their various roles as issuer, depositor and/or underwriter in a number of claims in the United States that relate to the securitisation and securities underwriting businesses. These cases include purported class action suits and actions by individual purchasers of securities. The cases involve the issuance of mortgage backed securities and/or collateralised debt obligations for more than $35 billion of securities issued by over one hundred securitisation trusts.  Although the allegations vary by claim, in general, plaintiffs in these actions claim that certain disclosures made in connection with the relevant offerings of such securities contained materially false or misleading statements and/or omissions regarding the underwriting standards pursuant to which the mortgage loans underlying the securities were issued.

In many of these actions, the Group has contractual rights to indemnification from the issuers of the securities (where a Group company is underwriter) and/or the underlying mortgage originator (where a Group company is issuer), but certain of those indemnity rights may prove effectively unenforceable where the issuers or originators are defunct or otherwise unable to perform.

Certain other institutional investors have threatened to assert claims against the Group in connection with various mortgage-related offerings. The Group cannot predict with any certainty whether any of these individual investors will pursue these threatened claims.

With respect to all of the mortgage-backed securities related claims, the Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to these claims and will continue to defend them vigorously. The Group cannot predict the outcome of these claims at this stage and is unable reliably to estimate the liability, if any, that may arise or its effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Madoff
In December 2010, Irving Picard, as trustee for the bankruptcy estates of Bernard L. Madoff and Bernard L. Madoff Investment Securities LLC filed a claim against RBS NV for $270 million. This is a clawback action similar to claims filed against six other institutions in December. RBS NV (or its subsidiaries) invested in Madoff funds through feeder funds. The Trustee alleges that RBS NV received $71 million in redemptions from the feeder funds and $200 million from its swap counterparties while RBS NV ‘knew or should have known of Madoff’s possible fraud’. The Trustee alleges that those transfers were preferences or fraudulent conveyances under the US bankruptcy code and New York law and he asserts the purported right to claw them back for the benefit of Madoff’s estate. The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to the claim and intends to defend it vigorously. The Group cannot predict the outcome of the claim at this stage and is unable reliably to estimate the liability, if any, that may arise or its effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

 
106

 
 
Notes (continued)


17. Litigation and investigations (continued)

Unarranged overdraft charges
In the US, Citizens Financial Group, in common with other US banks, has been named as a defendant in a class action asserting that Citizens charges excessive overdraft fees. The plaintiffs claim that overdraft fees resulting from point of sale and automated teller machine (ATM) transactions violate the duty of good faith implied in Citizens’ customer account agreement and constitute an unfair trade practice. The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to these claims and will defend them vigorously. The Group cannot predict the outcome of these claims at this stage and is unable reliably to estimate the liability, if any, that might arise or its effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR)
Certain members of the Group have been named as defendants in a number of class action claims filed in the US with respect to the setting of US dollar LIBOR. The complaints are substantially similar and allege, through various means, that certain members of the Group and other panel banks individually and collectively violated US commodities and antitrust laws and state common law by manipulating US dollar LIBOR and prices of US dollar LIBOR-based derivatives in various markets. The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to these and prospective claims. The Group cannot predict the outcome of these claims at this stage and is unable reliably to estimate the liability, if any, that might arise or its effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Summary of other disputes, legal proceedings and litigation
Members of the Group are engaged in other litigation in the United Kingdom and a number of overseas jurisdictions, including the United States, involving claims by and against them arising in the ordinary course of business. The Group has reviewed these other actual, threatened and known potential claims and proceedings and, after consulting with its legal advisers, does not expect that the outcome of any of these other claims and proceedings will have a significant effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.
 
 
Investigations
The Group’s businesses and financial condition can be affected by the fiscal or other policies and other actions of various governmental and regulatory authorities in the United Kingdom, the European Union, the United States and elsewhere. The Group has engaged, and will continue to engage, in discussions with relevant regulators, including in the United Kingdom and the United States, on an ongoing and regular basis regarding operational, systems and control evaluations and issues including those related to compliance with applicable anti-bribery, anti-money laundering and sanctions regimes. It is possible that any matters discussed or identified may result in investigatory or other action being taken by the regulators, increased costs being incurred by the Group, remediation of systems and controls, public or private censure, restriction of the Group’s business activities or fines. Any of these events or circumstances could have a significant effect on the Group, its business, authorisations and licences, reputation, results of operations or the price of securities issued by it.

Political and regulatory scrutiny of the operation of retail banking and consumer credit industries in the United Kingdom and elsewhere continues. The nature and impact of future changes in policies and regulatory action are not predictable and are beyond the Group’s control but could have a significant effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

 
107

 
 
Notes (continued)


17. Litigation and investigations (continued)

Retail banking
In the European Union, regulatory actions included an inquiry into retail banking initiated on 13 June 2005 in all of the then 25 member states by the European Commission’s Directorate General for Competition. The inquiry examined retail banking in Europe generally. On 31 January 2007, the European Commission (“EC”) announced that barriers to competition in certain areas of retail banking, payment cards and payment systems in the European Union had been identified. The EC indicated that it will consider using its powers to address these barriers and will encourage national competition authorities to enforce European and national competition laws where appropriate. In addition, in late 2010, the EC launched an initiative pressing for increased transparency of bank fees. The Group cannot predict the outcome of these actions at this stage and  is unable reliably to estimate the effect, if any, that these may have on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Multilateral interchange fees
In 2007, the EC issued a decision that while interchange is not illegal per se, MasterCard’s current multilateral interchange fee (MIF) arrangements for cross border payment card transactions with MasterCard and Maestro branded consumer credit and debit cards in the European Union are in breach of competition law. MasterCard was required by the decision to withdraw the relevant cross-border MIF (i.e. set these fees to zero) by 21 June 2008.

MasterCard appealed against the decision to the European Court of First Instance (subsequently re-named the General Court) on 1 March 2008, and the Group has intervened in the appeal proceedings. In addition, in summer 2008, MasterCard announced various changes to its scheme arrangements. The EC was concerned that these changes might be used as a means of circumventing the requirements of the infringement decision. In April 2009, MasterCard agreed an interim settlement on the level of cross-border MIF with the EC pending the outcome of the appeal process and, as a result, the EC has advised it will no longer investigate the non-compliance issue (although MasterCard is continuing with its appeal). The appeal was heard on 8 July 2011 by the General Court and judgment is awaited.

Visa’s cross-border MIFs were exempted in 2002 by the EC for a period of five years up to 31 December 2007 subject to certain conditions. On 26 March 2008, the EC opened a formal inquiry into Visa’s current MIF arrangements for cross border payment card transactions with Visa branded debit and consumer credit cards in the European Union and on 6 April 2009 the EC announced that it had issued Visa with a formal Statement of Objections. At the same time Visa announced changes to its interchange levels and introduced some changes to enhance transparency. There is no deadline for the closure of the inquiry. However, on 26 April 2010 Visa announced it had reached an agreement with the EC as regards immediate cross border debit card MIF rates only and in December 2010 the commitments were finalised for a four year period commencing December 2010 under Article 9 of Regulation 1/2003. The EC is continuing its investigations into Visa’s cross border MIF arrangements for deferred debit and credit transactions.

 
108

 
 
Notes (continued)


17. Litigation and investigations (continued)

Multilateral interchange fees (continued)
In the UK, the Office of Fair Trading (“OFT”) has carried out investigations into Visa and MasterCard domestic credit card interchange rates. The decision by the OFT in the MasterCard interchange case was set aside by the Competition Appeal Tribunal (the CAT) in June 2006. The OFT’s investigations in the Visa interchange case and a second MasterCard interchange case are ongoing. On 9 February 2007, the OFT announced that it was expanding its investigation into domestic interchange rates to include debit cards. In January 2010 the OFT advised that it did not anticipate issuing a Statement of Objections prior to the European General Court’s judgment, although it has reserved the right to do so if it considers it appropriate.

The outcome of these investigations is not known, but they may have a significant effect on the consumer credit industry in general and, therefore, on the Group’s business in this sector. Accordingly, the Group is unable reliably to estimate the effect, if any, which these investigations may have on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Payment Protection Insurance
Having conducted a market study relating to Payment Protection Insurance (PPI), on 7 February 2007 the OFT referred the PPI market to the Competition Commission (CC) for an in-depth inquiry. The CC published its final report on 29 January 2009 and announced its intention to order a range of remedies, including a prohibition on actively selling PPI at point of sale of the credit product (and for 7 days thereafter), a ban on single premium policies and other measures to increase transparency (in order to improve customers’ ability to search and improve price competition). Barclays Bank PLC subsequently appealed certain CC findings to the CAT. On 16 October 2009, the CAT handed down a judgment remitting the matter back to the CC for review. Following further review, on 14 October 2010, the CC published its final decision on remedies following the remittal which confirmed the point of sale prohibition. On 24 March 2011, the CC made a final order with a commencement date of 6 April 2011. The key measures will come into force in October 2011 and April 2012.

The Financial Services Authority (FSA) conducted a broad industry thematic review of PPI sales practices and in September 2008, the FSA announced that it intended to escalate its level of regulatory intervention. Substantial numbers of customer complaints alleging the mis-selling of PPI policies have been made to banks and to the Financial Ombudsman Service (FOS) and many of these are being upheld by the FOS against the banks.

Following unsuccessful negotiations with the industry, the FSA issued consultation papers on PPI complaint handling and redress in September 2009 and again in March 2010. The FSA published its  final policy statement on 10 August 2010 and instructed firms to implement the measures contained in it by 1 December 2010. The new rules impose significant changes with respect to the handling of mis-selling PPI complaints. On 8 October 2010, the British Bankers’ Association (BBA) filed an application for judicial review of the FSA’s policy statement and of related guidance issued by the FOS. The application was heard in January 2011. On 20 April 2011 the High Court issued judgment in favour of the FSA and the FOS.  The BBA announced on 9 May 2011 that it would not appeal that judgment. The Group supports this position. The Group has recorded an additional provision of £850 million in the second quarter of 2011, supplementing its existing provision of approximately £100 million.

 
109

 
 
Notes (continued)


17. Litigation and investigations (continued)

Payment Protection Insurance (continued)
The Group has now reached agreement with the FSA on a process for implementation of the FSA’s policy statement and for the future handling of PPI complaints to ensure that redress is offered to any customers identified as having suffered detriment.

Personal current accounts
On 16 July 2008, the OFT published the results of its market study into Personal Current Accounts (“PCAs”) in the United Kingdom. The OFT found evidence of competition and several positive features in the personal current account market but believed that the market as a whole was not working well for consumers and that the ability of the market to function well had become distorted.

On 7 October 2009, the OFT published a follow-up report summarising the initiatives agreed between the OFT and personal current account providers to address the OFT’s concerns about transparency and switching, following its market study. Personal current account providers will take a number of steps to improve transparency, including providing customers with an annual summary of the cost of their account and making charges prominent on monthly statements. To improve the switching process, a number of steps are being introduced following work with Bacs (formerly Bankers’ Automated Clearing Services), the payment processor, including measures to reduce the impact on consumers of any problems with transferring direct debits.

On 22 December 2009, the OFT published a further report in which it stated that it continued to have significant concerns about the operation of the personal current account market in the United Kingdom, in particular in relation to unarranged overdrafts, and that it believed that fundamental changes are required for the market to work in the best interests of bank customers. The OFT stated that it would discuss these issues intensively with banks, consumer groups and other organisations, with the aim of reporting on progress by the end of March 2010. On 16 March 2010, the OFT announced that it had secured agreement from the banks on four industry-wide initiatives, namely minimum standards on the operation of opt-outs from unarranged overdrafts, new working groups on information sharing with customers, best practice for PCA customers in financial difficulties and incurring charges, and PCA providers to publish their policies on dealing with PCA customers in financial difficulties. The OFT also announced its plan to conduct six-monthly ongoing reviews, fully to review the market again in 2012 and to undertake a brief analysis on barriers to entry.

The first six-monthly ongoing review was completed in September 2010. The OFT noted progress in the areas of switching, transparency and unarranged overdrafts for the period March to September 2010, as well as highlighting further changes the OFT expects to see in the market. On 29 March 2011, the OFT published its update report in relation to personal current accounts. This noted further progress in improving consumer control over the use of unarranged overdrafts. In particular, the Lending Standards Board has led on producing standards and guidance to be included in a revised Lending Code published on 31 March 2011. The OFT will continue to monitor the market and will consider the need for, and appropriate timing of, further update reports in light of other developments, in particular the work of the Independent Commission on Banking. The OFT intends to conduct a more comprehensive review of the market in 2012.

 
110

 

Notes (continued)

 
17. Litigation and investigations (continued)

Personal current accounts (continued)
On 26 May 2010, the OFT announced its review of barriers to entry. The review concerns retail banking for individuals and small and medium size enterprises (up to £25 million turnover) and will look at products which require a banking licence to sell mortgages, loan products and, where appropriate, other products such as insurance or credit cards where cross-selling may facilitate entry or expansion. The OFT published its report in November 2010. It advised that it expected its review to be relevant to the Independent Commission on Banking, the FSA, HM Treasury and the Department for Business, Innovation and Skills and to the devolved governments in the United Kingdom. The OFT has not indicated whether it will undertake any further work. The report maintained that barriers to entry remain, in particular regarding switching, branch networks and brands. At this stage, it is not possible to estimate the effect of the OFT’s report and recommendations regarding barriers to entry upon the Group.

Equity underwriting
On 6 August 2010, the OFT launched a market study into equity underwriting and related services. The OFT looked at the way that the market works and in particular: (i) how underwriting services are purchased; (ii) how underwriting services are provided; and (iii) how the regulatory environment affects the provision of underwriting services. On 27 January 2011 the OFT published its market study report.  The OFT decided not to refer the market to the CC (this decision was confirmed on 17 May 2011 following a public consultation) but identified certain concerns around the level of equity underwriting fees. The OFT therefore identified a number of options which would enable companies and institutional shareholders to address these concerns and allow them to drive greater competition in the market.  It is not possible to estimate with any certainty what effect this development and any related developments may have on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Independent Commission on Banking
On 16 June 2010, HM Treasury published the terms of reference for the Government’s Independent Commission on Banking (“ICB”). The ICB is considering the structure of the United Kingdom banking sector and is looking at structural and non-structural measures to reform the banking system and to promote competition. It is mandated to formulate policy recommendations with a view to: (i) reducing systemic risk in the banking sector, exploring the risk posed by banks of different size, scale and function; (ii) mitigating moral hazard in the banking system; (iii) reducing the likelihood and impact of a bank’s failure; and (iv) promoting competition in retail and investment banking with a view to ensuring that the needs of banks’ customers are served efficiently and considering the extent to which large banks can gain competitive advantage from being perceived as “too big to fail”. The ICB reports to the Cabinet Committee on Banking Reform and will issue a final report on 12 September 2011. The interim report published on 11 April 2011 (the “Interim Report”) set out the ICB’s provisional views on possible reforms and sought responses to those views.  Reform options for stability include additional capital and the ring-fencing of retail banking operations (on a basis yet to be defined). Reform options for competition include structural measures to improve competition, improved means of switching and transparency and a primary duty for the Financial Conduct Authority to promote effective competition.  The Interim Report also supported the introduction of rules as to contingent capital, bail-in debt and depositor preferences.

 
111

 
 
Notes (continued)


17. Litigation and investigations (continued)

Independent Commission on Banking (continued)
The Group has responded to the Interim Report and set out its views on the reform options outlined in that Report. The Group will continue to participate in the debate and to consult with the ICB during the coming weeks and with the UK Government thereafter. Prior to the publication of a final report by the ICB it is not possible to estimate the effect of the ICB’s report and recommendations upon the Group but they could have a negative impact on its consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

US dollar clearing activities
In May 2010, following a criminal investigation by the United States Department of Justice (“DoJ”) into its dollar clearing activities, Office of Foreign Assets Control compliance procedures and other Bank Secrecy Act compliance matters, RBS NV formally entered into a Deferred Prosecution Agreement (DPA) with the DoJ resolving the investigation. The investigation was in relation to activities before the Consortium Members acquired ABN AMRO Holding N.V. (now known as RBS Holdings N.V.). The agreement was signed by RBS NV and is binding on that entity and its subsidiaries. Pursuant to the DPA, RBS NV paid a penalty of US$500 million and agreed that it will comply with the terms of the DPA and continue to co-operate fully with any further investigations. Payment of the penalty was made from a provision established in April 2007 when an agreement in principle to settle was first announced. At the joint request of the DoJ and RBS NV, in order to allow RBS NV sufficient time to fulfil its obligations, the U.S. District Court, on 6 April 2011, extended the duration of the DPA until 31 December 2011. Upon satisfaction of the conditions of the DPA within that period the matter will be fully resolved. Failure to comply with the terms of the DPA during this period could result in the DoJ recommencing its investigations, the outcome of which would be uncertain and could result in public censure and fines or have an adverse effect on RBS Holdings N.V.’s operations, any of which could have a material adverse effect on its consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Securitisation and collateralised debt obligation business
In September and October 2010, the SEC requested voluntary production of information concerning residential mortgage-backed securities underwritten by subsidiaries of RBS during the period from September 2006 to July 2007 inclusive. In November 2010, the SEC commenced formal proceedings and requested testimony from the Group employees. The investigation is in its preliminary stages and it is difficult to predict any potential exposure that may result.

Also in October 2010, the SEC commenced an inquiry into document deficiencies and repurchase requests with respect to certain securitisations, and in January 2011, this was converted to a formal investigation. Among other matters, the investigation seeks information related to document deficiencies and remedial measures taken with respect to such deficiencies. The investigation also seeks information related to early payment defaults and loan repurchase requests. The Group is fully co-operating with this investigation.

In June 2009, in connection with an investigation into the role of investment banks in the origination and securitisation of sub-prime loans in Massachusetts, the Massachusetts Attorney General issued subpoenas to various banks, including an RBS subsidiary, seeking information related to residential mortgage lending practices and sales and securitisation of residential mortgage loans. This investigation is ongoing and the Group is co-operating.

 
112

 
 
Notes (continued)


17. Litigation and investigations (continued)

Securitisation and collateralised debt obligation business (continued)
Previously, in 2008, the New York State Attorney General issued subpoenas to a wide array of participants in the securitisation and securities industry, focusing on the information underwriters obtained as part of the due diligence process from the independent due diligence firms. The Group completed its production of documents requested by the New York State Attorney General in 2009, principally producing documents related to loans that were pooled into one securitisation transaction. In May 2011, at the New York State Attorney General's request, representatives of the Group attended an informal meeting to provide additional information about the Group's mortgage securitisation business.  The investigation is ongoing and the Group is cooperating.  It is difficult to predict the potential exposure from this investigation.

In September 2010, RBS subsidiaries received a request from the Nevada State Attorney General requesting information related to securitisations of mortgages issued by three specific originators. The investigation by the Nevada State Attorney General is in the early stages and therefore it is difficult to predict the potential exposure from any such investigation. RBS and its subsidiaries are co-operating with these various investigations and requests. At this stage it is not possible to estimate the effect of the matters discussed in this section headed “Securitisation and collateralised debt obligation business” upon the Group, if any.

US mortgages
The Group’s Global Banking & Markets N.A. (“GBM N.A.”), has been a purchaser of non-agency US residential mortgages in the secondary market, and an issuer and underwriter of non-agency residential mortgage-backed securities (“RMBS”). GBM N.A. did not originate or service any US residential mortgages and it was not a significant seller of mortgage loans to government sponsored enterprises (“GSEs”) (e.g., the Federal National Mortgage Association and the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Association).

In issuing RMBS, GBM N.A. generally assigned certain representations and warranties regarding the characteristics of the underlying loans made by the originator of the residential mortgages; however, in some circumstances, GBM N.A. made such representations and warranties itself. Where GBM N.A. has given those or other representations and warranties (whether relating to underlying loans or otherwise), GBM N.A. may be contractually required to repurchase such loans or indemnify certain parties against losses for certain breaches of such representations and warranties. In certain instances where it is required to repurchase loans or related securities, GBM N.A. may be able to assert claims against third parties who provided representations or warranties to GBM N.A. when selling loans to it; although the ability to make recoveries against such parties and outcome of such claims would be uncertain. During the two and a half year period ended 30 June 2011, GBM N.A. has received approximately US$48 million in repurchase demands in respect of loans made and related securities sold where obligations in respect of contractual representations or warranties were undertaken by GBM N.A. However, repurchase demands presented to GBM N.A. are subject to challenge and, to date, GBM N.A. has rebutted a significant percentage of these claims.

 
113

 

Notes (continued)


17. Litigation and investigations (continued)

US mortgages (continued)
Citizens Financial Group (CFG) has not been an issuer or underwriter of non-agency RMBS. However, CFG is an originator and servicer of residential mortgages, and it routinely sells such mortgage loans in the secondary market and to GSEs. In the context of such sales, CFG makes certain representations and warranties regarding the characteristics of the underlying loans and, as a result, may be contractually required to repurchase such loans or indemnify certain parties against losses for certain breaches of the representations and warranties concerning the underlying loans. During the two and a half year period ended 30 June 2011, CFG has received approximately US$28.7 million in repurchase demands in respect of loans originated. However, repurchase demands presented to CFG are subject to challenge and, to date, CFG has rebutted a significant percentage of these claims.

Although there has been disruption in the ability of certain financial institutions operating in the United States to complete foreclosure proceedings in respect of US mortgage loans in a timely manner (or at all) over the last year (including as a result of interventions by certain states and local governments), to date, CFG has not been materially impacted by such disruptions and the Group has not ceased making foreclosures.

The Group cannot estimate what the future level of repurchase demands or ultimate exposure of GBM N.A. or CFG may be, and cannot give any assurance that the historical experience will continue in the future. Furthermore, the Group is unable to estimate the extent to which the matters described above will impact it and future developments may have an adverse impact on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

LIBOR
The Group has received requests from various regulators, including the US Commodity Futures Trading Commission, the US Department of Justice and the European Commission, seeking documents and communications related to the process and procedures for setting LIBOR and other interest rates, together with related trading information. The Group is co-operating with these investigations and is keeping relevant regulators informed. It is not possible to estimate with any certainty what effect these investigations and any related developments may have on the Group.

Other investigations
The Federal Reserve and state banking supervisors have been reviewing the Group's US operations and RBS and its subsidiaries have been required to make improvements with respect to various matters, including enterprise-wide governance, Bank Secrecy Act and anti-money laundering compliance, risk management and asset quality. The Group is in the process of implementing measures for matters identified to date. The Group may become subject to formal and informal supervisory actions and may be required by its US banking supervisors to take further actions and implement additional remedial measures with respect to these and additional matters. Any limitations or conditions placed on the Group's activities in the United States, as well as the terms of any supervisory action applicable to RBS and its subsidiaries, could have a material adverse effect on the Group's consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

 
114

 
 
Notes (continued)


17. Litigation and investigations (continued)

Other investigations (continued)
On 27 July 2011, the Group consented to the issuance of a Cease and Desist Order (“the Order”) setting forth measures required to address deficiencies related to governance, risk management and compliance systems and controls identified by the Federal Reserve and state banking supervisors during examinations of the RBS plc and RBS N.V. branches in the United States in 2010. The Order requires the Group to strengthen its US corporate governance structure, to develop an enterprise-wide risk management programme, and to develop and enhance its programmes to ensure compliance with US law, particularly the US Bank Secrecy Act and anti-money laundering laws, rules and regulations. The Group has established a strategic and remedial programme of change to address the identified concerns and is committed to working closely with the US bank regulators to implement the remedial measures required by the Order.

The Group’s operations include businesses outside the United States that are responsible for processing US dollar payments. The Group is conducting a review of its policies, procedures and practices in respect of such payments and has initiated discussions with UK and US authorities to discuss its historical compliance with applicable laws and regulations, including US economic sanctions regulations. Although the Group cannot currently determine when the review of its operations will be completed or what the outcome of its discussions with UK and US authorities will be, the investigation costs, remediation required or liability incurred could have a material adverse impact on the Group’s business, results of operations or value of the Securities.

In April 2009, the FSA notified the Group that it was commencing a supervisory review of the acquisition of ABN AMRO in 2007 and the 2008 capital raisings and an investigation into conduct, systems and controls within the Global Banking & Markets division of the Group. RBS and its subsidiaries co-operated fully with this review and investigation. On 2 December 2010, the FSA confirmed that it had completed its investigation and had concluded that no enforcement action, either against the Group or against individuals, was warranted. The Group is engaging constructively with the FSA with regard to the publication of a report by the FSA relating to the supervisory review, subject to any necessary commercial constraints.

In July 2010, the FSA notified the Group that it was commencing an investigation into the sale by Coutts & Co of the ALICO (American Life Insurance Company) Premier Access Bond Enhanced Variable Rate Fund to customers between 2001 and 2008 as well as its subsequent review of those sales. On 11 January 2011 the FSA amended the date range on which their investigation is focused and the investigation start date is now December 2003. RBS and its subsidiaries are co-operating fully with this investigation.

In the United States, RBS and certain subsidiaries have received requests for information from various governmental agencies, self-regulatory organisations, and state governmental agencies including in connection with sub-prime mortgages and securitisations, collateralised debt obligations and synthetic products related to sub-prime mortgages. In particular, during March 2008, the Group was advised by the SEC that it had commenced a non-public, formal investigation relating to the Group’s United States sub-prime securities exposures and United States residential mortgage exposures. RBS and its subsidiaries are co-operating with these various requests for information and investigations. In December 2010, the SEC contacted the Group and indicated that it would also examine valuations of various RBS N.V. structured products, including Collateralised Debt Obligations (CDOs).

 
115

 
 
Notes (continued)


18. Other developments

Proposed transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to The Royal Bank of Scotland plc (RBS plc) 
On 19 April 2011, the Group announced its intention to transfer a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS plc (the "Proposed Transfers"), subject, amongst other matters, to regulatory and other approvals, further tax and other analysis in respect of the assets and liabilities to be transferred and employee consultation procedures.

The Proposed Transfers will streamline the manner in which the GBM and GTS businesses of the Group interact with clients with simplified access to the GBM and GTS product suites. 

It is expected that the Proposed Transfers will be implemented on a phased basis over a period ending 31 December 2013. A large part of the Proposed Transfers (including the transfers of certain securities issued by RBS N.V.) is expected to have taken place by the end of 2012.

Rating agencies
RBS and RBS plc's long-term and short-term ratings have remained unchanged in the quarter. On 9 March 2011, Standard & Poor's affirmed the A+ counterparty rating of RBS plc and upgraded its standalone credit profile to a- from bbb+. The agency highlighted that they expect RBS plc's standalone credit profile to move toward the A+ counterparty rating by 2012 if continued progress is made, following the strategic plan. The counterparty rating contains 2 notches of uplift to account for the systemic importance of the Group. On 29 June 2011, Fitch affirmed the AA- Issuer Default Rating of RBS plc and RBS and also upgraded the individual rating to C from C/D.  Fitch noted the significant progress RBS made in implementing its strategic plan and improving its funding and liquidity profile.  Further to this, on 20 July 2011 Fitch changed its individual rating methodology for financial institutions, moving from an 'A to E' scale to a viability rating on a more familiar scale (aaa, aa+ etc).  It was announced that RBS plc had an assigned viability rating of bbb. On 24 May 2011 Moody's placed the long term rating of RBS and several of its primary operating subsidiaries on review for possible downgrade following Moody's reassessment of extraordinary levels of systemic support in its ratings of UK financial institutions. This review is due to conclude following the publication of the final Independent Commission on Banking report in September.

Gender equality in insurance contracts
On 1 March 2011, the European Court of Justice (ECJ) upheld a ruling that insurers are no longer allowed to use gender as a rating factor across the insurance industry. This will have a significant impact on the insurance industry in calculating premiums and determining benefits. The Group is currently working through the findings, and any consequences arising will be rectified by December 2012 in line with the ruling from the ECJ. At this stage, while it is not possible reliably to estimate the impact which the ECJ's ruling may have on the Group's financial position or profitability, it is not expected to be material.

 
116

 
 
Notes (continued)


19. Related party transactions
Related party transactions in the half year ended 30 June 2011 were similar in nature to those for the year ended 31 December 2010.

Full details of the Group’s related party transactions for the year ended 31 December 2010 are included in the Group’s 2010 Form 20-F.

20. Post balance sheet events
There have been no significant events between 30 June 2011 and the date of approval of this announcement which would require a change to or additional disclosure in the announcement.
 
21. Consolidating financial information
The Royal Bank of Scotland plc ("RBS plc") is a wholly owned subsidiary of The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc ("RBSG plc") and is able to offer and sell certain securities in the US from time to time pursuant to a registration statement on Form F-3 filed with the SEC with a full and unconditional guarantee from RBSG plc. RBS plc utilises an exception provided in Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X, and therefore does not file its financial statements with the SEC. In accordance with the requirements to qualify for the exception, presented below is condensed consolidating financial information for:

-
RBSG plc on a stand-alone basis as guarantor
-
RBS plc on a stand-alone basis as issuer
-
Non-guarantor Subsidiaries of RBSG plc and RBS plc on a combined basis ("Subsidiaries")
-
Consolidation adjustments; and
-
RBSG plc consolidated amounts ("RBSG Group").

Under IAS 27, RBSG plc and RBS plc account for investments in their subsidiary undertakings at cost less impairment. Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X requires a company to account for its investments in subsidiary undertakings using the equity method, which would increase/(decrease) the results for the period of RBSG plc and RBS plc in the information below by £(1,654) million and £(1,349) million respectively for the six months ended 30 June 2011 (£204 million and £(1,060) million for the six months ended 30 June 2010). The net assets of RBSG plc and RBS plc in the information below would also be increased/(decreased) by £15,098 million and £7,973 million respectively at 30 June 2011 (£15,908 million and £9,466 million at 31 December 2010). The RBSG Group amounts in the tables below do not include amounts attributable to non-controlling interests.

Income statement
 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
For the six months ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Net interest income
261 
2,131 
4,097 
39 
6,528 
Non-interest income (excluding insurance net premium income)
54 
4,527 
2,306 
(358)
6,529 
Insurance net premium income
2,239 
2,239 
Total income
315 
6,658 
8,642 
(319)
15,296 
           
Operating expenses
(4,302)
(5,159)
129 
(9,332)
Insurance net claims
(1,705)
(1,705)
Impairment losses
(571)
(4,384)
(98)
(5,053)
Operating profit/(loss) before tax
315 
1,785 
(2,606)
(288)
(794)
Tax
(86)
(563)
(100)
104 
(645)
Profit/(loss)from continuing operations
229 
1,222 
(2,706)
(184)
(1,439)
Profit from discontinued operations, net of tax
31 
31 
Profit/(loss)for the period
229 
1,222 
(2,675)
(184)
(1,408)
 
 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
For the six months ended 30 June 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Net interest income
198 
2,032 
5,308 
(320)
7,218 
Non-interest income (excluding insurance net premium income)
(237)
6,183 
1,629 
600 
8,175 
Insurance net premium income
2,567 
2,567 
Total income
(39)
8,215 
9,504 
280 
17,960 
           
Operating expenses
(3,857)
(5,538)
225 
(9,170)
Insurance net claims
(2,459)
(2,459)
Impairment losses
(1,674)
(3,495)
(5,162)
Operating (loss)/profit before tax
(39)
2,684 
(1,988)
512 
1,169 
Tax
(32)
(844)
(128)
72 
(932)
(Loss)/profit from continuing operations
(71)
1,840 
(2,116)
584 
237 
Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax
(680)
(26)
(706)
(Loss)/profit for the period
(71)
1,840
(2,796)
558 
(469)
 
 
 
117

 
 
Balance sheets
 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
At 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Assets
         
Cash and balances at central banks
47,322 
17,029 
64,351 
Loans and advances to banks
19,097 
98,770 
349,884 
(372,645)
95,106 
Loans and advances to customers
8,705 
361,690 
334,954 
(159,615)
545,734 
Debt securities
1,522 
201,468 
119,079 
(78,424)
243,645 
Equity shares
1,026 
24,715 
(790)
24,951 
Investments in Group undertakings
49,238 
29,982 
12,107 
(91,327)
Settlement balances
12,041 
12,433 
92 
24,566 
Derivatives
987 
399,911 
29,684 
(35,710)
394,872 
Intangible assets
620 
7,042 
6,930 
14,592 
Property, plant and equipment
2,288 
15,078 
(9)
17,357 
Deferred tax
735 
5,114 
394 
6,245 
Prepayments, accrued income and other assets
26 
4,192 
12,515 
(5,590)
11,143 
Assets of disposal groups
853 
2,491 
63 
3,407 
Total assets
79,577 
1,160,898 
942,125 
(736,631)
1,445,969 
           
Liabilities
         
Deposits by banks
201,823 
235,108 
(329,977)
106,954 
Customer accounts
973 
311,972 
387,746 
(183,166)
517,525 
Debt securities in issue
10,139 
127,776 
153,190 
(77,308)
213,797 
Settlement balances
10,125 
12,780 
22,905 
Short positions
32,692 
24,572 
(1,158)
56,106 
Derivatives
19 
389,365 
34,186 
(35,761)
387,809 
Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities
1,129 
8,714 
18,880 
(4,658)
24,065 
Retirement benefit liabilities
23 
787 
1,429 
2,239 
Deferred tax
2,386 
(294)
2,092 
Insurance liabilities
6,722 
(35)
6,687 
Subordinated liabilities
7,671 
28,951 
9,422 
(19,733)
26,311 
Liabilities of disposal groups
398 
2,839 
3,237 
Total liabilities
19,931 
1,111,839 
888,618 
(650,661)
1,369,727 
Non-controlling interests
1,915 
(417)
1,498 
Equity owners
59,646 
49,059 
51,592 
(85,553)
74,744 
           
Total equity
59,646 
49,059 
53,507 
(85,970)
76,242 
           
Total liabilities and equity
79,577 
1,160,898 
942,125 
(736,631)
1,445,969 

 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
At 31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Assets
         
Cash and balances at central banks
44,921 
12,093 
57,014 
Loans and advances to banks
19,535 
100,965 
343,198 
(363,180)
100,518 
Loans and advances to customers
6,689 
349,179 
340,881 
(141,489)
555,260 
Debt securities
1,454 
189,208 
106,684 
(79,866)
217,480 
Equity shares
1,016 
21,982 
(800)
22,198 
Investments in Group undertakings
49,125 
27,504 
12,119 
(88,748)
Settlement balances
3,529 
8,068 
11,605 
Derivatives
1,475 
432,812 
35,230 
(42,440)
427,077 
Intangible assets
443 
7,060 
6,945 
14,448 
Property, plant and equipment
2,301 
14,247 
(5)
16,543 
Deferred tax
794 
5,161 
416 
6,373 
Prepayments, accrued income and other assets
28 
4,760 
9,696 
(1,908)
12,576 
Assets of disposal groups
4,765 
7,719 
12,484 
Total assets
78,308 
1,162,197 
924,138 
(711,067)
1,453,576 
           
Liabilities
         
Deposits by banks
197,973 
207,685 
(306,868)
98,790 
Customer accounts
1,029 
295,358 
392,733 
(178,427)
510,693 
Debt securities in issue
8,742 
128,073 
161,006 
(79,449)
218,372 
Settlement balances
3,343 
7,648 
10,991 
Short positions
25,687 
17,862 
(431)
43,118 
Derivatives
231 
424,503 
41,673 
(42,440)
423,967 
Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities
1,034 
8,058 
14,603 
(606)
23,089 
Retirement benefit liabilities
23 
796 
1,469 
2,288 
Deferred tax
2,415 
(273)
2,142 
Insurance liabilities
6,829 
(35)
6,794 
Subordinated liabilities
8,048 
29,299 
9,932 
(20,226)
27,053 
Liabilities of disposal groups
2,336 
7,092 
9,428 
Total liabilities
19,084 
1,114,653 
870,274 
(627,286)
1,376,725 
Non-controlling interests
1,616 
103 
1,719 
Equity owners
59,224 
47,544 
52,248 
(83,884)
75,132 
           
Total equity
59,224 
47,544 
53,864 
(83,781)
76,851 
           
Total liabilities and equity
78,308 
1,162,197 
924,138 
(711,067)
1,453,576 
 
 
118

 

 
Cash Flow Statements
 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
For the six months ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Net cash flows from operating activities
(455)
3,899 
11,101 
(6,293)
8,252 
Net cash flows from investing activities
193 
(3,064)
(3,686)
2,195 
(4,362)
Net cash flows from financing activities
(453)
(870)
1,612 
(1,501)
(1,212)
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
58 
1,009 
(1,099)
514 
482 
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents
(657)
974 
7,928 
(5,085)
3,160 
           
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the period
2,357 
114,379 
169,284 
(133,490)
152,530 
           
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the period
1,700 
115,353 
177,212 
(138,575)
155,690 

 
 
 
119

 
 
Cash Flow Statements
 
RBSG
plc
RBS
plc
Subsidiaries
Consolidation
adjustments
RBSG
Group
For the six months ended 30 June 2010
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
           
Net cash flows from operating activities
(14,834)
11,274 
6,955 
(13,816)
(10,421)
Net cash flows from investing activities
11,859 
3,891 
(1,844)
(13,084)
822 
Net cash flows from financing activities
(3,029)
(645)
(22,739)
13,618 
(12,795)
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
(135)
(1,023)
2,460 
(1,657)
(355)
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents
(6,139)
13,497 
(15,168)
(14,939)
(22,749)
           
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the period
16,448 
78,716 
174,913 
(125,891)
144,186 
           
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the period
10,309 
92,213 
159,745 
(140,830)
121,437 
 
 
120

 

Risk and balance sheet management


Key terms and acronyms used in this section are defined in the glossary of terms.

Balance sheet management

Capital
The Group aims to maintain an appropriate level of capital to meet its business needs and regulatory requirements as capital adequacy and risk management are closely aligned. The Group’s risk asset ratios calculated in accordance with Financial Services Authority (FSA) definitions are set out below.

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Risk-weighted assets (RWAs)
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Credit risk
366.1 
367.9 
385.9 
Counterparty risk
66.1 
62.8 
68.1 
Market risk
58.6 
69.5 
80.0 
Operational risk
37.9 
37.9 
37.1 
       
 
528.7 
538.1 
571.1 
Benefit of Asset Protection Scheme
(95.2)
(98.4)
(105.6)
       
 
433.5 
439.7 
465.5 

Risk asset ratio
       
Core Tier 1
11.1 
11.2 
10.7 
Tier 1
13.5 
13.5 
12.9 
Total
14.4 
14.5 
14.0 

Key points
·
Credit and counterparty risk RWAs increased by £1.5 billion in Q2 2011 principally driven by a change in risk parameters and business movements.
   
·
Market risk RWAs decreased by £10.9 billion in Q2 2011 reflecting de-risking of the Non-Core portfolio and a reduction in trading VaR in both GBM and Non-Core.
   
·
The APS benefit decreased by £3.2 billion, reflecting asset reductions, partially offset by adverse changes in risk parameters principally related to Ireland.
   
·
The Core Tier 1 ratio remained strong at 11.1%.
 
 
121

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Capital (continued)

The Group’s capital resources in accordance with FSA definitions were as follows:

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Composition of regulatory capital
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Tier 1
     
Ordinary and B shareholders' equity
70,000 
69,332 
70,388 
Non-controlling interests
1,498 
1,710 
1,719 
Adjustments for:
     
  - goodwill and other intangible assets - continuing businesses
(14,592)
(14,409)
(14,448)
  - unrealised losses on available-for-sale (AFS) debt securities
1,103 
2,125 
2,061 
  - reserves arising on revaluation of property and unrealised gains on
    AFS equities
(76)
(62)
(25)
  - reallocation of preference shares and innovative securities
(548)
(548)
(548)
  - other regulatory adjustments*
(1,014)
(379)
(1,097)
Less excess of expected losses over provisions net of tax
(2,156)
(2,385)
(1,900)
Less securitisation positions
(2,404)
(2,410)
(2,321)
Less APS first loss
(3,810)
(3,936)
(4,225)
       
Core Tier 1 capital
48,001 
49,038 
49,604 
Preference shares
5,372 
5,380 
5,410 
Innovative Tier 1 securities
4,564 
4,561 
4,662 
Tax on the excess of expected losses over provisions
777 
860 
758 
Less material holdings
(327)
(291)
(310)
       
Total Tier 1 capital
58,387 
59,548 
60,124 
       
Tier 2
     
Reserves arising on revaluation of property and unrealised gains on AFS
  equities
76 
62 
25 
Collective impairment provisions
715 
750 
778 
Perpetual subordinated debt
1,858 
1,845 
1,852 
Term subordinated debt
15,697 
16,334 
16,745 
Non-controlling and other interests in Tier 2 capital
11 
11 
11 
Less excess of expected losses over provisions
(2,933)
(3,245)
(2,658)
Less securitisation positions
(2,404)
(2,410)
(2,321)
Less material holdings
(327)
(291)
(310)
Less APS first loss
(3,810)
(3,936)
(4,225)
       
Total Tier 2 capital
8,883 
9,120 
9,897 
       
Supervisory deductions
     
Unconsolidated investments
     
  - RBS Insurance
(4,176)
(3,988)
(3,962)
  - other investments
(354)
(330)
(318)
Other deductions
(419)
(422)
(452)
       
Deductions from total capital
(4,949)
(4,740)
(4,732)
       
Total regulatory capital
62,321 
63,928 
65,289 
       
* Includes reduction for own liabilities carried at fair value
(1,112)
(863)
(1,182)
 
 
122

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Capital (continued)

Movement in Core Tier 1 capital
£m 
   
At 1 January 2011
49,604 
Attributable loss net of movement in fair value of own debt
(209)
Foreign currency reserves
(384)
Increase in capital deductions including APS first loss
(285)
Other movements
312 
   
At 31 March 2011
49,038 
Attributable loss net of movement in fair value of own debt
(1,146)
Foreign currency reserves
80 
Decrease in non-controlling interests
(212)
Decrease in capital deductions including APS first loss
361 
Other movements
(120)
   
At 30 June 2011
48,001 

 
123

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Capital: Risk-weighted assets by division
Risk-weighted assets by risk category and division are set out below.

 
Credit 
risk 
Counterparty 
risk 
Market 
risk 
Operational 
risk 
Gross 
RWAs 
APS 
relief 
Net 
RWAs 
30 June 2011
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
UK Retail
42.2 
7.3 
49.5 
(10.7)
38.8 
UK Corporate
71.2 
6.7 
77.9 
(19.3)
58.6 
Wealth
10.9 
0.1 
1.9 
12.9 
12.9 
Global Transaction Services
13.9 
4.9 
18.8 
18.8 
Ulster Bank
33.9 
0.5 
0.1 
1.8 
36.3 
(7.6)
28.7 
US Retail & Commercial
49.6 
0.8 
4.4 
54.8 
54.8 
               
Retail & Commercial
221.7 
1.3 
0.2 
27.0 
250.2 
(37.6)
212.6 
Global Banking & Markets
51.2 
31.4 
40.9 
15.5 
139.0 
(10.3)
128.7 
Other
10.7 
0.4 
0.7 
11.8 
11.8 
               
Core
283.6 
33.1 
41.1 
43.2 
401.0 
(47.9)
353.1 
Non-Core
79.7 
33.0 
17.5 
(5.5)
124.7 
(47.3)
77.4 
               
Group before RFS MI
363.3 
66.1 
58.6 
37.7 
525.7 
(95.2)
430.5 
RFS MI
2.8 
0.2 
3.0 
3.0 
               
Group
366.1 
66.1 
58.6 
37.9 
528.7 
(95.2)
433.5 
               
31 March 2011
             
               
UK Retail
43.0 
7.3 
50.3 
(11.4)
38.9 
UK Corporate
72.6 
6.7 
79.3 
(21.5)
57.8 
Wealth
10.6 
0.1 
1.9 
12.6 
12.6 
Global Transaction Services
13.3 
4.9 
18.2 
18.2 
Ulster Bank
29.4 
0.4 
0.1 
1.8 
31.7 
(7.4)
24.3 
US Retail & Commercial
48.4 
0.8 
4.4 
53.6 
53.6 
               
Retail & Commercial
217.3 
1.2 
0.2 
27.0 
245.7 
(40.3)
205.4 
Global Banking & Markets
51.0 
32.0 
48.0 
15.5 
146.5 
(11.1)
135.4 
Other
13.3 
0.5 
0.7 
14.5 
14.5 
               
Core
281.6 
33.7 
48.2 
43.2 
406.7 
(51.4)
355.3 
Non-Core
83.6 
29.1 
21.3 
(5.5)
128.5 
(47.0)
81.5 
               
Group before RFS MI
365.2 
62.8 
69.5 
37.7 
535.2 
(98.4)
436.8 
RFS MI
2.7 
0.2 
2.9 
2.9 
               
Group
367.9 
62.8 
69.5 
37.9 
538.1 
(98.4)
439.7 

31 December 2010
             
               
UK Retail
41.7 
7.1 
48.8 
(12.4)
36.4 
UK Corporate
74.8 
6.6 
81.4 
(22.9)
58.5 
Wealth
10.4 
0.1 
2.0 
12.5 
12.5 
Global Transaction Services
13.7 
4.6 
18.3 
18.3 
Ulster Bank
29.2 
0.5 
0.1 
1.8 
31.6 
(7.9)
23.7 
US Retail & Commercial
52.0 
0.9 
4.1 
57.0 
57.0 
               
Retail & Commercial
221.8 
1.4 
0.2 
26.2 
249.6 
(43.2)
206.4 
Global Banking & Markets
53.5 
34.5 
44.7 
14.2 
146.9 
(11.5)
135.4 
Other
16.4 
0.4 
0.2 
1.0 
18.0 
18.0 
               
Core
291.7 
36.3 
45.1 
41.4 
414.5 
(54.7)
359.8 
Non-Core
91.3 
31.8 
34.9 
(4.3)
153.7 
(50.9)
102.8 
               
Group before RFS MI
383.0 
68.1 
80.0 
37.1 
568.2 
(105.6)
462.6 
RFS MI
2.9 
2.9 
2.9 
               
Group
385.9 
68.1 
80.0 
37.1 
571.1 
 (105.6)
465.5 
               
 
 
124

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Capital (continued)

Basel 2.5 and Basel III impacts
The Basel Committee on Banking Supervision completed its review of and finalised the Basel III capital requirements for credit valuation adjustments (CVAs) with respect to counterparty risk in June 2011.  The review resulted in minor modifications to the text published in December 2010.  Indicative impacts of the major Basel 2.5 and Basel III proposals on the Group’s RWAs and Core Tier 1 ratio were disclosed in our 2010 Form 20-F and these remain unchanged.  The Group continues to make progress on the mitigation actions and develop further opportunities to optimise the outcome.

On 20 July 2011, the European Commission published a preliminary version of the Capital Requirements Directive (CRD) IV to implement the Basel III agreement within the EU.  The Group is assessing the impact of CRD IV on RWAs, capital and liquidity.

 
Funding and liquidity risk
The Group’s balance sheet composition is a function of the broad array of product offerings and diverse markets served by its Core divisions. The structural composition of the balance sheet is augmented as needed through active management of both asset and liability portfolios. The objective of these activities is to optimise liquidity transformation in normal business environments while ensuring adequate coverage of all cash requirements under extreme stress conditions.

Diversification of the Group’s funding base is central to its liquidity management strategy. The Group’s businesses have developed large customer franchises based on strong relationship management and high quality service. These customer franchises are strongest in the UK, US and Ireland but extend into Europe and Asia. Customer deposits provide large pools of stable funding to support the majority of the Group’s lending. It is a strategic objective to improve the Group’s loan to deposit ratio to 100%, or better, by 2013.

The Group also accesses professional markets funding by way of public and private debt issuances on an unsecured and secured basis. These debt issuance programmes are spread across multiple currencies and maturities to appeal to a broad range of investor types and preferences around the world. This market based funding supplements the Group’s structural liquidity needs and in some cases achieves certain capital objectives.
 
 
125

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Funding and liquidity risk: funding sources (continued)

Funding sources
The table below shows the Group’s primary funding sources, excluding repurchase agreements.

 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                 
Deposits by banks
               
  - central banks
8,156 
1.1 
 
10,679 
1.5 
 
11,612 
1.6 
  - cash collateral
25,524 
3.5 
 
23,594 
3.2 
 
28,074 
3.8 
  - other
37,893 
5.1 
 
29,556 
4.0 
 
26,365 
3.6 
                 
 
71,573 
9.7 
 
63,829 
8.7 
 
66,051 
9.0 
                 
Debt securities in issue
               
  - commercial paper
22,369 
3.0 
 
24,216 
3.3 
 
26,235 
3.5 
  - certificates of deposits
35,305 
4.8 
 
35,967 
4.9 
 
37,855 
5.1 
  - medium-term notes (MTNs)
132,371 
17.9 
 
130,230 
17.7 
 
131,026 
17.7 
  - covered bonds
6,972 
0.9 
 
6,850 
0.9 
 
4,100 
0.6 
  - securitisations
16,780 
2.3 
 
18,705 
2.6 
 
19,156 
2.6 
                 
 
213,797 
28.9 
 
215,968 
29.4 
 
218,372 
29.5 
Subordinated liabilities
26,311 
3.5 
 
26,515 
3.6 
 
27,053 
3.6 
                 
Debt securities in issue and subordinated
  liabilities
240,108 
32.4 
 
242,483 
33.0 
 
245,425 
33.1 
                 
Wholesale funding
311,681 
42.1 
 
306,312 
41.7 
 
311,476 
42.1 
                 
Customer deposits
               
  - cash collateral
11,166 
1.5 
 
8,673 
1.2 
 
10,433 
1.4 
  - other
417,537 
56.4 
 
419,801 
57.1 
 
418,166 
56.5 
                 
Total customer deposits
428,703 
57.9 
 
428,474 
58.3 
 
428,599 
57.9 
                 
Total funding
740,384 
100.0 
 
734,786 
100.0 
 
740,075 
100.0 


 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Short-term wholesale funding
173.5 
166.3 
157.5 
Of which - bank deposits
67.0 
60.3 
62.5 
               - other
106.5 
106.0 
95.0 
       
Short-term wholesale funding excluding derivative collateral
148.0 
142.7 
129.4 
Of which - bank deposits
41.5 
36.7 
34.4 
               - other
106.5 
106.0 
95.0 
 
 
126

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Funding and liquidity risk: funding sources (continued)

Key points
·
Customer deposits remained stable in absolute terms at £428.7 billion and as a proportion of total funding at 58%.
   
·
The proportion of funding from customer deposits, excluding cash collateral, remained broadly stable at 56.4% at 30 June 2011 compared with 31 December 2010 and reduced slightly from 57.1% at 31 March 2011 reflecting a net £5.4 billion increase in wholesale funding in Q2 2011.
   
·
Short-term wholesale funding excluding derivative collateral and bank deposits increased from £95.0 billion at 31 December 2010 to £106.0 billion at 31 March 2011 and increased marginally to £106.5 billion at 30 June 2011. The £11.0 billion increase in the first quarter of 2011 was primarily due to the inclusion of MTNs issued under the Credit Guarantee Scheme (CGS) maturing through to Q2 2012.
   
·
Short-term wholesale funding excluding derivative collateral increased from £129.4 billion at 31 December 2010 to £142.7 billion at 31 March 2011 and £148.0 billion at 30 June 2011, due primarily to the inclusion of CGS MTNs as discussed above.

The table below shows the Group’s debt securities in issue and subordinated liabilities by remaining maturity.
 
 
Debt securities in issue
     
 
CP and CDs 
MTNs 
Covered 
bonds 
Securitisations 
Total 
Subordinated 
liabilities 
Total 
 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
30 June 2011
               
Less than 1 year
56,868 
49,174 
43 
106,085 
399 
106,484 
44.3 
1-3 years
788 
33,366 
1,114 
18 
35,286 
1,962 
37,248 
15.6 
3-5 years
13 
19,028 
3,154 
33 
22,228 
8,316 
30,544 
12.7 
More than 5 years
30,803 
2,704 
16,686 
50,198 
15,634 
65,832 
27.4 
                 
 
57,674 
132,371 
6,972 
16,780 
213,797 
26,311 
240,108 
100.0 
                 
31 March 2011
               
Less than 1 year
59,533 
45,530 
105 
105,168 
826 
105,994 
43.7 
1-3 years
634 
34,046 
1,105 
16 
35,801 
2,247 
38,048 
15.7 
3-5 years
11 
22,242 
1,326 
34 
23,613 
7,217 
30,830 
12.7 
More than 5 years
28,412 
4,419 
18,550 
51,386 
16,225 
67,611 
27.9 
                 
 
60,183 
130,230 
6,850 
18,705 
215,968 
26,515 
242,483 
100.0 
                 
31 December 2010
               
Less than 1 year
63,371 
30,589 
88 
94,048 
964 
95,012 
38.7 
1-3 years
702 
47,357 
1,078 
12 
49,149 
754 
49,903 
20.3 
3-5 years
12 
21,466 
1,294 
34 
22,806 
8,476 
31,282 
12.8 
More than 5 years
31,614 
1,728 
19,022 
52,369 
16,859 
69,228 
28.2 
                 
 
64,090 
131,026 
4,100 
19,156 
218,372 
27,053 
245,425 
100.0 
 
 
127

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Funding and liquidity risk: funding sources (continued)

Long-term debt issuances
The table below shows debt securities issued by the Group with an original maturity of one year or more. The Group also executes other long-term funding arrangements (predominately term repos) which are not reflected in the following tables.

   
Half year 
ended 
30 June 
2011 
 
Half year 
ended 
30 June 
2010 
 
Quarter ended
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
30 June 
2010 
31 March 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Public
           
  - unsecured
1,808 
3,277 
5,085 
1,882 
3,976 
5,858 
  - secured
2,211 
2,652 
4,863 
1,030 
1,030 
Private
           
  - unsecured
3,997 
4,251 
8,248 
2,370 
4,158 
6,528 
             
Gross issuance
8,016 
10,180 
18,196 
5,282 
8,134 
13,416 

The table below shows the original maturity of public long-term debt securities issued in the half years ended 30 June 2011 and 2010.

 
2-3 years 
3-4 years 
5-10 years 
> 10 years 
Total 
Half year ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
MTNs
904 
1,407 
1,839 
935 
5,085 
Covered bonds
2,652 
2,652 
Securitisations
2,211 
2,211 
           
 
904 
1,407 
4,491 
3,146 
9,948 
           
% of total
9% 
14% 
45% 
32% 
100% 
           
Half year ended 30 June 2010
         
           
MTNs
260 
3,828 
1,770 
5,858 
Covered bonds
1,030 
1,030 
           
 
1,290 
3,828 
1,770 
6,888 
           
% of total
19% 
55% 
26% 
100% 

 
128

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Funding and liquidity risk: funding sources (continued)

The table below shows the currency breakdown of public and private long-term debt securities issued in the half years ended 30 June 2011 and 2010.

 
GBP 
EUR 
USD 
AUD 
Other 
Total 
Half year ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Public
           
  - MTNs
1,808 
2,181 
1,096 
5,085 
  - covered bonds
2,652 
2,652 
  - securitisations
258 
1,293 
660 
2,211 
Private
1,203 
2,535 
2,344 
118 
2,048 
8,248 
             
 
1,461 
8,288 
5,185 
1,214 
2,048 
18,196 
             
% of total
8% 
46% 
28% 
7% 
11% 
100% 
             
Half year ended 30 June 2010
           
             
Public
           
  - MTNs
1,260 
2,923 
1,427 
248 
5,858 
  - covered bonds
1,030 
1,030 
Private
448 
4,552 
846 
68 
614 
6,528 
             
 
1,708 
8,505 
2,273 
68 
862 
13,416 
             
% of total
13% 
63% 
17% 
1% 
6% 
100% 

Key points
·
Gross term issuances in Q2 2011 were £8.0 billion, including £2.2 billion of securitisations with original maturity of greater than 10 years.
   
·
The Group has continued to diversify its funding mix with 46% of issuance denominated in euros, 28% in US dollars and 26% in other currencies.
   
·
The Group had completed £18 billion of its £23 billion 2011 issuance target by 30 June 2011.
 
 
129

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Funding and liquidity risk (continued)

Liquidity portfolio
The table below shows the composition of the Group’s liquidity portfolio.

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Liquidity portfolio
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Cash and balances at central banks
59,010 
58,936 
53,661 
Treasury bills
8,600 
9,859 
14,529 
Central and local government bonds (1)
     
  - AAA rated governments and US agencies (2)
47,999 
40,199 
41,435 
  - AA- to AA+ rated governments
1,399 
1,408 
3,744 
  - governments rated below AA
836 
1,052 
1,029 
  - local government
4,881 
4,771 
5,672 
 
55,115 
47,430 
51,880 
Unencumbered collateral (3)
     
  - AAA rated
18,335 
21,328 
17,836 
  - below AAA rated and other high quality assets
13,493 
13,637 
16,693 
 
31,828 
34,965 
34,529 
       
Total liquidity portfolio
154,553 
151,190 
154,599 

Notes:
(1)
Includes FSA eligible government bonds of £34.5 billion at 30 June 2011 (31 March 2011 - £30.1 billion; 31 December 2010 - £34.7 billion).
(2)
Includes AAA rated US government guaranteed and US government sponsored agencies.
(3)
Includes secured assets eligible for discounting at central banks, comprising loans and advances and debt securities.

Key points
·
The Group’s liquidity portfolio was £154.6 billion, an increase of £3.4 billion from 31 March 2011 and flat compared with the position at 31 December 2010. The Group increased its liquidity balances during the quarter given unsettled market conditions.
   
·
The strategic target of £150 billion is unchanged.
   
·
The liquidity portfolio is actively managed and as such its composition varies over time. Actions in H1 2011 to alter the maturity and currency mix resulted in a higher portfolio of cash and central bank balances compared with 31 December 2010.
 
 
130

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Funding and liquidity risk (continued)

Net stable funding
The table below shows the Group’s net stable funding ratio (NSFR) estimated by applying the Basel III guidance issued in December 2010. This measure seeks to show the proportion of structural term assets which are funded by stable funding including customer deposits, long-term wholesale funding and equity. The Group’s NSFR will continue to be refined over time in line with regulatory developments.
 
 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
   
   
ASF (1)
   
ASF (1)
   
ASF (1)
 
Weighting 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
                     
Equity
76 
76 
 
76 
76 
 
76 
76 
 
100 
Wholesale funding > 1 year
138 
138 
 
138 
138 
 
154 
154 
 
100 
Wholesale funding < 1 year
174 
 
168 
 
157 
 
Derivatives
388 
 
361 
 
424 
 
Repurchase agreements
124 
 
130 
 
115 
 
Deposits
                   
  - Retail and SME - more stable
168 
151 
 
171 
154 
 
172 
155 
 
90 
  - Retail and SME - less stable
25 
20 
 
26 
21 
 
51 
41 
 
80 
  - Other
236 
118 
 
231 
116 
 
206 
103 
 
50 
Other (2)
117 
 
112 
 
98 
 
                     
Total liabilities and equity
1,446 
503 
 
1,413 
505 
 
1,453 
529 
   
                     
Cash
64 
 
60 
 
57 
 
Inter bank lending
53 
 
59 
 
58 
 
Debt securities > 1 year
                   
  - central and local governments AAA
    to AA-
87 
 
83 
 
89 
 
  - other eligible bonds
85 
17 
 
79 
16 
 
75 
15 
 
20 
  - other bonds
19 
19 
 
16 
16 
 
10 
10 
 
100 
Debt securities < 1 year
53 
 
53 
 
43 
 
Derivatives
395 
 
361 
 
427 
 
Reverse repurchase agreements
98 
 
106 
 
95 
 
Customer loans and advances > 1 year
                   
  - residential mortgages
145 
94 
 
143 
93 
 
145 
94 
 
65 
  - other
182 
182 
 
200 
200 
 
211 
211 
 
100 
Customer loans and advances < 1 year
                   
  - retail loans
20 
17 
 
19 
16 
 
22 
19 
 
85 
  - other
143 
72 
 
132 
66 
 
125 
63 
 
50 
Other (3)
102 
102 
 
102 
102 
 
96 
96 
 
100 
                     
Total assets
1,446 
507 
 
1,413 
513 
 
1,453 
512 
   
                     
Undrawn commitments
250 
13 
 
255 
13 
 
267 
13 
 
                     
Total assets and undrawn commitments
1,696 
520 
 
1,668 
526 
 
1,720 
525 
   
                     
Net stable funding ratio
 
97%
   
96% 
   
101% 
   

Notes:
(1)
Available stable funding.
(2)
Deferred tax, insurance liabilities and other liabilities.
(3)
Prepayments, accrued income, deferred tax and other assets.

Key point
·
The Group’s net stable funding ratio declined in Q1 2010 due to the roll down of CGS MTNs into wholesale funding maturing in less than one year. The ratio stabilised in Q2 2011 and we anticipate that the ratio will continue to improve in H2 2011.

 
131

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Funding and liquidity risk (continued)

Loan deposit ratio and funding gap
The table below shows quarterly trends in the loan to deposit ratio and customer funding gap.

 
Loan to
deposit ratio (1)
 
Customer 
 funding gap (1)
 
Group 
Core 
 
Group 
 
 
£bn 
         
30 June 2011
114 
96 
 
61 
31 March 2011
115 
96 
 
66 
31 December 2010
117 
96 
 
74 
30 September 2010
126 
101 
 
107 
30 June 2010
128 
102 
 
118 
31 March 2010
131 
102 
 
131 

Note:
(1)
Excludes repurchase agreements and bancassurance deposits at 31 March 2010, and loans are net of provisions.

Key points
·
The Group’s loan to deposit ratio improved by 300 basis points to 114% in the six months to 30 June 2011, including a 100 basis points improvement in the second quarter of 2011. The customer funding gap narrowed by £13 billion in the six months to 30 June 2011, including a £5 billion reduction in Q2 2011, primarily due to a reduction in Non-Core customer loans.
   
·
The loan to deposit ratio for the Group’s Core business has remained stable at 96% since December 2010.

Sensitivity of net interest income
The Group seeks to mitigate the effect of prospective interest rate movements which could reduce future net interest income through its management of market risk in the Group’s businesses, whilst balancing the cost of such hedging activities on the current net revenue stream. Hedging activities also consider the impact on market value sensitivity under stress.

The table below shows the sensitivity of net interest income over the next twelve months to an immediate up and down 100 basis points change to all interest rates. In addition the table includes the impact of a gradual 400 basis point steepening and a gradual 300 basis point flattening of the yield curve at tenors greater than a year.
 
30 June 
2011 
£m 
   
+ 100bp shift in yield curves
319 
– 100bp shift in yield curves
(141)
Bear steepener
417 
Bull flattener
(309)

Key points
·
The Group’s interest rate exposure remains slightly asset sensitive driven in part by changes to underlying business assumptions as rates rise.
·
The reported sensitivity will vary over time due to a number of factors such as changing market conditions and strategic changes to the balance sheet mix and should not therefore be considered predictive of future performance.

 
132

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Funding and liquidity risk (continued)

Structural foreign currency exposures
The Group does not maintain material non-trading open currency positions other than the structural foreign currency translation exposures arising from its investments in foreign subsidiaries and associated undertakings and their related currency funding.

The table below shows the Group’s structural foreign currency exposures.

 
Net assets 
 of overseas 
 operations 
RFS MI 
Net 
investments 
in foreign 
 operations 
Net 
 investment 
 hedges 
Structural 
 foreign 
 currency 
 exposures 
pre-economic 
hedges 
Economic 
 hedges (1) 
Residual 
structural 
foreign 
currency 
exposures 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
30 June 2011
             
US dollar
17,082 
17,080 
(1,827)
15,253 
(3,920)
11,333 
Euro
9,313 
50 
9,263 
(733)
8,530 
(2,416)
6,114 
Other non-sterling
5,603 
262 
5,341 
(4,340)
1,001 
1,001 
               
 
31,998 
314 
31,684 
(6,900)
24,784 
(6,336)
18,448 
               
31 December 2010
             
US dollar
17,137 
17,135 
(1,820)
15,315 
(4,058)
11,257 
Euro
8,443 
33 
8,410 
(578)
7,832 
(2,305)
5,527 
Other non-sterling
5,320 
244 
5,076 
(4,135)
941 
941 
               
 
30,900 
279 
30,621 
(6,533)
24,088 
(6,363)
17,725 

Note:
(1)
The economic hedges represent US dollar and euro preference shares in issue that are treated as equity under IFRS, and do not qualify as hedges for accounting purposes.

Key point
·
Changes in foreign currency exchange rates will affect equity in proportion to the structural foreign currency exposure. A 5% strengthening in foreign currencies against sterling would result in a gain of £1,300 million (31 December 2010 - £1,200 million) recognised in equity, while a 5% weakening in foreign currencies would result in a loss of £1,200 million (31 December 2010 - £1,150 million) recognised in equity.

 
133

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk of financial loss due to the failure of customers or counterparties to meet payment obligations. The quantum and nature of credit risk assumed across the Group’s different businesses varies considerably, while the overall credit risk outcome usually exhibits a high degree of correlation with the macroeconomic environment.

Loans and advances to customers by industry and geography
The table below shows loans and advances to customers excluding reverse repos and assets of disposal groups.

 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Central and local government
6,574 
1,507 
8,081 
 
5,650 
1,514 
7,164 
 
6,781 
1,671 
8,452 
Finance
47,545 
5,038 
52,583 
 
47,797 
7,559 
55,356 
 
46,910 
7,651 
54,561 
Residential mortgages
144,400 
5,509 
149,909 
 
142,920 
5,678 
148,598 
 
140,359 
6,142 
146,501 
Personal lending
32,224 
3,229 
35,453 
 
32,362 
3,482 
35,844 
 
33,581 
3,891 
37,472 
Property
44,539 
42,862 
87,401 
 
45,038 
43,866 
88,904 
 
42,455 
47,651 
90,106 
Construction
8,525 
3,070 
11,595 
 
9,011 
3,231 
12,242 
 
8,680 
3,352 
12,032 
Manufacturing
24,068 
6,293 
30,361 
 
24,621 
6,295 
30,916 
 
25,797 
6,520 
32,317 
Service industries and
  business activities
                     
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
22,123 
2,598 
24,721 
 
22,185 
2,802 
24,987 
 
21,974 
3,191 
25,165 
  - transport and storage
15,243 
6,449 
21,692 
 
15,402 
7,090 
22,492 
 
15,946 
8,195 
24,141 
  - health, education and
    recreation
16,707 
1,547 
18,254 
 
16,391 
1,460 
17,851 
 
17,456 
1,865 
19,321 
  - hotels and restaurants
8,028 
1,452 
9,480 
 
8,090 
1,452 
9,542 
 
8,189 
1,492 
9,681 
  - utilities
7,487 
2,010 
9,497 
 
7,679 
2,016 
9,695 
 
7,098 
2,110 
9,208 
  - other
25,128 
4,966 
30,094 
 
22,876 
5,892 
28,768 
 
24,464 
5,530 
29,994 
Agriculture, forestry and
  fishing
3,791 
123 
3,914 
 
3,741 
130 
3,871 
 
3,758 
135 
3,893 
Finance leases and
  instalment credit
8,353 
7,920 
16,273 
 
8,061 
8,119 
16,180 
 
8,321 
8,529 
16,850 
Interest accruals
715 
176 
891 
 
673 
193 
866 
 
831 
278 
1,109 
                       
Gross loans
415,450 
94,749 
510,199 
 
412,497 
100,779 
513,276 
 
412,600 
108,203 
520,803 
Loan impairment provisions
(8,621)
(12,006)
(20,627)
 
(8,287)
(10,841)
(19,128)
 
(7,740)
(10,315)
(18,055)
                       
Net loans
406,829 
82,743 
489,572 
 
404,210 
89,938 
494,148 
 
404,860 
97,888 
502,748 

Key points
·
Gross loans reduced by £10.6 billion in the first half of the year, of which £3.1 billion was in the second quarter, principally due to disposals and restructuring and run-offs in Non-Core, partially offset by increased mortgage lending in UK Retail.
   
·
Unsecured lending decreased in the first half of the year, predominantly in UK Retail.
   
·
Property lending decreased during the first half of the year in line with the continued focus on lower risk secured lending.
   
·
The decrease in transport and storage primarily reflects decreases in shipping and aviation.
 
 
134

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk (continued)

Loans and advances to customers by industry and geography (continued)
The table below analyses loans and advances to customers excluding reverse repos and assets of disposal groups by geography (by location of office).

 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
UK
                     
Central and local government
5,945 
91 
6,036 
 
5,144 
104 
5,248 
 
5,728 
173 
5,901 
Finance
28,657 
3,734 
32,391 
 
27,510 
5,910 
33,420 
 
27,995 
6,023 
34,018 
Residential mortgages
103,689 
1,570 
105,259 
 
102,462 
1,632 
104,094 
 
99,928 
1,665 
101,593 
Personal lending
22,205 
358 
22,563 
 
22,278 
451 
22,729 
 
23,035 
585 
23,620 
Property
36,584 
27,182 
63,766 
 
36,419 
28,322 
64,741 
 
34,970 
30,492 
65,462 
Construction
6,839 
2,104 
8,943 
 
7,271 
2,282 
9,553 
 
7,041 
2,310 
9,351 
Manufacturing
10,155 
1,447 
11,602 
 
10,810 
1,498 
12,308 
 
12,300 
1,510 
13,810 
Service industries and
  business activities
                     
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
12,255 
1,615 
13,870 
 
12,762 
1,676 
14,438 
 
12,554 
1,853 
14,407 
  - transport and storage
7,905 
3,844 
11,749 
 
8,354 
4,390 
12,744 
 
8,105 
5,015 
13,120 
  - health, education and
    recreation
12,678 
835 
13,513 
 
12,572 
951 
13,523 
 
13,502 
1,039 
14,541 
  - hotels and restaurants
6,399 
775 
7,174 
 
6,500 
792 
7,292 
 
6,558 
808 
7,366 
  - utilities
3,418 
908 
4,326 
 
3,705 
1,088 
4,793 
 
3,101 
1,035 
4,136 
  - other
13,555 
2,199 
15,754 
 
13,406 
2,603 
16,009 
 
14,445 
1,991 
16,436 
Agriculture, forestry and
  fishing
2,955 
55 
3,010 
 
2,935 
61 
2,996 
 
2,872 
67 
2,939 
Finance leases and
  instalment credit
5,578 
7,161 
12,739 
 
5,565 
7,431 
12,996 
 
5,589 
7,785 
13,374 
Interest accruals
365 
21 
386 
 
371 
48 
419 
 
415 
98 
513 
                       
 
279,182 
53,899 
333,081 
 
278,064 
59,239 
337,303 
 
278,138 
62,449 
340,587 
                       
Europe
                     
Central and local government
397 
862 
1,259 
 
220 
899 
1,119 
 
365 
1,017 
1,382 
Finance
2,642 
719 
3,361 
 
3,768 
821 
4,589 
 
2,642 
1,019 
3,661 
Residential mortgages
20,224 
640 
20,864 
 
19,892 
684 
20,576 
 
19,473 
621 
20,094 
Personal lending
2,234 
572 
2,806 
 
2,276 
587 
2,863 
 
2,270 
600 
2,870 
Property
5,483 
12,790 
18,273 
 
5,304 
12,711 
18,015 
 
5,139 
12,636 
17,775 
Construction
1,163 
864 
2,027 
 
1,246 
851 
2,097 
 
1,014 
873 
1,887 
Manufacturing
5,669 
4,253 
9,922 
 
6,167 
4,139 
10,306 
 
5,853 
4,181 
10,034 
Service industries and
  business activities
                     
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
4,058 
767 
4,825 
 
4,074 
847 
4,921 
 
4,126 
999 
5,125 
  - transport and storage
5,330 
970 
6,300 
 
4,932 
1,013 
5,945 
 
5,625 
1,369 
6,994 
  - health, education and
    recreation
1,373 
445 
1,818 
 
1,383 
355 
1,738 
 
1,442 
496 
1,938 
  - hotels and restaurants
1,065 
597 
1,662 
 
1,051 
556 
1,607 
 
1,055 
535 
1,590 
  - utilities
1,536 
654 
2,190 
 
1,425 
591 
2,016 
 
1,412 
623 
2,035 
  - other
4,807 
1,850 
6,657 
 
3,246 
2,286 
5,532 
 
3,877 
2,050 
5,927 
Agriculture, forestry and
  fishing
789 
68 
857 
 
774 
69 
843 
 
849 
68 
917 
Finance leases and
  instalment credit
264 
620 
884 
 
265 
688 
953 
 
370 
744 
1,114 
Interest accruals
135 
98 
233 
 
76 
85 
161 
 
143 
101 
244 
                       
 
57,169 
26,769 
83,938 
 
56,099 
27,182 
83,281 
 
55,655 
27,932 
83,587 
 
 
135

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk (continued)

Loans and advances to customers by industry and geography (continued)

 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
US
                     
Central and local government
164 
15 
179 
 
169 
38 
207 
 
263 
53 
316 
Finance
9,820 
444 
10,264 
 
9,635 
495 
10,130 
 
9,522 
587 
10,109 
Residential mortgages
20,020 
3,093 
23,113 
 
20,084 
3,243 
23,327 
 
20,548 
3,653 
24,201 
Personal lending
6,315 
2,299 
8,614 
 
6,327 
2,444 
8,771 
 
6,816 
2,704 
9,520 
Property
2,228 
1,626 
3,854 
 
2,574 
1,768 
4,342 
 
1,611 
3,318 
4,929 
Construction
445 
68 
513 
 
420 
63 
483 
 
442 
78 
520 
Manufacturing
6,113 
64 
6,177 
 
5,614 
80 
5,694 
 
5,459 
143 
5,602 
Service industries and
  business activities
                     
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
4,644 
144 
4,788 
 
4,366 
199 
4,565 
 
4,264 
237 
4,501 
  - transport and storage
1,725 
1,297 
3,022 
 
1,723 
1,337 
3,060 
 
1,786 
1,408 
3,194 
  - health, education and
    recreation
2,396 
107 
2,503 
 
2,319 
138 
2,457 
 
2,380 
313 
2,693 
  - hotels and restaurants
455 
71 
526 
 
487 
90 
577 
 
486 
136 
622 
  - utilities
960 
27 
987 
 
1,001 
32 
1,033 
 
1,117 
53 
1,170 
  - other
4,195 
425 
4,620 
 
3,809 
465 
4,274 
 
4,042 
577 
4,619 
Agriculture, forestry and
  fishing
25 
25 
 
26 
26 
 
31 
31 
Finance leases and
  instalment credit
2,456 
2,456 
 
2,188 
2,188 
 
2,315 
2,315 
Interest accruals
179 
57 
236 
 
179 
59 
238 
 
183 
73 
256 
                       
 
62,140 
9,737 
71,877 
 
60,921 
10,451 
71,372 
 
61,265 
13,333 
74,598 
                       
RoW
                     
Central and local government
68 
539 
607 
 
117 
473 
590 
 
425 
428 
853 
Finance
6,426 
141 
6,567 
 
6,884 
333 
7,217 
 
6,751 
22 
6,773 
Residential mortgages
467 
206 
673 
 
482 
119 
601 
 
410 
203 
613 
Personal lending
1,470 
1,470 
 
1,481 
1,481 
 
1,460 
1,462 
Property
244 
1,264 
1,508 
 
741 
1,065 
1,806 
 
735 
1,205 
1,940 
Construction
78 
34 
112 
 
74 
35 
109 
 
183 
91 
274 
Manufacturing
2,131 
529 
2,660 
 
2,030 
578 
2,608 
 
2,185 
686 
2,871 
Service industries and
  business activities
                     
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
1,166 
72 
1,238 
 
983 
80 
1,063 
 
1,030 
102 
1,132 
  - transport and storage
283 
338 
621 
 
393 
350 
743 
 
430 
403 
833 
  - health, education and
    recreation
260 
160 
420 
 
117 
16 
133 
 
132 
17 
149 
  - hotels and restaurants
109 
118 
 
52 
14 
66 
 
90 
13 
103 
  - utilities
1,573 
421 
1,994 
 
1,548 
305 
1,853 
 
1,468 
399 
1,867 
  - other
2,571 
492 
3,063 
 
2,415 
538 
2,953 
 
2,100 
912 
3,012 
Agriculture, forestry and
  fishing
22 
22 
 
 
Finance leases and
  instalment credit
55 
139 
194 
 
43 
43 
 
47 
47 
Interest accruals
36 
36 
 
47 
48 
 
90 
96 
                       
 
16,959 
4,344 
21,303 
 
17,413 
3,907 
21,320 
 
17,542 
4,489 
22,031 
 
 
136

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: REIL and PPL

The table below analyses the Group's risk elements in lending (REIL) and potential problem loans (PPL) and takes no account of the value of any security held which could reduce the eventual loss should it occur, nor of any provisions.

 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Impaired loans (1)
                     
  - UK
9,229 
7,812 
17,041 
 
9,175 
7,147 
16,322 
 
8,575 
7,835 
16,410 
  - Overseas
6,326 
16,268 
22,594 
 
5,932 
15,878 
21,810 
 
4,936 
14,355 
19,291 
                       
 
15,555 
24,080 
39,635 
 
15,107 
23,025 
38,132 
 
13,511 
22,190 
35,701 
                       
Accruing loans past due
  90 days or more (2)
                     
  - UK
1,487 
583 
2,070 
 
1,545 
752 
2,297 
 
1,434 
939 
2,373 
  - Overseas
415 
230 
645 
 
366 
246 
612 
 
262 
262 
524 
                       
 
1,902 
813 
2,715 
 
1,911 
998 
2,909 
 
1,696 
1,201 
2,897 
                       
Total REIL
17,457 
24,893 
42,350 
 
17,018 
24,023 
41,041 
 
15,207 
23,391 
38,598 
PPL (3)
354 
127 
481 
 
324 
202 
526 
 
473 
160 
633 
                       
Total REIL and PPL
17,811 
25,020 
42,831 
 
17,342 
24,225 
41,567 
 
15,680 
23,551 
39,231 
                       
REIL as a % of gross
  loans and advances (4)
4.2% 
26.1% 
8.3% 
 
4.1% 
23.0% 
7.9% 
 
3.7% 
20.7% 
7.3% 
Provisions as a % of REIL
50% 
48% 
49% 
 
49% 
45% 
47% 
 
51% 
44% 
47% 

Notes:
(1)
Loans against which an impairment provision is held.
(2)
Loans where an impairment event has taken place but no impairment provision recognised. This category is used for fully collateralised non-revolving credit facilities.
(3)
Loans for which an impairment event has occurred but no impairment provision is necessary. This category is used for advances and revolving credit facilities where the past due concept is not applicable.
(4)
Gross loans and advances to customers including disposal groups and excluding reverse repurchase agreements.

Key points
·
REIL increased by £3.8 billion in the first half of the year and by £1.3 billion in the second quarter, predominantly in Non-Core and Ulster Bank.
   
·
Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) was the predominant contributor to the increase in REIL with an increase of £3.2 billion, principally property lending (commercial real estate up £2.2 billion and mortgages up £0.4 billion).
   
·
Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) provision coverage ratio increased to 51% from 44% at 31 December 2010 reflecting provisions relating to development land in the second quarter following re-assessment of collateral values. This contributed to the higher Group provision coverage ratio at 30 June 2011, which now stands at 49% compared with 47% at the year end and at 31 March 2011.

For sector, geography and divisional analysis of loans, REIL and impairments, refer to Appendix 2.
 
 
137

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Loans, REIL and impairment provisions

Movement in REIL and PPL
The table below details the movement in REIL and PPL for the half year ended 30 June 2011.

 
REIL
 
PPL
 
Total
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
At 1 January 2011
15,207 
23,391 
38,598 
 
473 
160 
633 
 
15,680 
23,551 
39,231 
Intra-group transfers
369 
(369)
 
 
369 
(369)
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
68 
98 
166 
 
 
69 
102 
171 
Additions
3,119 
2,866 
5,985 
 
305 
152 
457 
 
3,424 
3,018 
6,442 
Transfers
137 
39 
176 
 
(137)
(39)
(176)
 
Disposals, restructurings
  and repayments
(1,342)
(1,426)
(2,768)
 
(318)
(75)
(393)
 
(1,660)
(1,501)
(3,161)
Amounts written-off
(540)
(576)
(1,116)
 
 
(540)
(576)
(1,116)
                       
At 31 March 2011
17,018 
24,023 
41,041 
 
324 
202 
526 
 
17,342 
24,225 
41,567 
Intra-group transfers
12 
(12)
 
 
12 
(12)
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
111 
376 
487 
 
(5)
(1)
(6)
 
106 
375 
481 
Additions
2,492 
3,094 
5,586 
 
137 
22 
159 
 
2,629 
3,116 
5,745 
Transfers
21 
20 
41 
 
(21)
(20)
(41)
 
Disposals, restructurings
  and repayments
(1,719)
(2,272)
(3,991)
 
(81)
(76)
(157)
 
(1,800)
(2,348)
(4,148)
Amounts written-off
(478)
(336)
(814)
 
 
(478)
(336)
(814)
                       
At 30 June 2011
17,457 
24,893 
42,350 
 
354 
127 
481 
 
17,811 
25,020 
42,831 

 
REIL
 
PPL
 
Total
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
At 1 January 2011
15,207 
23,391 
38,598 
 
473 
160 
633 
 
15,680 
23,551 
39,231 
Intra-group transfers
381 
(381)
 
 
381 
(381)
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
179 
474 
653 
 
(4)
(1)
 
175 
477 
652 
Additions
5,611 
5,960 
11,571 
 
442 
174 
616 
 
6,053 
6,134 
12,187 
Transfers
158 
59 
217 
 
(158)
(59)
(217)
 
Disposals, restructurings
  and repayments
(3,061)
(3,698)
(6,759)
 
(399)
(151)
(550)
 
(3,460)
(3,849)
(7,309)
Amounts written-off
(1,018)
(912)
(1,930)
 
 
(1,018)
(912)
(1,930)
                       
At 30 June 2011
17,457 
24,893 
42,350 
 
354 
127 
481 
 
17,811 
25,020 
42,831 

Disposals, restructurings and repayments include £1,569 million of transfers to the performing book in H1 2011.

For sector, geography and divisional analysis of loans, REIL and impairments, refer to Appendix 2.
 
 
138

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Loans, REIL and impairment provisions (continued)

Restructuring and forbearance
Corporate loan restructuring completed during H1 2011 was £1.0 billion.

During H1 2011, the flow of mortgage loans subject to forbearance arrangements in UK Retail was £289 million representing 0.3% of the book. In Ulster Bank £1.8 billion (31 December 2010 - £1.2 billion) of mortgage loans were subject to forbearance arrangements at 30 June 2011, 78% of these arrangements are in the performing book.

Movement in loan impairment provisions
The following table shows the movement in impairment provisions for loans and advances to customers and banks.

 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
30 June 2010
 
Core 
Non-Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                         
At beginning of period
8,416 
10,842 
19,258 
 
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 
 
7,397 
9,430 
16,827 
Transfers to disposal groups
 
(9)
(9)
 
(38)
(38)
Intra-group transfers
 
177 
(177)
 
Currency translation and other adjustments
33 
145 
178 
 
56 
95 
151 
 
(309)
(66)
(375)
Disposals
11 
11 
 
 
(17)
(17)
Amounts written-off
(504)
(474)
(978)
 
(514)
(438)
(952)
 
(562)
(2,122)
(2,684)
Recoveries of amounts previously written-off
41 
126 
167 
 
39 
80 
119 
 
59 
21 
80 
Charge to income statement
                       
  - continued
810 
1,427 
2,237 
 
852 
1,046 
1,898 
 
1,096 
1,383 
2,479 
  - discontinued
(11)
(11)
 
 
Unwind of discount
(44)
(68)
(112)
 
(60)
(71)
(131)
 
(48)
(58)
(106)
                         
At end of period
8,752 
12,007 
20,759 
 
8,416 
10,842 
19,258 
 
7,633 
8,533 
16,166 

 
Half year ended
 
30 June 2011
 
30 June 2010
 
Core 
Non-Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
At beginning of period
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 
 
6,921 
8,252 
2,110 
17,283 
Transfers to disposal groups
 
(67)
(67)
Intra-group transfers
177 
(177)
 
Currency translation and other adjustments
89 
240 
329 
 
(279)
119 
(160)
Disposals
11 
11 
 
(17)
(2,152)
(2,169)
Amounts written-off
(1,018)
(912)
(1,930)
 
(1,063)
(2,718)
(3,781)
Recoveries of amounts previously written-off
80 
206 
286 
 
104 
46 
150 
Charge to income statement
                 
  - continuing
1,662 
2,473 
4,135 
 
2,046 
3,035 
5,081 
  - discontinued
(11)
(11)
 
42 
42 
Unwind of discount
(104)
(139)
(243)
 
(96)
(117)
(213)
                   
At end of period
8,752 
12,007 
20,759 
 
7,633 
8,533 
16,166 

 
139

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Loans, REIL and impairment provisions (continued)

Movement in loan impairment provisions (continued)

Key points
·
Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) was the main contributor to impairment losses with a total half year charge of £2.5 billion (Core - £0.7 billion; Non-Core - £1.8 billion), 61% of the total Group impairment charge of £4.1 billion. The Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) charge includes the impact of a re-assessment of collateral values relating to development land.
   
·
The other main contributor to the Q2 2011 Non-Core impairment charge was impairments in respect of a small number of large corporates.
   
·
Provision balance has increased by £2.6 billion in the first half of 2011 from £18.2 billion to £20.8 billion, as impairments are running twice the rate of write-offs.

Impairment provisions on loans and advances

 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Latent loss
1,568 
786 
2,354 
 
1,583 
963 
2,546 
 
1,653 
997 
2,650 
Collectively assessed
4,510 
1,100 
5,610 
 
4,375 
1,112 
5,487 
 
4,139 
1,157 
5,296 
Individually assessed
2,543 
10,120 
12,663 
 
2,329 
8,766 
11,095 
 
1,948 
8,161 
10,109 
                       
Customer loans
8,621 
12,006 
20,627 
 
8,287 
10,841 
19,128 
 
7,740 
10,315 
18,055 
Bank loans
131 
132 
 
129 
130 
 
126 
127 
                       
Total provisions
8,752 
12,007 
20,759 
 
8,416 
10,842 
19,258 
 
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 
                       
% of loans (1)
2.1% 
12.6% 
4.0% 
 
2.0% 
10.4% 
3.7% 
 
1.9% 
9.1% 
3.4% 

Note:
(1)
Customer provisions as a percentage of gross loans and advances to customers including disposal groups and excluding reverse repurchase agreements.
 
 
140

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Loans, REIL and impairment provisions (continued)

Impairment charge
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
Latent loss
(16)
(172)
(188)
 
(116)
(107)
Collectively assessed
465 
126 
591 
 
584 
136 
720 
Individually assessed
361 
1,473 
1,834 
 
384 
901 
1,285 
               
Customer loans
810 
1,427 
2,237 
 
852 
1,046 
1,898 
Securities  - sovereign debt impairment and
   related interest rate hedge adjustments
842 
842 
 
Securities  - other
43 
(16)
27 
 
20 
29 
49 
               
Charge to income statement
1,695 
1,411 
3,106 
 
872 
1,075 
1,947 
               
Charge relating to customer loans as a %
  of gross customer loans (1)
0.8% 
6.0% 
1.8% 
 
0.8% 
4.0% 
1.5% 

 
Half year ended
 
30 June 2011
 
30 June 2010
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
Latent loss
(132)
(163)
(295)
 
(69)
24 
(45)
Collectively assessed
1,049 
262 
1,311 
 
1,249 
344 
1,593 
Individually assessed
745 
2,374 
3,119 
 
866 
2,667 
3,533 
               
Customer loans
1,662 
2,473 
4,135 
 
2,046 
3,035 
5,081 
Securities  - sovereign debt impairment and
   related interest rate hedge adjustments
842 
842 
 
Securities  - other
63 
13 
76 
 
22 
59 
81 
               
Charge to income statement
2,567 
2,486 
5,053 
 
2,068 
3,094 
5,162 
               
Charge relating to customer loans as a %
  of gross customer loans (1)
0.8% 
5.2% 
1.6% 
 
1.0% 
4.8% 
1.8% 

Note:
(1)
Customer loan impairment charge as a percentage of gross loans and advances to customers including disposal groups and excluding reverse repurchase agreements.

Key points
·
Non-Core latent loss in Q2 2011 principally reflects the release of Ulster Bank’s provision relating to development land booked in Q1 2011, substituted with individually assessed impairment charge in Q2 2011.
   
·
The H1 2011 impairment charge was marginally lower than for H1 2010. The decrease in loan impairments of £0.9 billion was substantially offset by impairments of AFS Greek sovereign bonds.
 
 
141

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Debt securities

The table below analyses debt securities by issuer and measurement classification with short positions netted against debt securities. However such netting is not reflected in the Group’s balance sheet under IFRS.
 
 
Central and local government
       
 
UK 
US 
Other 
Financial 
institutions 
ABS 
Corporate 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
30 June 2011
             
Held-for-trading (HFT)
8,035 
14,608 
51,434 
12,099 
25,636 
6,357 
118,169 
DFV
192 
10 
213 
Available-for-sale
11,399 
16,600 
37,546 
7,951 
43,207 
1,965 
118,668 
Loans and receivables
11 
367 
5,813 
404 
6,595 
               
 
19,446 
31,208 
89,172 
20,427 
74,657 
8,735 
243,645 
Short positions (HFT)
(3,864)
(15,841)
(25,064)
(5,450)
(1,041)
(2,134)
(53,394)
               
 
15,582 
15,367 
64,108 
14,977 
73,616 
6,601 
190,251 
               
Available-for-sale
             
Gross unrealised gains
363 
474 
422 
71 
1,300 
62 
2,692 
Gross unrealised losses
(3)
(119)
(29)
(3,179)
(6)
(3,336)
               
31 March 2011
             
Held-for-trading
5,422 
19,079 
51,792 
7,461 
23,907 
5,478 
113,139 
DFV
199 
16 
114 
332 
Available-for-sale
8,474 
15,621 
34,325 
7,988 
42,884 
1,836 
111,128 
Loans and receivables
11 
391 
5,951 
432 
6,785 
               
 
13,908 
34,700 
86,316 
15,856 
72,856 
7,748 
231,384 
Short positions (HFT)
(4,852)
(12,715)
(22,463)
(3,421)
(1,014)
(2,684)
(47,149)
               
 
9,056 
21,985 
63,853 
12,435 
71,842 
5,064 
184,235 
               
Available-for-sale
             
Gross unrealised gains
207 
202 
346 
38 
1,102 
65 
1,960 
Gross unrealised losses
(24)
(44)
(820)
(31)
(3,201)
(33)
(4,153)
               
31 December 2010
             
Held-for-trading
5,097 
15,956 
43,224 
7,548 
21,988 
5,056 
98,869 
DFV
262 
16 
119 
402 
Available-for-sale
8,377 
17,890 
33,122 
7,849 
42,515 
1,377 
111,130 
Loans and receivables
11 
419 
6,203 
446 
7,079 
               
 
13,486 
33,846 
76,608 
15,832 
70,825 
6,883 
217,480 
Short positions (HFT)
(4,200)
(11,398)
(18,909)
(3,622)
(1,335)
(1,553)
(41,017)
               
 
9,286 
22,448 
57,699 
12,210 
69,490 
5,330 
176,463 
               
Available-for-sale
             
Gross unrealised gains
349 
341 
700 
60 
1,057 
88 
2,595 
Gross unrealised losses
(10)
(1)
(618)
(32)
(3,396)
(40)
(4,097)

 
142

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Debt securities (continued)

Key points
·
Held-for-trading bonds increased in H1 2011 by £19.3 billion, with increases in G10 and Australian government bonds. The increase in asset-backed securities (ABS) included £4.1 billion in GBM Mortgage trading primarily in US agency pass-through notes, reflecting strong investor appetite.
   
·
The Group has continued to add to its liquidity resources through the purchase of around £7.5 billion of top quality AFS government bonds during Q2 2011. These purchases for the Group’s liquidity portfolio have been focussed in the highest quality securities and most liquid markets. The growth in these liquidity reserves provides the Group with an opportunity to manage market risk and improve returns.

The table below analyses debt securities by issuer and external ratings.
 
 
Central and local government
         
 
UK 
US 
Other 
Financial 
institutions 
ABS 
Corporate 
Total 
% of 
 total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
30 June 2011
               
AAA
19,446 
31,208 
55,063 
7,759 
55,669 
435 
169,580 
70 
AA to AA+
5,290 
3,300 
5,668 
678 
14,936 
A to AA-
23,843 
5,191 
3,991 
1,797 
34,822 
14 
BBB- to A-
3,229 
1,848 
3,501 
2,442 
11,020 
Non-investment grade
1,687 
931 
4,579 
2,340 
9,537 
Unrated
60 
1,398 
1,249 
1,043 
3,750 
                 
 
19,446 
31,208 
89,172 
20,427 
74,657 
8,735 
243,645 
100 
                 
31 March 2011
               
AAA
13,908 
34,700 
51,272 
2,701 
52,867 
171 
155,619 
67 
AA to AA+
6,428 
3,341 
7,031 
640 
17,440 
A to AA-
22,778 
4,832 
3,187 
1,366 
32,163 
14 
BBB- to A-
3,351 
1,897 
3,799 
1,883 
10,930 
Non-investment grade
1,946 
1,300 
4,805 
3,413 
11,464 
Unrated
541 
1,785 
1,167 
275 
3,768 
                 
 
13,908 
34,700 
86,316 
15,856 
72,856 
7,748 
231,384 
100 
                 
31 December 2010
               
AAA
13,486 
33,846 
44,784 
3,084 
51,235 
153 
146,588 
67 
AA to AA+
18,025 
3,261 
6,335 
554 
28,175 
13 
A to AA-
9,138 
4,352 
3,244 
1,141 
17,875 
BBB- to A-
2,843 
1,489 
3,385 
1,869 
9,586 
Non-investment grade
1,766 
2,245 
4,923 
2,311 
11,245 
Unrated
52 
1,401 
1,703 
855 
4,011 
                 
 
13,486 
33,846 
76,608 
15,832 
70,825 
6,883 
217,480 
100 

Key points
·
The proportion of AAA rated debt securities increased to 70% primarily due to a move towards higher quality government bonds as well as demand for US agency pass-through notes.
   
·
Non-investment grade and unrated bonds were 5% of the portfolio compared with 7% at the end of Q1 2011 and 2010 year end.
 
 
143

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk:  Asset-backed securities

 
RMBS (1)
         
 
G10 
 government 
Covered 
 bond 
Prime 
Non- 
conforming 
Sub-prime 
CMBS (2) 
CDOs (3)
CLOs (4)
Other 
ABS 
Total 
30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                     
AAA
34,399 
7,345 
4,835 
1,587 
295 
1,991 
389 
2,116 
2,712 
55,669 
AA to AA+
1,401 
381 
451 
96 
138 
435 
539 
1,356 
871 
5,668 
A to AA-
144 
385 
239 
76 
280 
1,238 
389 
448 
792 
3,991 
BBB- to A-
61 
138 
301 
86 
398 
171 
582 
1,764 
3,501 
Non-investment grade
758 
727 
308 
408 
1,900 
259 
219 
4,579 
Unrated
108 
23 
101 
14 
97 
484 
422 
1,249 
                     
 
35,944 
8,172 
6,529 
2,810 
1,208 
4,484 
3,485 
5,245 
6,780 
74,657 
                     
31 March 2011
                   
AAA
32,067 
7,200 
4,140 
1,684 
273 
1,922 
424 
2,269 
2,888 
52,867 
AA to AA+
1,547 
475 
653 
96 
218 
744 
565 
1,617 
1,116 
7,031 
A to AA-
197 
118 
73 
246 
979 
358 
345 
871 
3,187 
BBB- to A-
157 
162 
299 
84 
390 
185 
578 
1,944 
3,799 
Non-investment grade
760 
917 
246 
439 
1,847 
344 
252 
4,805 
Unrated
25 
28 
143 
76 
673 
220 
1,167 
                     
 
33,614 
8,029 
5,858 
3,097 
1,210 
4,476 
3,455 
5,826 
7,291 
72,856 
                     
31 December 2010
                   
AAA
28,835 
7,107 
4,355 
1,754 
317 
2,789 
444 
2,490 
3,144 
51,235 
AA to AA+
1,529 
357 
147 
144 
116 
392 
567 
1,786 
1,297 
6,335 
A to AA-
408 
67 
60 
212 
973 
296 
343 
885 
3,244 
BBB- to A-
82 
316 
39 
500 
203 
527 
1,718 
3,385 
Non-investment grade
900 
809 
458 
296 
1,863 
332 
265 
4,923 
Unrated
196 
52 
76 
85 
596 
698 
1,703 
                     
 
30,364 
7,872 
5,747 
3,135 
1,218 
4,950 
3,458 
6,074 
8,007 
70,825 

Notes:
(1)
Residential mortgage-backed securities.
(2)
Commercial mortgage-backed securities.
(3)
Collateralised debt obligations.
(4)
Collateralised loan obligations.

For analyses of ABS by geography and measurement classification, refer to Appendix 2.

 
144

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Available-for-sale debt securities and reserves
The table below analyses available-for-sale (AFS) debt securities by issuer and related AFS reserves, gross and net of tax, for countries exceeding £0.5 billion, together with the total of those individually less than £0.5 billion.

 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31  December 2010
 
Central 
and local 
government 
ABS 
Other (1)
Total 
AFS 
 reserves
(gross)
AFS 
 reserves 
(net)
 
Central 
and local 
government 
ABS 
Other (1)
Total 
AFS 
 reserves 
(net)
 
Central 
and local 
government 
ABS 
Other (1)
Total 
AFS 
 reserves 
(net)
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                                     
US
16,600 
20,707 
521 
37,828 
131 
265 
 
15,670 
20,961 
731 
37,362 
(133)
 
17,890 
20,872 
763 
39,525 
(116)
UK
11,399 
4,286 
2,066 
17,751 
182 
(148)
 
8,500 
4,134 
2,052 
14,686 
(134)
 
8,377 
4,002 
2,284 
14,663 
(106)
Germany
14,218 
1,160 
477 
15,855 
(38)
(35)
 
12,584 
1,298 
500 
14,382 
(217)
 
10,649 
1,360 
535 
12,544 
(35)
Netherlands
5,323 
7,366 
782 
13,471 
(66)
40 
 
3,977 
7,096 
774 
11,847 
(8)
 
3,469 
6,773 
713 
10,955 
(59)
France
5,503 
628 
1,171 
7,302 
(36)
(22)
 
4,195 
579 
1,000 
5,774 
(42)
 
5,912 
575 
900 
7,387 
33 
Spain
91 
7,018 
51 
7,160 
(1,243)
(921)
 
91 
6,912 
78 
7,081 
(863)
 
88 
6,773 
157 
7,018 
(939)
Japan
4,240 
 - 
4,246 
 
4,204 
4,207 
 
4,354 
82 
4,436 
Australia
 - 
599 
2,141 
2,740 
(17)
(20)
 
467 
2,421 
2,888 
(27)
 
486 
1,586 
2,072 
(34)
Singapore
1,144 
 - 
213 
1,357 
 
798 
206 
1,004 
 
649 
209 
858 
Italy
955 
240 
16 
1,211 
(105)
(79)
 
928 
238 
24 
1,190 
(67)
 
906 
243 
24 
1,173 
(86)
Supranational
960 
960 
26 
25 
 
489 
489 
 
459 
459 
Denmark
694 
 - 
206 
900 
(3)
(3)
 
690 
251 
941 
(7)
 
629 
172 
801 
India
642 
 - 
175 
817 
(8)
(5)
 
657 
156 
813 
(3)
 
548 
139 
687 
Belgium
770 
36 
814 
(52)
(39)
 
742 
35 
785 
(32)
 
763 
34 
53 
850 
(34)
Greece
733 
 - 
733 
 
936 
936 
(476)
 
895 
895 
(517)
Switzerland
535 
 - 
173 
708 
12 
10 
 
749 
161 
910 
 
657 
156 
813 
11 
Austria
283 
162 
150 
595 
(34)
(27)
 
267 
50 
143 
460 
(19)
 
274 
51 
151 
476 
(20)
Sweden
79 
257 
253 
589 
 
77 
250 
219 
546 
 
30 
269 
165 
464 
Hong Kong
544 
 - 
545 
 
797 
12 
809 
 
905 
913 
South Korea
129 
271 
400 
 
229 
383 
612 
 
261 
429 
690 
(2)
Republic of
  Ireland
93 
160 
128 
381 
(100)
(75)
 
101 
161 
375 
637 
(67)
 
104 
177 
408 
689 
(74)
Other
1,570 
317 
418 
2,305 
(91)
(71)
 
2,228 
320 
221 
2,769 
(43)
 
2,029 
471 
262 
2,762 
(93)
                                     
 
65,545 
43,207 
9,916 
118,668 
(1,440)
(1,103)
 
58,420 
42,884 
9,824 
111,128 
(2,125)
 
59,389 
42,515 
9,226 
111,130 
(2,061)

Note:
(1)
Relates to financial institutes and corporates.
 
 
145

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Derivatives

The Group's derivative assets by internal grading scale and residual maturity are set out below. Master netting arrangements in respect of mark-to-market (mtm) values and collateral do not result in a net presentation in the Group’s balance sheet under IFRS.
 
   
30 June 2011
   
Asset
quality
Probability
of default range
0-3 
months 
3-6 
months 
6-12 
months 
1-5 
years 
Over 5 
years 
Total 
31 March 
2011 
Total 
31 December 
2010 
Total 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
AQ1
0% - 0.034%
23,480 
10,823 
16,883 
114,941 
190,904 
357,031 
323,302 
408,489 
AQ2
0.034% - 0.048%
648 
154 
366 
1,666 
2,766 
5,600 
5,365 
2,659 
AQ3
0.048% - 0.095%
1,523 
461 
741 
3,293 
4,890 
10,908 
10,780 
3,317 
AQ4
0.095% - 0.381%
776 
138 
429 
2,434 
2,847 
6,624 
6,349 
3,391 
AQ5
0.381% - 1.076%
602 
164 
251 
2,290 
3,626 
6,933 
6,396 
4,860 
AQ6
1.076% - 2.153%
1,574 
57 
121 
963 
880 
3,595 
3,991 
1,070 
AQ7
2.153% - 6.089%
194 
25 
55 
511 
1,287 
2,072 
1,880 
857 
AQ8
6.089% - 17.222%
10 
108 
532 
654 
786 
403 
AQ9
17.222% - 100%
20 
10 
24 
192 
240 
486 
995 
450 
AQ10
100%
184 
36 
468 
274 
969 
1,204 
1,581 
                   
   
29,004 
11,840 
18,916 
126,866 
208,246 
394,872 
361,048 
427,077 
Counterparty mtm netting
         
(323,455)
(290,462)
(330,397)
Cash collateral held against derivative exposures
         
(27,500)
(25,363)
(31,096)
Net exposure
           
43,917 
45,223 
65,584 

At 30 June 2011, the Group also held collateral in the form of securities of £4.2 billion (31 March 2011 - £3.3 billion; 31 December 2010 - £2.9 billion) against derivative positions.

The table below analyses the fair value of the Group’s derivatives by type of contract.

 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Assets 
Liabilities 
 
Assets 
Liabilities 
 
Assets 
Liabilities 
Contract type
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                 
Interest rate contracts
283,966 
269,638 
 
259,006 
250,515 
 
311,731 
299,209 
Exchange rate contracts
72,682 
78,095 
 
73,552 
79,045 
 
83,253 
89,375 
Credit derivatives
32,507 
30,877 
 
22,704 
21,689 
 
26,872 
25,344 
Equity and commodity contracts
5,717 
9,199 
 
5,786 
9,376 
 
5,221 
10,039 
                 
 
394,872 
387,809 
 
361,048 
360,625 
 
427,077 
423,967 

Key points

30 June 2011 compared with 31 March 2011
·
Net exposure, after taking account of position and collateral netting arrangements reduced marginally in Q2 2011, despite an increase in derivative carrying values.
   
·
Interest rate contracts increased due to lower over-the-counter contract compression trades, reductions in interest rate yields and depreciation of sterling against the euro. This was partially offset by the effect of the appreciation of sterling against the US dollar. All major five year interest rate indices (sterling, euro, and US dollar), moved down, decreasing by approximately 45, 26, and 39 basis points respectively. 
 
 
146

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Derivatives (continued)

Key points (continued)

30 June 2011 compared with 31 March 2011 (continued)
·
Exchange rate contracts decreased due to the trading fluctuations and movements in forward rates and volume.
   
·
Credit derivative fair values increased by £9.8 billion, primarily as a result of de-risking of Non-Core where hedging trades resulted in higher assets and liabilities. Widening credit spreads also contributed to the increase in Non-Core.

30 June 2011 compared with 31 December 2010
·
Net exposure, after taking account of position and collateral netting arrangements, reduced by 33%, primarily reflecting reductions in derivative carrying values.
   
·
The main driver of the £28 billion decrease in interest rate assets reflected greater use of over-the-counter contract compression trades during H1 2011 overall and appreciation of sterling against the US dollar, as the majority of interest rate contracts are US dollar denominated. This was partially offset by a reduction in clearing house netting, downward shifts in US interest rate yields and increased net new business.
   
·
Exchange rate contracts decreased due to trading fluctuations and movements in forward rates and volume.
   
·
Credit derivatives increased by £5.6 billion, primarily as a result of de-risking of Non-Core where hedging trades put in place in Q2 2011 resulted in higher assets and liabilities. Widening credit spreads also increased carrying values in Non-Core’s Structured Credit Products.
 
 
147

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Derivatives (continued)

The Group’s exposures to monolines and CDPCs by credit rating are summarised below, ratings are based on the lower of S&P and Moody’s. All of these exposures are in Non-Core.

 
Notional:
 protected
 assets
Fair value:
reference
 protected
assets
Gross
 exposure
Credit
valuation
adjustment
(CVA)
Hedges
Net
 exposure
Monoline insurers
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
30 June 2011
           
A to AA-
5,547 
4,936 
611 
166 
445 
Non-investment grade
7,079 
4,047 
3,032 
2,155 
68 
809 
             
 
12,626 
8,983 
3,643 
2,321 
68 
1,254 
             
Of which:
           
CMBS
3,853 
2,131 
1,722 
1,285 
   
CDOs
1,086 
230 
856 
596 
   
CLOs
4,946 
4,561 
385 
107 
   
Other ABS
2,241 
1,739 
502 
250 
   
Other
500 
322 
178 
83 
   
             
 
12,626 
8,983 
3,643 
2,321 
   
             
31 March 2011
           
A to AA-
5,759 
5,121 
638 
194 
444 
Non-investment grade
8,123 
5,246 
2,877 
1,984 
69 
824 
             
 
13,882 
10,367 
3,515 
2,178 
69 
1,268 
             
Of which:
           
CMBS
3,859 
2,316 
1,543 
1,132 
   
CDOs
1,092 
245 
847 
569 
   
CLOs
6,183 
5,747 
436 
139 
   
Other ABS
2,260 
1,734 
526 
260 
   
Other
488 
325 
163 
78 
   
             
 
13,882 
10,367 
3,515 
2,178 
   
             
31 December 2010
           
A to AA-
6,336 
5,503 
833 
272 
561 
Non-investment grade
8,555 
5,365 
3,190 
2,171 
71 
948 
             
 
14,891 
10,868 
4,023 
2,443 
71 
1,509 
             
Of which:
           
CMBS
4,149 
2,424 
1,725 
1,253 
   
CDOs
1,133 
256 
877 
593 
   
CLOs
6,724 
6,121 
603 
210 
   
Other ABS
2,393 
1,779 
614 
294 
   
Other
492 
288 
204 
93 
   
             
 
14,891 
10,868 
4,023 
2,443 
   

Key points

30 June 2011 compared with 31 March 2011
·
The gross exposure to monolines increased primarily due to lower prices of underlying reference instruments.
   
·
The CVA increased reflecting the increase in exposure and widened credit spreads.

 
148

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Derivatives (continued)

30 June 2011 compared with 31 December 2010
·
The exposure to monolines decreased primarily due to higher prices of underlying reference instruments.  The trades with monolines are predominantly US dollar denominated.  The strengthening of sterling against the US dollar further decreased the exposure.
   
·
The CVA decreased on a total basis, with a reduction in exposure but partially offset by the impact of wider credit spreads.

 
Notional:
protected
 assets
Fair value:
reference
protected
assets
Gross
exposure
Credit
valuation
adjustment
Net
exposure
CDPCs
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
30 June 2011
         
AAA
205 
205 
A to AA-
622 
607 
15 
11 
Non-investment grade
19,724 
18,759 
965 
427 
538 
Unrated
3,927 
3,712 
215 
101 
114 
           
 
24,478 
23,283 
1,195 
532 
663 
           
31 March 2011
         
AAA
206 
206 
A to AA-
623 
607 
16 
11 
Non-investment grade
19,686 
18,793 
893 
362 
531 
Unrated
3,964 
3,772 
192 
78 
114 
           
 
24,479 
23,378 
1,101 
445 
656 
           
31 December 2010
         
AAA
213 
212 
A to AA-
644 
629 
15 
11 
Non-investment grade
20,066 
19,050 
1,016 
401 
615 
Unrated
4,165 
3,953 
212 
85 
127 
           
 
25,088 
23,844 
1,244 
490 
754 

Key points

30 June 2011 compared with 31 March 2011
·
Exposure to CDPCs increased primarily driven by wider credit spreads on the underlying reference loans and bonds, partially offset by a decrease in the relative value of senior tranches compared with that of underlying reference portfolios.
·
The CVA increased in line with the increased exposure.

30 June 2011 compared with 31 December 2010
·
Exposure to CDPCs reduced, primarily driven by a decrease in the relative value of senior tranches compared with that of the underlying reference portfolios. This was partially offset by wider credit spreads on the underlying reference instruments. The trades with CDPCs are predominantly US and Canadian dollar denominated. The strengthening of sterling against these currencies also contributed to the decrease in exposure.
·
The increase in CVA was primarily driven by an increase in the estimated cost of hedging expected underlying portfolio default losses in excess of the capital available in each vehicle. The level of CVA on CDPC exposures is estimated by reference to cost of hedging as above and recent market events affecting CDPCs, including commutation activity.

 
149

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Cross border exposures

Cross border exposures consist of loans and advances gross of provisions and other financial instruments, such as debt securities and derivatives, including non-local currency claims of overseas on local residents. The geographical analysis is basedon the country of domicile of the borrower or guarantor of ultimate risk. Cross border exposures exclude exposure to local residents in local currency.

The table below sets out the Group’s cross border exposures greater than 0.5% of the Group’s total assets at 30 June 2011. Short positions have been netted against cross border exposures. However such netting is not reflected in the Group’s balance sheet under IFRS. None of these countries have experienced repayment difficulties that have so far required restructuring of outstanding debt. On 21 July 2011 proposals to restructure Greek government debt were announced by the Heads of State or Government of the Euro area and EU institutions.  These proposals include a voluntary programme of debt exchange and a buyback plan developed by the Greek government.

 
30 June 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Government 
Banks 
Other
Total 
Short 
positions 
Net of short 
positions 
 
Government 
Banks 
Other
Total 
Short 
positions 
Net of short 
positions 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                           
US
22,912 
9,721 
39,259 
71,892 
19,484 
52,408 
 
21,201 
14,382 
36,813 
72,396 
14,240 
58,156 
France
18,905 
18,956 
6,635 
44,496 
6,069 
38,427 
 
17,293 
16,007 
6,756 
40,056 
4,285 
35,771 
Germany
21,741 
6,595 
8,320 
36,656 
5,391 
31,265 
 
22,962 
6,276 
10,467 
39,705 
4,685 
35,020 
Netherlands
4,303 
5,186 
11,778 
21,267 
1,287 
19,980 
 
2,900 
3,055 
10,824 
16,779 
951 
15,828 
Japan
5,421 
7,789 
5,777 
18,987 
3,336 
15,651 
 
7,983 
6,962 
7,542 
22,487 
409 
22,078 
Spain
1,247 
4,911 
11,242 
17,400 
2,402 
14,998 
 
1,401 
4,248 
11,589 
17,238 
1,357 
15,881 
Italy
8,501 
1,671 
1,846 
12,018 
5,337 
6,681 
 
6,409 
1,083 
2,188 
9,680 
3,183 
6,497 
Switzerland
4,313 
4,024 
3,309 
11,646 
18 
11,628 
 
1,714 
2,944 
4,662 
12 
4,650 
Republic of Ireland
186 
3,094 
2,376 
5,656 
82 
5,574 
 
199 
3,789 
3,101 
7,089 
131 
6,958 
                           
Set out below are cross border exposures for selected other eurozone countries:
             
Portugal
189 
536 
957 
1,682 
113 
1,569 
 
197 
985 
472 
1,654 
121 
1,533 
Greece
1,032 
48 
840 
1,920 
29 
1,891 
 
1,015 
228 
1,175 
2,418 
37 
2,381 

 
150

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Country risk

Country exposures are managed under the Group's country risk framework. This includes active management of exposures that have either been identified as exhibiting signs of actual or potential stress using the Group's country watchlist process or where it is considered appropriate to actively control exposure levels.  Limit controls are applied on a risk-differentiated basis. Granular portfolio reviews are undertaken with a view to adjusting the risk profile and to align to the Group’s country risk appetite in light of the evolving economic and political developments.

A re-appraisal of sovereign default risk among the most vulnerable eurozone economies has resulted in intensified management responses. This included frequent, comprehensive and detailed reviews of exposures to each of these countries, including increased vigilance in counterparty monitoring, leading to several divestments and limit reductions to ensure the Group’s exposure remains within defined risk appetite. Exposure to Irish banks for example is now less than half of the exposure in Q4 2008.

In addition to the macroeconomic and strategic analysis in the regular country risk control process, the Group has undertaken sovereign-related stress tests and a series of broad thematic reviews of possible high-impact scenarios related to the eurozone crisis, with potential impact and mitigating actions. Investigated themes include sovereign debt restructuring, various eurozone break-up scenarios and a re-examination of potential financial sector support given ongoing public finance and political pressures. These reviews combine operational analysis with strategic commentary to develop detailed contingency plans and identify potential business opportunities.

A dynamic limit setting methodology was introduced with an automatic reduction of trading limits upon evidence of reduced liquidity or increased CDS spreads. This approach has resulted in an effective reduction in sovereign issuer risk limits for the vulnerable eurozone countries.

The table below shows the Group’s exposure in terms of credit risk assets, to countries where the exposure to counterparties domiciled in that country exceeded £1 billion and where the country had an external rating of A+ or below from Standard & Poor’s, Moody’s or Fitch at 30 June 2011, and selected other countries. The numbers are stated gross of mitigating action which may have been taken to reduce or eliminate exposure to country risk events.

Further details for selected eurozone countries are provided in Appendix 2.
 
 
151

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Country risk (continued)
 
 
Lending
   
 
Central
and local
government
Central
 banks
Other
financial
institutions
Corporate
Personal
Total
Core
Non-
Core
 
Derivatives and
contingent obligations
30 June 2011
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
 
£m
                     
Republic of Ireland
53
1,557
459
20,669
20,773
43,511
32,364
11,147
 
2,448
India
192
260
1,170
2,625
16
4,263
3,975
288
 
1,448
Italy
7
81
1,121
2,317
26
3,552
1,891
1,661
 
2,323
China
14
223
1,431
647
34
2,349
2,177
172
 
1,697
South Korea
-
12
1,078
710
2
1,802
1,786
16
 
394
Turkey
207
36
312
1,216
13
1,784
1,221
563
 
556
Russia
-
49
815
808
65
1,737
1,610
127
 
248
Brazil
-
-
1,001
301
4
1,306
1,185
121
 
88
Mexico
-
8
249
1,036
1
1,294
872
422
 
198
Romania
34
183
48
477
401
1,143
17
1,126
 
125
Poland
41
5
52
723
5
826
744
82
 
372
Indonesia
83
57
233
264
133
770
632
138
 
321
Portugal
45
-
48
585
5
683
327
356
 
555
                     
Additional selected countries
               
                     
Spain
20
13
1,197
6,842
405
8,477
4,022
4,455
 
2,372
Belgium
172
11
1,182
983
19
2,367
1,855
512
 
2,342
Japan
401
-
1,028
756
24
2,209
1,561
648
 
1,907
Greece
10
9
36
421
15
491
341
150
 
220

31 December 2010
                   
                     
Republic of Ireland
61
2,119
900
19,881
20,228
43,189
32,431
10,758
 
3,496
India
262
-
1,614
2,590
273
4,739
4,085
654
 
1,249
Italy
45
78
1,086
2,483
27
3,719
1,817
1,902
 
2,312
China
17
298
1,240
753
64
2,372
2,136
236
 
1,572
South Korea
-
276
1,039
555
2
1,872
1,822
50
 
643
Turkey
282
68
485
1,365
12
2,212
1,520
692
 
547
Russia
-
110
251
1,181
58
1,600
1,475
125
 
216
Brazil
-
-
825
315
5
1,145
1,025
120
 
120
Mexico
-
8
149
999
1
1,157
854
303
 
148
Romania
36
178
42
426
446
1,128
7
1,121
 
142
Poland
-
168
13
655
6
842
736
106
 
381
Indonesia
84
42
262
293
131
812
657
155
 
273
Portugal
86
-
63
611
6
766
450
316
 
537
                     
Additional selected countries
               
                     
Spain
19
5
258
6,962
407
7,651
3,130
4,521
 
2,447
Belgium
102
14
473
893
327
1,809
1,307
502
 
2,546
Japan
1,379
-
685
809
24
2,897
2,105
792
 
2,000
Greece
14
36
49
188
16
303
173
130
 
214

Note:
(1)
Credit risk assets consist of:
 
Lending: cash and balances at central banks, loans and advances to banks and customers (including overdraft facilities, instalment credit and finance leases). Undrawn commitments are excluded;
 
Derivative exposures are measured at mark-to-market and net of liabilities where a master netting arrangement is enforceable;
 
Contingent obligations, primarily letters of credit and guarantees. Undrawn commitments are excluded.

 
152

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Country risk (continued)

Key points
·
Exposure shows a mixed picture for the selected countries during the first half of 2011. Currency movements increased euro denominated lending by 4.6% and reduced US dollar denominated exposures by 3.5%. There were reductions in lending to governments, central banks and corporate clients whereas exposure to banks increased. Non-Core exposures fell, except in a few countries where drawings took place under committed facilities. Appendix 2 provides further commentary and details on selected eurozone countries, including held-for-trading and available-for-sale holdings.
   
·
Japan - lending exposure at £2.2 billion reduced by £0.7 billion since 31 December 2010 driven by a reduction in government lending.
   
·
North Africa and the Middle East - exposure reduced during the first half of 2011. Of the countries experiencing varying degrees of social and political unrest. Lending exposure to Bahrain and Egypt was £197 million and £77 million respectively. Exposure to Libya and Syria is negligible.
 
 
153

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate

The commercial real estate lending portfolio totalled £84.6 billion at 30 June 2011, a 5.9% decrease since 31 December 2010 (£89.9 billion). The Non-Core portion of the portfolio totalled £42.7 billion (50.5% of the portfolio) at 30 June 2011 (31 December 2010 - £47.7 billion, or 53.0% of the portfolio) and includes exposures in Ulster Bank Group as discussed on page 162. The analysis below excludes RRM and contingent obligations.

 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Investment 
Development 
Total 
 
Investment 
Development 
Total 
 
Investment 
Development 
Total 
By division
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Core
                     
UK Corporate(1)
25,472 
5,839 
31,311 
 
26,514 
6,124 
32,638 
 
24,879 
5,819 
30,698 
Ulster Bank
4,338 
955 
5,293 
 
4,272 
1,015 
5,287 
 
4,284 
1,090 
5,374 
US Retail &
  Commercial
4,009 
98 
4,107 
 
4,083 
87 
4,170 
 
4,322 
93 
4,415 
GBM
775 
402 
1,177 
 
1,030 
417 
1,447 
 
1,131 
644 
1,775 
                       
 
34,594 
7,294 
41,888 
 
35,899 
7,643 
43,542 
 
34,616 
7,646 
42,262 
                       
Non-Core
                     
UK Corporate
4,765 
2,504 
7,269 
 
5,372 
2,701 
8,073 
 
7,591 
3,263 
10,854 
Ulster Bank
4,076 
9,002 
13,078 
 
3,947 
8,881 
12,828 
 
3,854 
8,760 
12,614 
US Retail &
  Commercial
1,101 
49 
1,150 
 
1,234 
55 
1,289 
 
1,325 
70 
1,395 
GBM
20,823 
399 
21,222 
 
21,707 
523 
20,230 
 
22,405 
417 
22,822 
                       
 
30,765 
11,954 
42,719 
 
32,260 
12,160 
44,420 
 
35,175 
12,510 
47,685 
                       
 
65,359 
19,248 
84,607 
 
68,159 
19,803 
87,962 
 
69,791 
20,156 
89,947 

Note:
(1)
The increase in Core UK Corporate exposures in Q1 2011 reflected Non-Core returning commercial real estate assets, in preparation for the sale of the RBS England and Wales branch-based business to Santander.

 
154

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate (continued)

 
Investment
 
Development
 
 
Commercial 
Residential 
 
Commercial 
Residential 
Total 
By geography
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
30 June 2011
           
UK (excluding Northern Ireland)
31,116 
6,696 
 
1,356 
7,763 
46,931 
Ireland (ROI & NI) (1)
5,424 
1,210 
 
2,762 
6,701 
16,097 
Western Europe
10,887 
1,565 
 
13 
87 
12,552 
US
5,880 
1,196 
 
79 
108 
7,263 
RoW
1,361 
24 
 
149 
230 
1,764 
             
 
54,668 
10,691 
 
4,359 
14,889 
84,607 
             
31 March 2011
           
UK (excluding Northern Ireland)
32,221 
7,195 
 
1,405 
8,184 
49,005 
Ireland (ROI & NI) (1)
5,153 
1,143 
 
2,848 
6,556 
15,700 
Western Europe
12,273 
712 
 
70 
13,063 
US
6,696 
1,252 
 
234 
97 
8,279 
RoW
1,490 
24 
 
141 
260 
1,915 
             
 
57,833 
10,326 
 
4,636 
15,167 
87,962 
             
31 December 2010
           
UK (excluding Northern Ireland)
32,979 
7,255 
 
1,520 
8,296 
50,050 
Ireland (ROI & NI) (1)
5,056 
1,148 
 
2,785 
6,578 
15,567 
Western Europe
12,262 
707 
 
25 
46 
13,040 
US
7,405 
1,332 
 
69 
175 
8,981 
RoW
1,622 
25 
 
138 
524 
2,309 
             
 
59,324 
10,467 
 
4,537 
15,619 
89,947 

Note:
(1)
ROI: Republic of Ireland; NI: Northern Ireland.
 
 
155

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate (continued)

 
Investment
 
Development
 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
By geography
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
30 June 2011
           
UK (excluding Northern Ireland)
26,564 
11,248 
 
6,023 
3,096 
46,931 
Ireland (ROI & NI)
3,364 
3,270 
 
858 
8,605 
16,097 
Western Europe
431 
12,021 
 
55 
45 
12,552 
US
4,059 
3,017 
 
131 
56 
7,263 
RoW
176 
1,209 
 
227 
152 
1,764 
             
 
34,594 
30,765 
 
7,294 
11,954 
84,607 
             
31 March 2011
           
UK (excluding Northern Ireland)
27,658 
11,758 
 
6,320 
3,269 
49,005 
Ireland (ROI & NI)
3,189 
3,107 
 
899 
8,505 
15,700 
Western Europe
378 
12,607 
 
50 
28 
13,063 
US
4,396 
3,552 
 
121 
210 
8,279 
RoW
278 
1,236 
 
253 
148 
1,915 
             
 
35,899 
32,261 
 
7,643 
12,159 
87,962 
             
31 December 2010
           
UK (excluding Northern Ireland)
26,168 
14,066 
 
5,997 
3,819 
50,050 
Ireland (ROI & NI)
3,159 
3,044 
 
963 
8,401 
15,567 
Western Europe
409 
12,560 
 
25 
46 
13,040 
US
4,636 
4,101 
 
173 
71 
8,981 
RoW
244 
1,404 
 
488 
173 
2,309 
             
 
34,616 
35,175 
 
7,646 
12,510 
89,947 

By sub-sector (1)
UK 
(excl NI) 
£m 
Ireland 
(ROI & NI) 
£m 
Western 
Europe 
£m 
US 
£m 
RoW 
£m 
Total 
£m 
             
30 June 2011
           
Residential
14,449 
9,046 
1,650 
1,304 
254 
26,703 
Office
7,766 
462 
4,446 
552 
806 
14,032 
Retail
9,671 
956 
2,618 
268 
296 
13,809 
Industrial
4,589 
183 
675 
53 
51 
5,551 
Mixed/other
10,456 
5,450 
3,163 
5,086 
357 
24,512 
             
 
46,931 
16,097 
12,552 
7,263 
1,764 
84,607 
             
31 December 2010
 
Residential
15,551 
7,726 
753 
1,507 
549 
26,086 
Office
8,551 
1,402 
4,431 
675 
891 
15,950 
Retail
10,607 
3,985 
1,933 
1,029 
479 
18,033 
Industrial
4,928 
674 
711 
80 
106 
6,499 
Mixed/other
10,413 
1,780 
5,212 
5,690 
284 
23,379 
             
 
50,050 
15,567 
13,040 
8,981 
2,309 
89,947 

Note:
(1)
Excludes RRM and contingent obligations.
 
 
156

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate (continued)

Key points
·
The decrease in the commercial real estate portfolio over the last six months has occurred primarily in the UK. The growth shown in Ireland is due to foreign exchange rate movements. The asset mix has remained broadly unchanged since the end of 2010.
   
·
Of the total portfolio at 30 June 2011, £39.0 billion (31 December 2010 - £46.3 billion) is managed within the Group’s standard credit risk processes, £6.2 billion (31 December 2010 - £9.2 billion) is receiving heightened credit oversight under the Group watchlist process (“watch”) and £39.5 billion (31 December 2010 - £34.4 billion) is managed within Global Restructuring Group (GRG). The increase in the portfolio managed by GRG is primarily driven by Ulster Bank Group.
   
·
Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) commercial real estate lending of £18.4 billion had a provision of £6.0 billion at 30 June 2011.
   
·
Short-term lending to property developers without firm long-term financing in place is characterised as speculative. Speculative lending at origination continues to represent less than 1% of the portfolio.
   
·
Tighter risk appetite criteria for new business origination were implemented during 2010. Whilst there has been some recovery in the value of prime properties in the UK, the Group observes that it has been inconsistent. To date this recovery has not fed through into lower quality properties in the UK and has not been evident in other regions, notably the eurozone and Republic of Ireland.
   
·
The commercial real estate market will remain challenging in key markets and new business will be accommodated by running-off existing exposure. Liquidity in the market remains tight and so the Group’s focus remains on re-financing and supporting the existing client base.


 
157

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Retail assets

The Group's retail lending portfolio includes mortgages, credit cards, unsecured loans, auto finance and overdrafts. The majority of personal lending exposures are in the UK, Ireland and the US. The table below includes both Core and Non-Core balances.

 
30 June 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Personal credit risk assets
£m 
£m 
     
UK Retail
   
  - mortgages
95,955 
92,592 
  - cards, loans and overdrafts
16,941 
18,072 
Ulster Bank
   
  - mortgages
21,778 
21,162 
  - other personal
1,605 
1,017 
Citizens
   
  - mortgages
23,513 
24,575 
  - auto and cards
5,575 
6,062 
  - other (1)
3,070 
3,455 
Other (2)
16,409 
18,123 
     
 
184,846 
185,058 

Notes:
(1)
Mainly student loans and recreational vehicles/marine.
(2)
Personal exposures in other divisions.
 
 
Residential mortgages
The table below details the distribution of residential mortgages by indexed LTV. Ulster Bank Group is discussed on page 162.

 
UK Retail
 
Citizens
 
30 June 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Distribution by average LTV (1)
 
           
<= 50%
37.9 
38.5 
 
26.9 
25.8 
> 50% and <= 70%
22.4 
23.2 
 
18.1 
17.3 
> 70% and <= 90%
26.4 
26.2 
 
26.6 
27.4 
> 90%
13.3 
12.1 
 
28.4 
29.5 
           
Total portfolio average LTV
59.0 
58.2 
 
75.3 
75.3 
           
Average LTV on new originations
54.9 
64.2 
 
65.0 
64.8 

Note:
(1)
LTV averages are calculated by transaction volume.
 
 
158

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Retail assets - Residential mortgages (continued)

The table below details the residential mortgages which are three months or more in arrears (by volume).
 
30 June 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
     
UK Retail (1)
1.7 
1.7 
Citizens
1.2 
1.4 

Note:
(1)
UK Retail arrears analysis covers all mortgage brands except the One Account Current Account Mortgage and some small legacy portfolios and so represents 92% of the total UK Retail mortgage portfolio. The One Account accounts for the vast majority of the remainder (c.£8 billion of assets, c.8% of the total) and had 1.0% of accounts 90 days continually in excess of limit as at 30 June 2011 (31 March 2011 - 0.9%).

UK Retail residential mortgages

Key points
·
The UK Retail mortgage portfolio totalled £96.0 billion at 30 June 2011, an increase of 3.6% from 31 December 2010, due to continued strong sales growth and lower redemption rates relative to before the financial crisis. Of the total portfolio, 98.4% is designated as Core business with the primary brands being the Royal Bank of Scotland, NatWest, the One Account and First Active. Non-Core comprises Direct Line Mortgages. The assets are prime mortgage lending and include 6.8% (£6.5 billion) of exposure to residential buy-to-let. There is a small legacy self certification book (0.3% of total assets), which was withdrawn from sale in 2004.
·
Gross new mortgage lending in H1 2011 remained strong at £7.8 billion. The average LTV for new business during H1 2011 was 54.9% compared with 64.2% in FY 2010. The maximum LTV available to new customers remains at 90%. Based on the Halifax House Price index at March 2011, the book average indexed LTV has increased marginally to 59.0% from 58.2% at 31 December 2010, influenced by the fall in house prices with the proportion of balances with an LTV over 100% at 30 June 2011 at 7.8%, up from 6.9% at 31 December 2010.
·
The arrears rate (more than 3 payments in arrears, excluding repossessions and shortfalls post property sale) has remained broadly stable since late 2009 at 1.7%.
·
The mortgage impairment charge was £116 million for the half year ended 30 June 2011 (Q1 2011 - £61 million; Q2 2011 - £55 million) an increase of 36.7% from H2 2010.  A significant part of this relates to adjustments reflecting reduced expectations of recovery on prior period defaulted debt and provisions relating to mortgages in forbearance.  Default and arrears rates remain sensitive to economic developments and are currently supported by the low interest rate environment and strong book growth with recent business yet to mature.
·
A number of initiatives aimed at supporting customers experiencing temporary financial difficulties remain in place. Forbearance/re-negotiation activities include offering reduced or deferred payment terms on a temporary basis for a period of up to twelve months, during which arrears continue to accrue on the account, as well as term extensions beyond the originally planned repayment date, and also re-capitalisations from the non-performing book back to performing. It is Group policy not to initiate repossession proceedings for at least six months after arrears are evident. The number of properties repossessed in H1 2011 was 715 which is broadly in line with the 2010 average.
 
 
159

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Retail assets - Residential mortgages (continued)

Citizens residential real estate

Key points
·
Citizens total residential real estate portfolio totalled £23.5 billion ($37.8 billion) at 30 June 2011 (31 December 2010 - £24.6 billion ($38.2 billion)). The residential real estate portfolio comprises £6.3 billion ($10.1 billion) (Core - £5.6 billion ($9.0 billion); Non-Core - £0.7 billion ($1.1 billion)) of first lien residential mortgages and £17.2 billion ($27.7 billion) (Core - £14.6 billion ($23.4 billion); Non-Core - £2.7 billion ($4.3 billion)) of home equity loans and lines (first and second lien). Home equity Core consists of 46% first lien position while Non-Core consists of 98% second lien position. The Core business comprises 86% of the portfolio and Non-Core comprising 14%, with the serviced by others (SBO) portfolio being the largest component (74%) of the Non-Core portfolio.
   
·
Citizens continues to focus on the ‘footprint states’ in New England, Mid Atlantic and Mid West targeting low risk products and maintaining conservative risk policies.  At 30 June 2011, the portfolio consisted of £19.8 billion ($31.8 billion) (84% of the total portfolio) in these footprint states.
   
·
The current weighted average LTV of the residential real estate portfolio remained flat at 75.3% at 31 December 2010 and 30 June 2011.  The current weighted average LTV of the residential real estate portfolio excluding SBO is 70.0%.
   
·
The arrears rate decreased from 1.4% at 31 December 2010 to 1.2% at 30 June 2011. Delinquency rates have stabilised in recent months for both residential mortgages and home equity loans and lines.  Citizens participate in the US Government Home Modification Program alongside other bank-sponsored initiatives, which has helped customers.
   
·
The SBO portfolio consists of purchased pools of home equity loans and lines (96% second lien) with current LTV (108% at 30 June 2011) and geographic profiles (73% outside of Citizens footprint) resulting in an annualised charge-off rate of 9.7% in H1 2011.  The SBO book has been closed to new purchases since the third quarter of 2007 and is in run-off, with exposure down from £2.9 billion ($4.5 billion) at 31 December 2010 to £2.5 billion ($4.0 billion) at 30 June 2011. The arrears rate of the SBO portfolio has decreased from 2.7% at 31 December 2010 to 2.2% at 30 June 2011 due to more effective account servicing and collections.
 
 
160

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Retail assets - Personal lending

The Group's personal lending portfolio includes credit cards, unsecured loans, auto finance and overdrafts. The majority of personal lending exposures are in the UK and the US. New defaults as a proportion of average loans and advances are shown in the following table.

 
30 June 2011
 
31 December 2010
Personal lending
Average 
 loans and 
 receivables 
£m 
Impairment 
 charge 
 as a % of 
 loans and 
 receivables 
%
 
Average 
 loans and 
 receivables 
£m 
Impairment 
 charge 
as a % of 
loans and 
 receivables 
%
           
UK Retail cards (1)
5,719 
3.0 
 
6,025 
5.0 
UK Retail loans (1)
8,400 
2.4 
 
9,863 
4.8 
           
 
£m 
 
£m 
           
Citizens cards (2)
904 
5.8 
 
1,006 
9.9 
Citizens auto loans (2)
4,696 
0.1 
 
5,262 
0.6 

Notes:
(1)
The ratios for UK Retail assets refers to the impairment charges for the full year 2010 and annualised for June 2011.
(2)
The ratios for Citizens refers to charge-offs, net of recoveries realised in the period.

Key points
·
The UK personal lending portfolio, of which 98.1% is in Core businesses, comprises credit cards, unsecured loans and overdrafts and totalled £16.9 billion at 30 June 2011 (31 December 2010 - £18.1 billion), a decrease of 6.6% due to continued subdued loan recruitment activity and a continuing general market trend of customers repaying unsecured loan balances, and with cards and current account balances remaining stable. The Non-Core portfolio consists of the direct finance loan portfolios (Direct Line, Lombard, Mint and Churchill), and totalled £0.3 billion at 30 June 2011 (31 December 2010 - £0.4 billion).
   
·
Risk appetite continues to be actively managed across all products. Support continues for customers experiencing financial difficulties through “breathing space initiatives” on all unsecured products, whereby a thirty day period is given to allow customers to establish a debt repayment plan. During this time the Group suspends collection activity. A further extension of thirty days can be granted if progress is made and discussions are continuing. Investment in collection and recovery processes continues, addressing both continued support for the Group’s customers and the management of impairments.
   
·
UK Retail benefited from a combination of risk appetite tightening and a more favourable economic environment, impairment losses on unsecured lending have reduced from £395 million in H2 2010 to £287 million in H1 2011 with underlying default trends having now broadly stabilised. Impairments will remain sensitive to the external environment.
   
·
Industry benchmarks for cards arrears remain stable, with the Group continuing to perform favourably.
   
·
Outstanding balances for the Citizens credit card portfolio totalled £0.89 billion (US$1.43 billion) at 30 June 2011.  Core assets comprised 88% of the portfolio.
 
 
161

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core)

Overview
Ulster Bank Group accounts for 10.2% of the Group’s total gross customer loans (31 March 2011 - 10.1%; 31 December 2010 - 9.9%) and 8.8% of the Group’s Core gross customer loans (31 March 2011 - 9.0%; 31 December 2010 - 8.9%). The H1 2011 impairment charge was £2,540 million (H1 2010 - £1,722 million) with commercial real estate and mortgage sectors accounting for £1,860 million (73%) and £311 million (12%) of the total H1 2011 impairment charge respectively. The remainder of the impairment charge is attributable to the other corporate and personal unsecured portfolios. Provision coverage of REIL increased from 43.8% at 31 December 2010 to 51.4% at H1 2011.

The impairment charge of £1,246 million for Q2 2011 was £48 million lower than Q1 2011. There was a decrease in the value of loans defaulting and a moderation of mortgage credit loss metrics in the quarter, however, these were offset by deteriorating collateral values in our commercial real estate portfolios. Overall high unemployment coupled with higher taxation and less liquidity in the economy, continues to depress housing market confidence and consumer spending, which resulted in the elevated impairment charge in the portfolios during the quarter.

Core
The H1 2011 impairment charge was £730 million (H1 2010 - £499 million) with the mortgage sector accounting for £311 million (43%) of the total. Impairment losses for Q2 2011 were £269 million (Q1 2011 - £461 million) reflecting the difficult economic environment in Ireland with elevated default levels across both mortgage and other corporate non-property portfolios. High unemployment, lower incomes and increased taxation together with pressure on borrowers with a dependence on consumer spending have resulted in higher corporate and mortgage loan losses.

Ulster Bank Group is assisting customers in this difficult environment. Forbearance policies which are deployed through the 'Flex' initiative are aimed at assisting customers in financial difficulty.

Non-Core
The H1 2011 impairment charge was £1,810 million (H1 2010 - £1,223 million) with the commercial real estate sector accounting for £1,697 million (94%) of the total. The impairment charge increased from £833 million for Q1 2011 to £977 million for Q2 2011, primarily reflecting the deterioration in security values in the development property portfolio, particularly those projects which have very low expectation of being completed in the medium-term.

 
162

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector

 
Gross 
 loans (1) 
REIL 
Provisions 
REIL 
as a % of 
gross 
 loans 
Provisions 
 as a % of 
 REIL 
Provisions 
 as a % of 
 gross loans 
 
H1 
Impairment 
charge 
H1 
Amounts 
 written-off 
30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Mortgages
21,778 
2,014 
769 
9.2 
38.2 
3.5 
311 
Personal unsecured
1,605 
201 
181 
12.5 
90.0 
11.3 
33 
15 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
4,338 
838 
331 
19.3 
39.5 
7.6 
115 
  - development
955 
241 
120 
25.2 
49.8 
12.6 
48 
Other corporate
8,699 
1,822 
1,000 
20.9 
54.9 
11.5 
223 
                 
 
37,375 
5,116 
2,401 
13.7 
46.9 
6.4 
730 
21 
                 
Non-Core
               
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
4,076 
2,662 
1,231 
65.3 
46.2 
30.2 
384 
  - development
9,002 
7,847 
4,367 
87.2 
55.7 
48.5 
1,313 
Other corporate
1,811 
1,226 
661 
67.7 
53.9 
36.5 
113 
                 
 
14,889 
11,735 
6,259 
78.8 
53.3 
42.0 
1,810 
                 
Ulster Bank Group
               
Mortgages
21,778 
2,014 
769 
9.2 
38.2 
3.5 
311 
Personal unsecured
1,605 
201 
181 
12.5 
90.0 
11.3 
33 
15 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
8,414 
3,500 
1,562 
41.6 
44.6 
18.6 
499 
  - development
9,957 
8,088 
4,487 
81.2 
55.5 
45.1 
1,361 
Other corporate
10,510 
3,048 
1,661 
29.0 
54.5 
15.8 
336 
                 
 
52,264 
16,851 
8,660 
32.2 
51.4 
16.6 
2,540 
23 
 
Note:
(1)
Funded loans.

 
163

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector (continued)

 
Gross 
 loans 
REIL 
Provisions 
REIL 
as a % of 
gross 
 loans 
Provisions 
 as a % of 
 REIL 
Provisions 
 as a % of 
 gross loans 
 
Q1 
Impairment 
charge 
Q1 
Amounts 
 written-off 
31 March 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Mortgages
21,495 
1,780 
676 
8.3 
38.0 
3.1 
233 
Personal unsecured
1,499 
193 
164 
12.9 
85.0 
10.9 
11 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
4,272 
773 
282 
18.1 
36.5 
6.6 
73 
  - development
1,015 
210 
99 
20.7 
47.1 
9.8 
24 
Other corporate
8,886 
1,682 
890 
18.9 
52.9 
10.0 
120 
                 
 
37,167 
4,638 
2,111 
12.5 
45.5 
5.7 
461 
11 
                 
Non-Core
               
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
3,947 
2,449 
1,060 
62.0 
43.3 
26.9 
223 
  - development
8,881 
7,588 
3,524 
85.4 
46.4 
39.7 
503 
Other corporate
1,995 
1,186 
658 
59.4 
55.5 
33.0 
107 
                 
 
14,823 
11,223 
5,242 
75.7 
46.7 
35.4 
833 
                 
Ulster Bank Group
               
Mortgages
21,495 
1,780 
676 
8.3 
38.0 
3.1 
233 
Personal unsecured
1,499 
193 
164 
12.9 
85.0 
10.9 
11 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
8,219 
3,222 
1,342 
39.2 
41.7 
16.3 
296 
  - development
9,896 
7,798 
3,623 
78.8 
46.5 
36.6 
527 
Other corporate
10,881 
2,868 
1,548 
26.4 
54.0 
14.2 
227 
                 
 
51,990 
15,861 
7,353 
30.5 
46.4 
14.1 
1,294 
11 
 
 
164

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector (continued)

 
Gross 
 loans 
REIL 
Provisions 
REIL 
as a % of 
gross 
 loans 
Provisions 
 as a % of 
 REIL 
Provisions 
 as a % of 
 gross loans 
Q4 
Impairment 
charge 
Q4 
Amounts 
 written-off 
31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Mortgages
21,162 
1,566 
439 
7.4 
28.0 
2.1 
159 
Personal unsecured
1,282 
185 
158 
14.4 
85.4 
12.3 
13 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
4,284 
598 
332 
14.0 
55.5 
7.7 
79 
  - development
1,090 
65 
37 
6.0 
56.9 
3.4 
(10)
Other corporate
9,039 
1,205 
667 
13.3 
55.4 
7.4 
135 
                 
 
36,857 
3,619 
 1,633 
9.8 
45.1 
4.4 
376 
10 
                 
Non-Core
               
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
3,854 
2,391 
1,000 
62.0 
41.8 
25.9 
206 
  - development
8,760 
6,341 
2,783 
72.4 
43.9 
31.8 
596 
Other corporate
1,970 
 1,310 
561 
66.5 
42.8 
28.5 
(19)
                 
 
14,584 
 10,042 
 4,344 
68.9 
43.3 
29.8 
783 
                 
Ulster Bank Group
               
Mortgages
21,162 
1,566 
439 
7.4 
28.0 
2.1 
159 
Personal unsecured
1,282 
185 
158 
14.4 
85.4 
12.3 
13 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
8,138 
2,989 
1,332 
36.7 
44.6 
16.4 
285 
  - development
9,850 
6,406 
2,820 
65.0 
44.0 
28.6 
586 
Other corporate
11,009 
2,515 
1,228 
22.8 
48.8 
11.2 
116 
                 
 
51,441 
13,661 
5,977 
26.6 
43.8 
11.6 
1,159 
10 

Key points
·
The increase in REIL in H1 2011 reflects continuing difficult conditions in both the commercial and residential sectors in the Republic of Ireland. Of the REIL at 30 June 2011, 70% was in Non-Core (31 December 2010 - 74%).
   
·
Sequential quarter comparison shows Core impairment of £269 million down from £461 million in Q1 2011, reflecting a lower impairment charge on the mortgage portfolio in Q2 2011. Non-Core impairments in Q2 2011 were £977 million compared with £833 million in Q1 2011 as collateral values in the development property portfolio deteriorated.
   
·
The majority of the Non-Core development lending book (87%) is REIL with a 56% provision coverage.
   
·
Mortgages show REIL as a % of gross lending of 9.2% at 30 June 2011 compared with 8.3% at 31 March 2011 and 7.4% at 31 December 2010.

 
165

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

Residential mortgages
The table below shows how the continued decrease in property values has affected the distribution of residential mortgages by loan-to-value (LTV) (indexed). LTV is based upon gross loan amounts and, whilst including defaulted loans, does not take account of provisions made.
 
 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
 2011 
31 December 
2010 
By average LTV (1)
       
<= 50%
35.1 
34.7 
35.9 
> 50% and <= 70%
13.0 
13.0 
13.5 
> 70% and <= 90%
13.0 
13.0 
13.5 
> 90%
38.9 
39.3 
37.1 
       
Total portfolio average LTV
74.5 
73.7 
71.2 
       
Average LTV on new originations during the period
65.0 
69.0 
75.9 

Note:
(1)
LTV averages calculated by transaction volume.

Key points
·
The residential mortgage portfolio across Ulster Bank Group totalled £21.8 billion at 30 June 2011 - with 90% in the Republic of Ireland and 10% in Northern Ireland. At constant exchange rates, the portfolio remained at similar levels to 31 December 2010 (£22.0 billion) with little growth due to very low new business volumes.
   
·
The 90 days arrears rate (by volume) increased due to the continued challenging economic environment. At 30 June 2011, the arrears rate was 7.4% (by volume) compared with 6.0% at 31 December 2010 and 6.6% at 31 March 2011. The impairment charge for Q2 2011 was £78 million compared with £233 million for Q1 2011. Repossession levels are higher than 2010 but remain modest with a total of 98 properties in H1 2011 repossessed (76 for full year 2010). 78% of repossessions during H1 2011 were through voluntary surrender or abandonment of the property.
   
·
Ulster Bank Group has a number of initiatives in place aimed at increasing the level of support to customers experiencing temporary financial difficulties.

 
166

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

Commercial real estate
The commercial real estate lending portfolio in Ulster Bank Group increased marginally during the quarter to £18.4 billion at 30 June 2011, primarily due to exchange rate movements. The Non-Core portion of the portfolio totalled £13.1 billion (71% of the portfolio). Of the total Ulster Bank Group commercial real estate portfolio 25% relates to Northern Ireland, 63% to the Republic of Ireland and 12% to the rest of the UK.

 
Development
 
Investment
   
 
Commercial 
Residential 
 
Commercial 
Residential 
 
Total 
Exposure by geography
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
               
30 June 2011
             
Ireland (ROI & NI)
2,762 
6,701 
 
5,378 
1,210 
 
16,051 
UK (excluding Northern Ireland)
104 
358 
 
1,702 
112 
 
2,276 
RoW
28 
 
 
44 
               
 
2,870 
7,087 
 
7,088 
1,326 
 
18,371 
               
31 March 2011
             
Ireland (ROI & NI)
2,848 
6,556 
 
5,090 
1,143 
 
15,637 
UK (excluding Northern Ireland)
112 
362 
 
1,835 
129 
 
2,438 
RoW
18 
 
22 
 
40 
               
 
2,960 
6,936 
 
6,947 
1,272 
 
18,115 
               
31 December 2010
             
Ireland (ROI & NI)
2,785 
6,578 
 
5,072 
1,098 
 
15,533 
UK (excluding Northern Ireland)
110 
359 
 
1,831 
115 
 
2,415 
RoW
18 
 
22 
 
40 
               
 
2,895 
6,955 
 
6,925 
1,213 
 
17,988 

Note:
(1)
The above table does not include rate risk management or contingent obligations.

Key point
·
Commercial real estate remains the primary driver of the increase in the defaulted loan book for Ulster Bank. The outlook remains challenging with limited liquidity in the marketplace to support re-financing. Ongoing reviews of the portfolio have led to a greater portion of the portfolio moving to specialised management in the Global Restructuring Group.
 
 
167

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk
Market risk arises from changes in interest rates, foreign currency, credit spreads, equity prices and risk related factors such as market volatilities. The Group manages market risk centrally within its trading and non-trading portfolios through a comprehensive market risk management framework. This framework includes limits based on, but not limited to, VaR, stress testing, position and sensitivity analyses.

VaR is a technique that produces estimates of the potential change in the market value of a portfolio over a specified time horizon at given confidence levels. For internal risk management purposes, the Group’s VaR assumes a time horizon of one trading day and a confidence level of 99%. The Group's VaR model is based on a historical simulation model, utilising data from the previous 500 days of time series results.

The VaR disclosure is broken down into trading and non-trading. Trading VaR relates to the main trading activities of the Group and non-trading reflects the VaR associated with reclassified assets, money market business and the management of internal funds flow within the Group’s businesses.

The Group’s VaR should be interpreted in light of the limitations of the methodology used, as follows:

·
Historical simulation VaR may not provide the best estimate of future market movements. It can only provide a prediction of the future based on events that occurred in the 500 trading day time series. Therefore, events more severe than those in the historical data series cannot be predicted.
   
·
The use of a 99% confidence level does not reflect the extent of potential losses beyond that percentile.
   
·
The use of a one day time horizon will not fully capture the profit and loss implications of positions that cannot be liquidated or hedged within one day.
   
·
The Group computes the VaR of trading portfolios at the close of business. Positions may change substantially during the course of the trading day and intra-day profits and losses will be incurred.

These limitations mean that the Group cannot guarantee that profits or losses will not exceed the VaR.

 
168

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk: GBM traded revenue



Note:
(1)
The effect of any month end adjustments, not attributable to a specific daily market move, is spread evenly over the days in the month in question.

Key points
·
The average daily revenue earned from GBM’s trading activities in H1 2011 was £28 million, compared with £33 million in H1 2010. The standard deviation of these daily revenues was £19 million compared with £23 million in H1 2010. The standard deviation measures the variation of daily revenues about the mean value of those revenues.
   
·
An analysis of the frequency distribution of daily revenue shows that there were four days with negative revenue during H1 2011 compared with seven days in H1 2010.
   
·
The most frequent result is a daily revenue of between £25 million and £30 million with 16 occurrences in H1 2011, compared with 14 occurrences in H1 2010.

 
169

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk (continued)

The table below details VaR for the Group’s trading portfolio, segregated by type of market risk exposure, and between Core and Non-Core, Counterparty Exposure Management (CEM) and Core excluding CEM.

 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Interest rate
39.4 
36.8 
75.7 
27.5 
 
60.4 
60.2 
79.2 
42.1 
Credit spread
73.2 
64.6 
95.0 
60.0 
 
134.1 
97.7 
151.1 
97.7 
Currency
9.4 
9.3 
14.2 
5.2 
 
12.2 
10.5 
18.0 
8.1 
Equity
10.4 
12.0 
17.3 
5.2 
 
11.1 
10.7 
14.5 
8.0 
Commodity
0.2 
0.3 
1.6 
 
0.2 
0.1 
0.7 
-  
Diversification
 
(61.0)
       
(71.1)
   
                   
Total
78.7 
62.0 
117.9 
60.8 
 
156.4 
108.1 
181.3 
108.1 
                   
Core
60.2 
42.5 
86.0 
42.5 
 
108.2 
72.2 
133.9 
72.2 
CEM
26.5 
23.2 
33.2 
21.9 
 
40.0 
34.7 
47.6 
34.5 
Core excluding CEM
57.1 
39.4 
78.4 
39.2 
 
88.0 
70.6 
106.2 
65.2 
                   
Non-Core
69.3 
51.4 
110.1 
47.5 
 
113.9 
109.4 
128.6 
104.1 

Key points

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
The Group’s trading VaR reduced over the course of the second quarter as the exceptional volatility experienced during the financial crisis continued to drop out of the 500 days of time series data used in the VaR calculation.
   
·
The Core trading VaR and credit spread VaR decreased significantly at 31 March 2011 as GBM managed down its risk position given a volatile and risk averse environment and the adoption of more appropriate daily time series for sub-prime/subordinated RMBS. This decreased further in Q2 2011 as more inventory reductions were made and the reduced volatility in the time series continued to contribute to a lower VaR calculation.
   
·
The maximum interest rate VaR in Q2 2011 was driven by a higher exposure level ahead of the European Central Bank (ECB) meeting. Following the ECB meeting, positions were then reduced as the markets had fully factored in subsequent rate hikes, causing the interest rate VaR to reduce significantly. The VaR then remained at the lower level for the rest of the quarter.
   
·
The Non-Core trading VaR decreased significantly at the beginning of May 2011, as a result of continued de-risking of the Non-Core Markets portfolio in line with the overall strategy along with a period of high volatility dropping out of the VaR calculation.

 
170

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Market risk (continued)

 
Half year ended
 
30 June 2011
 
30 June 2010
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Interest rate
49.8 
36.8 
79.2 
27.5 
 
45.8 
42.8 
64.2 
32.5 
Credit spread
103.4 
64.6 
151.1 
60.0 
 
158.2 
203.0 
203.2 
113.0 
Currency
10.8 
9.3 
18.0 
5.2 
 
20.6 
21.4 
28.0 
13.9 
Equity
10.8 
12.0 
17.3 
5.2 
 
10.4 
6.7 
17.3 
6.6 
Commodity
0.2 
0.3 
1.6 
 
10.7 
8.1 
15.8 
6.7 
Diversification
 
(61.0)
       
(71.5)
   
                   
Total
117.3 
62.0 
181.3 
60.8 
 
152.9 
210.5 
210.5 
103.0 
                   
Core
84.0 
42.5 
133.9 
42.5 
 
95.5 
118.1 
145.4 
58.9 
CEM
33.2 
23.2 
47.6 
21.9 
 
45.1 
75.5 
76.5 
30.3 
Core excluding CEM
72.5 
39.4 
106.2 
39.2 
 
82.8 
78.6 
108.7 
53.6 
                   
Non-Core
91.4 
51.4 
128.6 
47.5 
 
90.4 
104.9 
108.1 
63.2 

Key point

H1 2011 compared with H1 2010
·
The Group’s trading VaR was significantly lower at 30 June 2011, compared with 30 June 2010. Both Core and Non-Core portfolios exhibited significantly reduced trading VaR in total and across asset class VaR components as the exceptional volatility of the market data from the period of the financial crisis dropped out of the time series data used in the VaR calculation and both portfolios engaged in active de-risking.
   
·
The commodity VaR was materially lower in H1 2011 compared with H1 2010 as the sale of the Group’s interest in Sempra was completed at the end of 2010.

 
171

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk (continued)

The table below details VaR for the Group’s non-trading portfolio, excluding the SCP and loans and receivables (LAR), segregated by type of market risk exposure and between Core and Non-Core.

 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2011
 
31 March 2011
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Non-trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Interest rate
8.3 
8.3 
9.2 
5.7 
 
7.8 
7.0 
10.8 
6.5 
Credit spread
19.1 
18.0 
24.2 
16.1 
 
23.8 
22.5 
39.3 
14.2 
Currency
1.7 
3.3 
3.3 
0.2 
 
0.6 
0.6 
1.8 
0.1 
Equity
2.2 
2.0 
2.4 
2.0 
 
2.5 
2.3 
3.1 
2.2 
Diversification
 
(13.1)
       
(5.4)
   
                   
Total
18.7 
18.5 
22.5 
16.7 
 
26.5 
27.0 
41.6 
13.4 
                   
Core
18.5 
19.4 
24.6 
15.7 
 
25.5 
26.1 
38.9 
13.5 
Non-Core
3.7 
4.3 
4.3 
2.8 
 
2.6 
2.4 
3.4 
2.2 

Key points

Q2 2011 compared with Q1 2011
·
The Core non-trading VaR reduced over the course of the second quarter, primarily due to reduced volatility in the market data used in the VaR calculation.
   
·
The maximum non-trading credit spread VaR in Q2 2011 was significantly lower than in Q1 2011. The Q1 2011 maximum VaR was high due to a change in the time series used for the Dutch RMBS portfolio in RBS N.V. where more relevant and granular market data had become available and provided a better reflection of the risk in the portfolio. The Q2 2011 credit spread VaR decreased through the period as the volatile market data continued to drop out of the 500 day time series used in the VaR calculation.


 
Half year ended
 
30 June 2011
 
30 June 2010 (1)
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Non-trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Interest rate
8.0 
8.3 
10.8 
5.7 
 
8.8 
7.3 
13.3 
5.5 
Credit spread
21.4 
18.0 
39.3 
14.2 
 
44.6 
23.0 
101.2 
23.0 
Currency
1.1 
3.3 
3.3 
0.1 
 
1.7 
3.4 
7.6 
0.3 
Equity
2.3 
2.0 
3.1 
2.0 
 
0.8 
0.3 
3.5 
0.2 
Diversification
 
(13.1)
       
(6.3)
   
                   
Total
22.6 
18.5 
41.6 
13.4 
 
42.0 
27.7 
98.0 
25.0 
                   
Core
22.0 
19.4 
38.9 
13.5 
 
41.6 
27.4 
98.1 
25.0 
Non-Core
3.2 
4.3 
4.3 
2.2 
 
0.9 
1.2 
3.6 
0.3 

Note:
(1)
Revised to exclude LAR portfolios.

 
172

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Market risk (continued)

Key points
·
As for traded VaR, the Group’s non-trading VaR was significantly lower at the end of H1 2011, when compared with the period end H1 2010, as the exceptional volatility of the market data from the period of the financial crises continued to drop out of the 500 days of time series data used in the VaR calculation.
   
·
The maximum credit spread VaR was significantly higher in the half year ended in 2010 than in  the half year ended 2011. This was primarily due to the increased market volatility experienced since the credit crisis being fully incorporated into the two year time series used by the VaR model.  This volatility was particularly pronounced in respect of credit spreads and had a marked impact on credit spread VaR.
   
·
A methodology enhancement to the ABS VaR was approved and incorporated into the regulatory model in mid-January 2010 which significantly reduced the credit spread VaR and the total and Core VaR. The enhancement better reflected the risk in the context of position changes, downgrades and vintage as well as improving differentiation between prime, Alt-A and sub-prime exposures.

 
173

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Market risk (continued)

Structured Credit Portfolio (SCP)

 
Drawn notional
 
Fair value
 
CDOs 
CLOs 
MBS (1)
Other 
 ABS 
Total 
 
CDOs 
CLOs 
MBS (1)
Other 
 ABS 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
30 June 2011
                     
1-2 years
45 
46 
91 
 
44 
41 
85 
2-3 years
11 
183 
194 
 
10 
170 
180 
3-4 years
11 
48 
64 
 
10 
46 
61 
4-5 years
15 
56 
71 
 
14 
53 
67 
5-10 years
95 
396 
315 
365 
1,171 
 
84 
370 
245 
322 
1,021 
>10 years
390 
498 
551 
526 
1,965 
 
167 
420 
391 
388 
1,366 
                       
 
501 
909 
922 
1,224 
3,556 
 
266 
804 
690 
1,020 
2,780 
                       
31 March 2011
                     
1-2 years
19 
38 
57 
 
18 
34 
52 
2-3 years
12 
19 
43 
70 
144 
 
12 
17 
42 
64 
135 
3-4 years
11 
206 
222 
 
10 
194 
209 
4-5 years
15 
15 
36 
66 
 
15 
14 
33 
62 
5-10 years
96 
467 
313 
385 
1,261 
 
85 
435 
232 
342 
1,094 
>10 years
397 
624 
561 
530 
2,112 
 
154 
500 
400 
369 
1,423 
                       
 
520 
1,149 
928 
1,265 
3,862 
 
266 
989 
684 
1,036 
2,975 
                       
31 December 2010
                     
1-2 years
47 
47 
 
42 
42 
2-3 years
85 
19 
44 
98 
246 
 
81 
18 
37 
91 
227 
3-4 years
41 
20 
205 
266 
 
-  
37 
19 
191 
247 
4-5 years
16 
16 
 
15 
15 
5-10 years
98 
466 
311 
437 
1,312 
 
87 
422 
220 
384 
1,113 
>10 years
412 
663 
584 
550 
2,209 
 
161 
515 
397 
367 
1,440 
                       
 
611 
1,189 
959 
1,337 
4,096 
 
344 
992 
673 
1,075 
3,084 

Note:
(1)
MBS include sub-prime RMBS with a notional amount of £451 million (31 March 2011 - £455 million; 31 December 2010 - £471 million) and a fair value of £325 million (31 March 2011 - £330 million; 31 December 2010 - £329 million), all with residual maturities of greater than 10 years.

The SCP non-trading risk in Non-Core is not measured using VaR as the Group believes this is not an appropriate tool for this portfolio of illiquid debt securities. The reduction in CLO drawn notional and fair value in Q2 2011 was due to positions paying down.

 
174

 

Risk factors


The principal risks and uncertainties facing the Group are unchanged from those disclosed on pages 352 to 369 of the 2010 Form 20-F, however the operational, legal and regulatory landscape in which the Group operates has continued to evolve since the 2010 Form 20-F was approved. In particular, set out in further detail below in the Summary of our Principal Risks and Uncertainties, the Group has identified two additional risks which were not included in the 2010 Form 20-F, namely those arising from the Independent Commission on Banking review and the transfer of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS plc.

Summary of our Principal Risks and Uncertainties
Set out below is a summary of certain risks which could adversely affect the Group. These should not be regarded as a complete and comprehensive statement of all potential risks and uncertainties. A fuller description of these and other risk factors is included in the 2010 Form 20-F.

·  
RBS or any of its UK bank subsidiaries may face the risk of full nationalisation or other resolution procedures and various actions could be taken by or on behalf of the UK Government, including actions in relation to any securities issued, new or existing contractual arrangements and transfers of part or all of RBS’s businesses.

·  
The Group’s ability to implement its strategic plan depends on the success of its efforts to refocus on its core strengths and its balance sheet reduction programme. As part of the Group’s strategic plan and implementation of the State Aid restructuring plan agreed with the EC and HM Treasury, the Group is undertaking an extensive restructuring which may adversely affect the Group’s business, results of operations and financial condition and give rise to increased operational risk and may impair the Group’s ability to raise new Tier 1 capital due to restrictions on its ability to make discretionary dividend or coupon payments on certain securities.

·  
The Group’s businesses, earnings and financial condition have been and will continue to be affected by geopolitical conditions, the global economy, the instability in the global financial markets and increased competition. These have resulted in significant changes in market conditions including interest rates, foreign exchange rates, credit spreads, and other market factors and consequent changes in asset valuations.

·  
The Group requires access to sources of liquidity, which have been constrained in recent years, and a failure to access liquidity due to market conditions or otherwise could adversely affect the Group’s financial condition. In addition, the Group’s borrowing costs and its access to the debt capital markets and other sources of liquidity depend significantly on its and the UK Government’s credit ratings.

·  
The actual or perceived failure or worsening credit of the Group’s counterparties or borrowers and depressed asset valuations resulting from poor market conditions have adversely affected and could continue to adversely affect the Group.

·  
The value of certain financial instruments recorded at fair value is determined using financial models incorporating assumptions, judgements and estimates that may change over time or may ultimately not turn out to be accurate.

 
175

 
 
Risk factors (continued)


·  
The Group’s insurance businesses are subject to inherent risks involving claims on insured events.

·  
The Group’s business performance, financial condition and capital and liquidity ratios could be adversely affected if its capital is not managed effectively or as a result of changes to capital adequacy and liquidity requirements, including those arising out of Basel III implementation (globally or by UK authorities), or if the Group is unable to issue Contingent B Shares to HM Treasury under certain circumstances.

·  
The Group could fail to attract or retain senior management, which may include members of the Board, or other key employees, and it may suffer if it does not maintain good employee relations.

·  
Any significant developments in regulatory or tax legislation could have an effect on how the Group conducts its business and on its results of operations and financial condition, and the recoverability of certain deferred tax assets recognised by the Group is subject to uncertainty.

·  
The Group is subject to substantial regulation and oversight, and any significant regulatory or legal developments could have an adverse effect on how the Group conducts its business and on its results of operations and financial condition.  In addition, the Group is and may be subject to litigation and regulatory investigations that may impact its business, results of operations and financial condition.

·  
Operational and reputational risks are inherent in the Group’s operations.

·  
The Group may be required to make contributions to its pension schemes and government compensation schemes, either of which may have an adverse impact on the Group’s results of operations, cash flow and financial condition.

·  
As a result of the UK Government’s majority shareholding in the Group it can, and in the future may decide to, exercise a significant degree of influence over the Group including suspending dividends and certain coupon payments, modifying or cancelling contracts or limiting the Group’s operations. The offer or sale by the UK Government of all or a portion of its shareholding in the company could affect the market price of the equity shares and other securities and acquisitions of ordinary shares by the UK Government (including through conversions of other securities or further purchases of shares) may result in the delisting of the Group from the Official List.

·  
The Group’s participation in the APS is costly and complex and may not produce the benefits expected and the occurrence of associated risks may have a material adverse impact on the Group’s business, capital or tax position, financial condition and results of operations. Any changes to the regulatory treatment of the APS may negatively impact the Group’s capital position and any withdrawal from, or termination of, the APS will be costly.

 
176

 
 
Risk factors (continued)


In addition, the risk faced by the Group as a result of the actual or perceived failure or worsening credit of the Group’s counterparties has been exacerbated by an increase in the perceived risk of sovereign default relating to certain EU member states. This has also had a negative impact on capital and credit markets. In particular, the Group has significant exposure to customers and counterparties within the European Union (including the United Kingdom and Ireland), which includes sovereign debt exposures that have been, and may in the future be, affected by restructuring of their terms, principal, interest and maturity. These exposures have resulted in the Group making significant provisions and recognising significant write-downs in prior periods, which may also occur in future periods.

The Group is also subject to the following additional risk factors which were not included in the 2010 Form 20-F:

The Independent Commission on Banking is reviewing competition in the UK banking industry and possible structural reforms. The outcomes of this review could have a material adverse effect on the interests of the Group.
The UK Government has appointed an Independent Commission on Banking (the “ICB”) to review possible structural measures to reform the banking system in order to promote, amongst other things, stability and competition. The ICB has confirmed it will publish its final report on 12 September 2011. The interim report published on 11 April 2011 (the “Interim Report”) set out the ICB’s provisional views on possible reforms to improve stability and competition in UK banking and sought responses to those views. Reform options for stability include additional capital and the ring-fencing of retail banking operations (on a basis yet to be defined). Reform options for competition include structural measures to improve competition, improved means of switching and transparency and a primary duty for the Financial Conduct Authority to promote effective competition. The Interim Report also supported the introduction of rules as to contingent capital, bail-in debt and depositor preferences. The Treasury Select Committee (the “TSC”) has also recently conducted an examination into competition and choice in the retail banking sector and issued a report on 2 April 2011. According to the UK Government’s response to the TSC’s report, published on 12 July 2011, the majority of the issues raised by the TSC will be addressed in the ICB’s final report. The Group will continue to participate in the debate and to consult with the ICB during the coming weeks and with the UK Government thereafter. However, there can be no assurance that the final report will not recommend that additional obligations be imposed upon the Group. The implementation of the recommendations set out in the Interim Report and any further obligations to be imposed upon the Group could negatively affect the Group’s structure, results of operations, financial condition and prospects.

The occurrence of a delay in the implementation of (or any failure to implement) the approved proposed transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS plc may have an adverse effect on the Group
As part of the restructuring of its businesses, operations and assets, on 19 April 2011, the boards of RBSG, RBS plc, RBS Holdings N.V. and The Royal Bank of Scotland N.V. (RBS N.V.) approved the proposed transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS plc (the “Proposed Transfers”), subject, among other matters, to regulatory and other approvals, further tax and other analysis in respect of the assets and liabilities to be transferred and employee consultation procedures. It is expected that the Proposed Transfers will be implemented on a phased basis over a period ending on 31 December 2013. A large part of the Proposed Transfers is expected to have taken place by the end of 2012.

 
177

 
 
Risk factors (continued)


The process for implementing the Proposed Transfers is complex and any failure to satisfy any conditions or complete any preliminary steps to each Proposed Transfer may cause a delay in its completion (or result in its non-completion). If any of the Proposed Transfers are delayed (or are not completed) for any reason, such as a failure to secure required regulatory approvals, it is possible that the relevant regulatory authorities could impose sanctions which could adversely impact the minimum regulatory requirements for capital and liquidity of RBS N.V. and RBS plc. In addition, the FSA may impose additional requirements in relation to RBS plc to the extent that such a delay in implementation (or non-completion) of any of the Proposed Transfers has consequential financial implications for RBS plc (for example increased intra-group large exposures). A delay in implementation of (or any failure to implement) any of the Proposed Transfers may therefore adversely impact RBS N.V.’s and RBS plc’s capital and liquidity resources and requirements, with consequential adverse impacts on their funding resources and requirements.

The occurrence of a delay in the implementation of (or any failure to implement) any of the Proposed Transfers may therefore have a material adverse effect on the Group's business, results of operations, financial condition, and could result in a loss of value in any securities issued by the company.

 
178

 

Additional information

 
Selected financial data

The dollar financial information included below has been translated for convenience at a rate of £1.00 to US$1.6067, being the Noon Buying Rate on 30 June 2011.

Summary consolidated income statement

 
30 June 
30 June 
 
30 June 
 
2011 
2011 
 
2010 
 
$m 
£m 
 
£m 
         
Net interest income
10,489 
6,528 
 
7,218 
Non-interest income
14,088 
8,768 
 
10,742 
         
Total income
24,577 
15,296 
 
17,960 
Operating expenses
(14,994)
(9,332)
 
(9,170)
         
Profit before other operating charges and impairment losses
9,583 
5,964 
 
8,790 
Insurance net claims
(2,739)
(1,705)
 
(2,459)
Impairment losses
(8,119)
(5,053)
 
(5,162)
         
Operating (loss)/profit before tax
(1,275)
(794)
 
1,169 
Tax (charge)/credit
(1,037)
(645)
 
(932)
         
(Loss)/profit from continuing operations
(2,312)
(1,439)
 
237 
Profit from discontinued operations, net of tax
50 
31 
 
(706)
         
(Loss)/profit for the period
(2,262)
(1,408)
 
(469)
         
(Loss)/profit attributable to:
       
Non-controlling interests
27 
17 
 
(602)
Preference dividends
 
124 
Ordinary shareholders
(2,289)
(1,425)
 
         

Summary consolidated balance sheet

 
 
30 June 
2011 
30 June 
2011 
 
31 December 
2010 
 
$m 
£m 
 
£m 
         
Loans and advances
1,029,638 
640,840 
 
655,778 
Debt securities and equity shares
431,553 
268,596 
 
239,678 
Derivatives and settlement balances
673,911 
419,438 
 
438,682 
Other assets
188,136 
117,095 
 
119,438 
         
Total assets
2,323,238 
1,445,969 
 
1,453,576 
         
Owners’ equity
120,091 
74,744 
 
75,132 
Non-controlling interests
2,407 
1,498 
 
1,719 
Subordinated liabilities
42,274 
26,311 
 
27,053 
Deposits
1,003,350 
624,479 
 
609,483 
Derivatives, settlement balances and short positions
750,040 
466,820 
 
478,076 
Other liabilities
405,076 
252,117 
 
262,113 
         
Total liabilities and equity
2,323,238 
1,445,969 
 
1,453,576 

 
179

 

Additional information


 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
       
Ordinary share price
£0.385 
£0.408 
£0.391 
       
Number of ordinary shares in issue
59,226m 
58,579m 
58,458m 
       
Market capitalisation (including B shares)
£42.4bn 
£44.7bn 
£42.8bn 

Capitalisation of the Group
The following table shows the Group’s issued and fully paid share capital, owners’ equity and indebtedness on an unaudited consolidated basis in accordance with IFRS as at 30 June 2011.
 
 
As at 
30 June 
 2011 
 
£m 
   
Share capital - allotted, called up and fully paid
 
Ordinary shares of 25p
14,806 
B shares of £0.01
510 
Dividend access share of £0.01
Non-cumulative preference shares of US$0.01
Non-cumulative preference shares of €0.01
Non-cumulative preference shares of £1.00
   
 
15,317 
Retained income and other reserves
59,427 
   
Owners’ equity
74,744 
   
Group indebtedness
 
Subordinated liabilities
26,311 
Debt securities in issue
213,797 
   
Total indebtedness
240,108 
   
Total capitalisation and indebtedness
314,852 

Under IFRS, certain preference shares are classified as debt and are included in subordinated liabilities in the table above.
 
Since 30 June 2011, issuances of debt securities totalled £2.1 billion (gross). Issuances net of buybacks and maturities totalled £0.2 billion.
 
Other than as disclosed above, the information contained in the tables above has not changed materially since 30 June, 2011.
 
 
180

 

Additional information (continued)


Ratio of earnings to fixed charges
 
Quarter ended 
30 June 
 2011(3,4) 
Year ended 31 December
2010 
2009(4)
2008(4)
2007 
2006 
             
Ratio of earnings to combined fixed charges
  and preference share dividends (1,2)
           
  - including interest on deposits
0.70 
0.94 
0.75 
­0.05 
1.45 
1.62 
  - excluding interest on deposits
 
0.38 
­
­
5.73 
6.12 
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges only (1,2)
           
  - including interest on deposits
0.70 
0.95 
0.80 
­0.05 
1.47 
1.64 
  - excluding interest on deposits
 
0.44 
­
­
6.53 
6.87 
 
Notes:
(1)
For this purpose, earnings consist of income before tax and minority interests, plus fixed charges less the unremitted income of associated undertakings (share of profits less dividends received). Fixed charges consist of total interest expense, including or excluding interest on deposits and debt securities in issue, as appropriate, and the proportion of rental expense deemed representative of the interest factor (one third of total rental expenses).
(2)
The earnings for the quarter ended 30 June 2011 and for the years ended 31 December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, were inadequate to cover total fixed charges and preference share dividends. The coverage deficiency for total fixed charges and preference share dividends for the quarter ended 30 June 2011 was £678 million and for the years ended 31 December, 2010, 2009 and 2008 they were £523 million, £3,582 million and £26,287 million, respectively. The coverage deficiency for fixed charges only for the quarter ended 30 June 2011 was £678 million and for the years ended 31 December, 2010, 2009 and 2008 they were £399 million, £2,647 million and £25,691 million, respectively.
(3)
Based on unaudited numbers.
(4)
Negative ratios have been excluded.

 
181

 

SIGNATURE

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorised.



 
The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc
(Registrant)
 







 
/s/ Rajan Kapoor
Rajan Kapoor
Group Chief Accountant
30 August 2011
 
 
 
 
 

 






 
Appendix 1

Businesses outlined for
disposal
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

 

Appendix 1 Businesses outlined for disposal


To comply with EC State Aid requirements the Group agreed to make a series of divestments by the end of 2013: the disposal of RBS Insurance, Global Merchant Services and its interest in RBS Sempra Commodities JV. The Group also agreed to dispose of its RBS England and Wales and NatWest Scotland branch-based businesses, along with certain SME and corporate activities across the UK (‘UK branch-based businesses’). The disposals of Global Merchant Services and RBS Sempra Commodities JV businesses have now effectively been completed.

The sale of the Group's UK branch-based businesses to Santander UK plc continues to make good progress. Due to the complex nature of the process required to separate the divesting branches and associated assets, and the desire to minimise customer disruption, the transaction is now expected to complete in the second half of 2012, subject to regulatory approvals and other conditions.

Preparations for the disposal of RBS Insurance, by way of public flotation or a trade sale, targeted for the second half of 2012 continue. External advisors were appointed during Q4 2010 and the process of separation is proceeding on plan. In the meantime, the business continues to be managed and reported as a separate core division.

The table below shows Total income and Operating profit of RBS Insurance, and the UK branch-based businesses.

 
Total income
 
Operating profit/(loss)
before impairments
 
Operating profit/(loss)
 
H1 2011 
FY 2010 
 
H1 2011 
FY 2010 
 
H1 2011 
FY 2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                 
RBS Insurance (1)
2,116 
4,369 
 
206 
(295)
 
206 
(295)
UK branch-based businesses (2)
472 
902 
 
248 
439 
 
185 
160 
                 
Total
2,588 
5,271 
 
454 
144 
 
391 
(135)

The table below shows the estimated risk-weighted assets, total assets and capital of the businesses identified for disposal.

 
RWAs
 
Total assets
 
Capital
 
30 June 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
30 June 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
                 
RBS Insurance (1)
n/m 
n/m 
 
12.7 
12.4 
 
4.2 
4.0 
UK branch-based businesses (2)
11.5 
13.2 
 
19.6 
19.9 
 
1.0 
1.2 
                 
Total
11.5 
13.2 
 
32.3 
32.3 
 
5.2 
5.2 

Notes:
(1)
As reported in the Form 6-K for the half year ended 30 June 2011 and Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2010 and excluding non-core business. Estimated capital includes approximately £1.0 billion of goodwill.
(2)
Estimated notional equity based on 9% of RWAs.

 
1

 
 
Appendix 1 Businesses outlined for disposal (continued)

 
Further information on the UK branch-based businesses by division is shown in the tables below:

 
Division
 
Total
 
UK 
Retail 
UK 
Corporate 
 
H1 2011 
FY 2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
           
Income statement
         
Net interest income
146 
200 
 
346 
656 
Non-interest income
50 
76 
 
126 
246 
           
Total income
196 
276 
 
472 
902 
           
Direct expenses
         
  - staff
(39)
(43)
 
(82)
(176)
  - other
(47)
(35)
 
(82)
(144)
Indirect expenses
(37)
(23)
 
(60)
(143)
           
 
(123)
(101)
 
(224)
(463)
           
Operating profit before impairment losses
73 
175 
 
248 
439 
Impairment losses (1)
(39)
(24)
 
(63)
(279)
           
Operating profit
34 
151 
 
185 
160 
           
Analysis of income by product
         
Loans and advances
69 
174 
 
243 
445 
Deposits
53 
77 
 
130 
261 
Mortgages
65 
 
65 
120 
Other
25 
 
34 
76 
           
Total income
196 
276 
 
472 
902 
           
Net interest margin
4.61% 
3.07% 
 
3.57% 
3.24% 
Employee numbers (full time equivalents rounded to the
  nearest hundred)
3,000 
1,600 
 
4,600 
4,400 

Note:
(1)
Q1 2011 impairment losses benefitted from £54 million of latent and other provision releases.

 
Division
 
Total
 
UK 
Retail 
UK 
Corporate 
Global 
Banking 
& Markets 
 
30 June 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
6.6 
13.0 
 
19.6 
19.9 
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
6.9 
13.4 
 
20.3 
20.7 
Customer deposits
8.8 
14.9 
 
23.7 
24.0 
Derivative assets
0.4 
 
0.4 
n/a 
Derivative liabilities
0.1 
 
0.1 
n/a 
Risk elements in lending
0.5 
1.1 
 
1.6 
1.7 
Loan:deposit ratio
79% 
90% 
 
86% 
86% 
Risk-weighted assets
3.3 
8.2 
 
11.5 
13.2 

 
2

 
 










Appendix 2
 
Additional risk management
disclosures

 
 
 

 
 
 
 

Contents
   
 
Page 
   
Country risk
 
  - background
  - key points
  - summary
  - lending
  - held-for-trading debt securities (net)
  - held-for-trading debt securities - long positions
  - held-for-trading debt securities - short positions
  - available-for-sale and loans and receivables debt securities
  - available-for-sale reserves relating to debt securities (gross and net of tax)
  - derivatives and reverse repos
10 
  - contingent liabilities and commitments
10 
   
Loans, REIL and impairments
 
  - by industry and geography
11 
  - by division
17 
   
ABS by geography and measurement classification
18 
 
 
1

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Country risk

Background
In this Appendix, further details are provided of the Group’s exposure to five eurozone countries, namely Greece, Ireland, Portugal, Spain and Italy, as these countries have been the focus of investor concern.

During these times of increased stress, the Group is working proactively with its clients in these five eurozone countries in order to manage both relationships and exposure. Additionally, the Group is managing its sovereign exposures closely.

As a result of the deterioration in Greece’s fiscal position and the announcement of the proposals to restructure Greek sovereign debt, the Group has recognised an impairment in respect of Greek government bonds. Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain are facing less acute fiscal difficulties and the Group’s sovereign exposures to these countries were not considered impaired at 30 June 2011.

Key points
 
Republic of Ireland: Major local operation, largely through Ulster Bank (split roughly equally between corporate and retail exposure). Some additional exposure through GBM (mostly derivatives and debt securities).
   
Central and local government: Modest exposure, including £93 million of AFS debt securities (AFS reserves £57 million) and HFT long and short positions of £84 million and £40 million respectively.
   
Other banks and financial institutions: Exposure including derivatives and reverse repos of £1.6 billion, most of which is collateralised, HFT long position of £387 million and short positions of £42 million, AFS securities of £304 million (AFS reserves £45 million), and lending of £459 million.
   
Corporate: Exposure largely consisting of lending which is concentrated in commercial real estate, with a majority of the exposures in Non-Core. Outside of this, corporate exposures are diversified across a range of customers, including subsidiaries of foreign-owned corporations and government-owned utilities and across a wide range of sectors, including manufacturing and services.
   
Personal: Lending of £20.8 billion, predominantly consisting of residential mortgages.
   
Contingent liabilities and commitments: Amounted to £3.7 billion, of which £2.2 billion corporate customers.
 
 
2

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Country risk (continued)

Key points (continued)

Spain: Primarily lending to major investment grade corporations. AFS debt securities of covered bonds.
Central and local government: Net HFT short positions of £997 million, consisting of long positions of £1.1 billion and short positions of £2.1 billion. Modest AFS position of £91 million (AFS reserves £49 million).
   
Other banks and financial institutions: AFS covered bonds of £6.7 billion (AFS reserves £1,191 million), issued by Spanish banks and financial institutions. Collateralised derivatives and reverse repos of £1.6 billion.  Lending exposure to banks up by £939 million in H1 2011 to £1.2 billion, reflecting seasonal increases in loans, settlement balances and money market positions to banks within existing credit lines.
   
Corporate: Lending essentially unchanged at £6.8 billion. Core exposure is to large international corporations and local corporations with strong business profiles, generally infrastructure, utilities and TMT companies. Diversified product mix.
   
Personal: Lending relatively stable at £405 million.
   
Contingent liabilities and commitments: Amounted to £2.6 billion, of which £2.2 billion corporate customers.
   
Italy: GBM hub country with relationships with large companies, banks and financial institutions and primary dealing activity.
Central and local government: HFT long position of £7.0 billion against a short position of £5.2 billion. AFS securities of £955 million (AFS reserves £90 million). Lending, derivatives and contingent exposures all minimal.
   
Other banks and financial institutions: Exposure comprised of derivatives and reverse repos of £1.7 billion, largely collateralised, along with lending of £1.1 billion.
   
Corporate: Lending largely unchanged at £2.3 billion. Portfolio currently weighted towards corporations with a large geographic footprint or substantial local operations. Diversified product mix.
   
Personal: Minor exposure, largely comprised of lending of £26 million.
   
Contingent liabilities and commitments: Amounted to £3.5 billion, of which £2.4 billion corporate customers.
   
Greece: Primarily legacy government bond positions.
Central and local government: AFS debt securities of £733 million after impairment of £733 million. HFT long and short positions of £276 million and £28 million respectively.
   
Other banks and financial institutions: Exposure to leading Greek banks, consisting of derivatives, generally cash collateralised, and reverse repos, totalling £188 million.
   
Corporate: Lending, including short and long-term committed facilities, amounting to £421 million. Focus on investment-grade borrowers, across a range of sectors, including industrial, energy and utilities.
   
Personal: Limited exposure - lending of £15 million.
   
Contingent liabilities and commitments: Amounted to £165 million, of which £154 million corporate customers.
 
 
3

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Country risk (continued)

Key points (continued)

Portugal: Modest exposure overall.
   
Central and local government: HFT long and short positions of £76 million and £109 million respectively. AFS bonds of £71 million (AFS reserves of £48 million).
   
Other banks and financial institutions: Exposure principally to the four largest local institutions, comprising sovereign CDS. Lending totalled £48 million.
   
Corporate: Lending of £585 million.
   
Personal: Negligible exposure.
   
Contingent liabilities and commitments: Amounted to £362 million, of which £353 million corporate customers.
 
CDS referencing sovereign exposures
   
CDS positions are managed by the Credit Flow desk in GBM, who acts as a market maker for CDS across a wide range of names from sovereigns to corporate, as well as indices. RBS’s net mark-to-market exposure to CDSs referencing peripheral eurozone sovereigns is small. In addition trades are collateralised with appropriate levels of variation margin applied on a daily basis. It is anticipated that sovereign CDS trades will become available for clearing on the   Intercontinental Exchange in coming months.
 
 
4

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures

Country risk:  Summary

 
30 June 2011
     
of which: central and local government
 
Republic 
of Ireland 
(ROI)
Spain 
Italy 
Greece 
Portugal 
Total 
 
Republic 
of Ireland 
(ROI)
Spain 
Italy 
Greece 
Portugal 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                           
Lending
43,511 
8,477 
3,552 
491 
683 
56,714 
 
53 
20 
10 
45 
135 
HFT debt securities (net)
465 
(839)
2,046 
250 
1,927 
 
44 
(997)
1,833 
248 
(33)
1,095 
AFS and LAR debt
  securities
531 
7,227 
1,817 
733 
223 
10,531 
 
93 
91 
955 
733 
71 
1,943 
Derivatives and  reverse
  repos
2,267 
2,004 
2,222 
212 
355 
7,060 
 
10 
25 
60 
21 
118 
                           
Total - debt and
  derivatives
46,774 
16,869 
9,637 
1,686 
1,266 
76,232 
 
200 
(861)
2,855 
993 
104 
3,291 
                           
Contingent liabilities
  and commitments
3,681 
2,606 
3,493 
165 
362 
10,307 
 
31 
40 
                           
CDS asset
             
530 
488 
558 
1,452 
833 
3,861 
CDS liability
             
539 
482 
511 
1,392 
839 
3,763 
                           
Lending maturity
                         
  - ≤ 1 year
             
20 
45 
65 
  - 1-5 years
             
22 
10 
39 
  - > 5 years
             
31 
31 
                           
AFS debt security
  maturity
                         
  - ≤ 1 year
             
50 
54 
  - 1-5 years
             
41 
51 
25 
117 
  - > 5 years
             
89 
904 
708 
71 
1,772 
 
 
5

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures

Country risk:  Summary (continued)

 
31 December 2010
     
of which: central and local government
 
ROI 
Spain 
Italy 
Greece 
Portugal 
Total 
 
ROI 
Spain 
Italy 
Greece 
Portugal 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                           
Lending
43,189 
7,651 
3,719 
303 
766 
55,628 
 
61 
19 
45 
14 
86 
225 
HFT debt securities (net)
411 
46 
2,082 
81 
2,620 
 
(67)
1,946 
81 
(51)
1,917 
AFS and LAR debt
  securities
921 
7,085 
1,769 
895 
245 
10,915 
 
104 
88 
906 
895 
92 
2,085 
Derivatives and  reverse
  repos
2,940 
2,047 
2,030 
203 
393 
7,613 
 
20 
53 
71 
29 
180 
                           
Total - debt and
  derivatives
47,461 
16,829 
9,600 
1,482 
1,404 
76,776 
 
193 
93 
2,968 
997 
156 
4,407 
                           
Contingent liabilities
  and commitments
4,311 
2,883 
3,853 
162 
734 
11,943 
 
211 
226 
                           
CDS asset
             
360 
436 
641 
854 
471 
2,762 
CDS liability
             
387 
435 
551 
871 
460 
2,704 
                           
Lending maturity
                         
  - ≤ 1 year
             
86 
103 
  - 1-5 years
             
24 
19 
37 
14 
94 
  - > 5 years
             
28 
28 
                           
AFS debt security
  maturity
                         
  - ≤ 1 year
             
49 
35 
88 
  - 1-5 years
             
32 
32 
  - > 5 years
             
100 
39 
906 
828 
92 
1,965 
 
 
6

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Country risk: Lending

 
30 June 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Central and local government
Central 
 banks 
Other banks
Other financial institutions
Corporate
Personal
Total
REIL
Provisions
Provision
coverage
 
Central and local government
Central 
 banks 
Other banks
Other financial institutions
Corporate
Personal
Total
 
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m 
%
 
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
                                     
ROI
53
1,557 
75
384
20,669
20,773
43,511
12,483
6,586
53
 
61
2,119 
87
813
19,881
20,228
43,189
Spain
20
13 
1,167
30
6,842
405
8,477
1,717
662
39
 
19
5 
166
92
6,962
407
7,651
Italy
7
81 
724
397
2,317
26
3,552
270
18
7
 
45
78 
668
418
2,483
27
3,719
Greece
10
9 
3
33
421
15
491
310
210
68
 
14
36 
18
31
188
16
303
Portugal
45
- 
48
-
585
5
683
-
-
-
 
86
- 
63
-
611
6
766
                                     
 
135
1,660 
2,017
844
30,834
21,224
56,714
14,870
7,476
51
 
225
2,238 
1,002
1,354
30,125
20,684
55,628

Held-for-trading debt securities (net)

 
30 June 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Central and 
 local 
 government 
Banks 
Other 
 financial 
 institutions 
Corporate 
Total 
 
Central and 
 local 
government 
Banks 
Other 
 financial 
 institutions 
Corporate 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
ROI
44 
79 
266 
76 
465 
 
247 
115 
41 
411 
Spain
(997)
(28)
64 
122 
(839)
 
(67)
46 
33 
34 
46 
Italy
1,833 
69 
51 
93 
2,046 
 
1,946 
52 
49 
35 
2,082 
Greece
248 
(1)
250 
 
81 
81 
Portugal
(33)
21 
17 
 
(51)
44 
                       
 
1,095 
140 
398 
294 
1,927 
 
1,917 
389 
200 
114 
2,620 
 
 
7

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Country risk: HFT debt securities - long positions

 
30 June 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Central and 
 local 
 government 
Banks 
Other 
 financial 
 institutions 
Corporate 
Total 
 
Central and 
 local 
 government 
Banks 
Other 
 financial 
 institutions 
Corporate 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
ROI
84 
85 
302 
76 
547 
 
93 
292 
116 
41 
542 
Spain
1,138 
213 
66 
146 
1,563 
 
1,172 
164 
33 
34 
1,403 
Italy
7,012 
174 
64 
133 
7,383 
 
5,113 
68 
49 
35 
5,265 
Greece
276 
279 
 
118 
118 
Portugal
76 
25 
17 
118 
 
68 
46 
121 
                       
 
8,586 
497 
449 
358 
9,890 
 
6,564 
570 
201 
114 
7,449 

HFT debt securities - short positions

 
30 June 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Central
and local government
Banks
Other
financial institutions
Corporate
Total
 
Central
and local
government
Banks
Other
financial institutions
Corporate
Total
 
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
 
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
                       
ROI
40
6
36
-
82
 
85
45
1
-
131
Spain
2,135
241
2
24
2,402
 
1,239
118
-
-
1,357
Italy
5,179
105
13
40
5,337
 
3,167
16
-
-
3,183
Greece
28
1
-
-
29
 
37
-
-
-
37
Portugal
109
4
-
-
113
 
119
2
-
-
121
                       
 
7,491
357
51
64
7,963
 
4,647
181
1
-
4,829
 
 
8

 

Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Country risk: Available-for-sale (AFS) and loans and receivables (LAR) debt securities

 
30 June 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Central
 and local government
Banks
Other
financial institutions
Corporate
Total
 
Central
 and local government
Banks
Other
 financial institutions
Corporate
Total
 
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
 
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
                       
ROI
93
205
99
134
531
 
104
429
204
184
921
Spain
91
4,928
1,847
361
7,227
 
88
4,829
1,767
401
7,085
Italy
955
1
177
684
1,817
 
906
9
175
679
1,769
Greece
733
-
-
-
733
 
895
-
-
-
895
Portugal
71
102
5
45
223
 
92
106
4
43
245
                       
 
1,943
5,236
2,128
1,224
10,531
 
2,085
5,373
2,150
1,307
10,915

The table above includes LAR of £828 million (31 December 2010 - £901 million) of which £594 million (31 December 2010 - £599 million) relates to bonds issued by Italian and Irish corporates and the rest to other financial institutions of Italy, Republic of Ireland and Spain.


AFS reserves relating to debt securities (gross and net of tax)

 
30 June 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Central and 
 local 
 government 
Banks
Other 
 financial 
 institutions 
Corporate 
AFS 
reserves 
(gross)
AFS 
reserves 
(net)
 
Central and 
 local 
 government 
Banks
Other 
 financial 
 institutions 
Corporate 
AFS 
reserves 
(gross)
AFS 
reserves 
(net)
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                           
ROI
(57)
(44)
(1)
(100)
(75)
 
(41)
(49)
(2)
(92)
(74)
Spain
(49)
(737)
(454)
(3)
(1,243)
(921)
 
(60)
(733)
(481)
(2)
(1,276)
(939)
Italy
(90)
(15)
(105)
(79)
 
(103)
(12)
(115)
(86)
Greece
 
(694)
(694)
(517)
Portugal
(48)
(28)
(76)
(57)
 
(26)
(23)
(49)
(36)
                           
 
(244)
(809)
(455)
(16)
(1,524)
(1,132)
 
(924)
(805)
(495)
(2)
(2,226)
(1,652)
 
 
9

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Country risk: Derivatives and reverse repos

 
30 June 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Central and 
 local 
 government 
Central 
 banks 
Other 
 banks 
Other 
 financial 
 institutions 
Corporate 
Total 
 
Central and 
 local 
 government 
Central 
 banks 
Other 
banks 
Other 
 financial 
 institutions 
Corporate 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                           
ROI
10 
228 
828 
757 
444 
2,267 
 
20 
126 
1,523 
837 
434 
2,940 
Spain
25 
1,554 
10 
415 
2,004 
 
53 
1,482 
22 
490 
2,047 
Italy
60 
1,053 
691 
418 
2,222 
 
71 
782 
759 
418 
2,030 
Greece
2 
186 
2 
22 
212 
 
7 
167 
3 
26 
203 
Portugal
21 
247 
42 
45 
355 
 
29 
307 
7 
50 
393 
                           
 
118 
228 
3,868 
1,502 
1,344 
7,060 
 
180 
126 
4,261 
1,628 
1,418 
7,613 


Contingent liabilities and commitments

 
30 June 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Central and 
 local 
 government 
Banks 
Other 
 financial 
 institutions 
Corporate 
Personal 
Total 
 
Central and 
 local 
 government 
Banks 
Other 
 financial 
 institutions 
Corporate 
Personal 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                           
ROI
2 
53 
818 
2,232 
576 
3,681 
 
1 
83 
1,050 
2,633 
544 
4,311 
Spain
31 
65 
255 
2,198 
57 
2,606 
 
1 
41 
285 
2,494 
62 
2,883 
Italy
7 
44 
1,053 
2,376 
13 
3,493 
 
6 
161 
1,217 
2,456 
13 
3,853 
Greece
1 
154 
10 
165 
 
7 
1 
3 
141 
10 
162 
Portugal
1 
353 
8 
362 
 
211 
2 
1 
512 
8 
734 
                           
 
40 
164 
2,126 
7,313 
664 
10,307 
 
226 
288 
2,556 
8,236 
637 
11,943 
 
 
10

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures

Loans, REIL and impairments by industry and geography
The tables below analyse loans and advances (excluding reverse repos and disposal groups) and related REIL, provisions, impairments and write-offs by industry and geography (by location of office), for the Group, Core and Non-Core.
30 June 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of loans 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
% 
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
 
H1
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
H1 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Group
               
Central and local government
8,081 
Finance - banks
53,264 
155 
133 
0.3 
86 
0.2 
              - other
52,583 
1,088 
677 
2.1 
62 
1.3 
15 
52 
Residential mortgages
149,909 
5,127 
1,284 
3.4 
25 
0.9 
670 
274 
Personal lending
35,453 
3,279 
2,628 
9.2 
80 
7.4 
303 
573 
Property
87,401 
21,953 
8,911 
25.1 
41 
10.2 
2,395 
415 
Construction
11,595 
1,757 
694 
15.2 
39 
6.0 
(73)
118 
Manufacturing
30,361 
1,274 
562 
4.2 
44 
1.9 
85 
30 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
24,721 
1,074 
536 
4.3 
50 
2.2 
80 
66 
  - transport and storage
21,692 
527 
148 
2.4 
28 
0.7 
49 
22 
  - health, education and
    recreation
18,254 
1,202 
413 
6.6 
34 
2.3 
146 
37 
  - hotels and restaurants
9,480 
1,611 
663 
17.0 
41 
7.0 
195 
43 
  - utilities
9,497 
89 
25 
0.9 
28 
0.3 
  - other
30,094 
2,173 
1,138 
7.2 
52 
3.8 
523 
205 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,914 
152 
62 
3.9 
41 
1.6 
(27)
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
16,273 
889 
531 
5.5 
60 
3.3 
68 
92 
Interest accruals
891 
Latent
2,354 
(295)
                 
 
563,463 
42,350 
20,759 
7.5 
49 
3.7 
4,135 
1,930 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
105,259 
2,222 
407 
2.1 
18 
0.4 
124 
12 
  - personal lending
22,563 
2,927 
2,395 
13.0 
82 
10.6 
336 
461 
  - property
63,766 
8,227 
2,847 
12.9 
35 
4.5 
830 
162 
  - other
178,726 
5,735 
3,424 
3.2 
60 
1.9 
239 
439 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
20,864 
2,140 
654 
10.3 
31 
3.1 
337 
  - personal lending
2,806 
216 
178 
7.7 
82 
6.3 
(80)
27 
  - property
18,273 
13,018 
5,826 
71.2 
45 
31.9 
1,570 
170 
  - other
50,711 
5,004 
3,106 
9.9 
62 
6.1 
637 
48 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
23,113 
740 
214 
3.2 
29 
0.9 
209 
260 
  - personal lending
8,614 
134 
53 
1.6 
40 
0.6 
47 
82 
  - property
3,854 
360 
97 
9.3 
27 
2.5 
(46)
63 
  - other
36,908 
610 
1,053 
1.7 
173 
2.9 
(82)
40 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
673 
25 
3.7 
36 
1.3 
  - personal lending
1,470 
0.1 
100 
0.1 
  - property
1,508 
348 
141 
23.1 
41 
9.4 
41 
20 
  - other
24,355 
642 
353 
2.6 
55 
1.4 
(27)
141 
                 
 
563,463 
42,350 
20,759 
7.5 
49 
3.7 
4,135 
1,930 
 
 
11

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by industry and geography (continued)

31 December 2010
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
% 
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
FY 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
FY 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Group
               
Central and local government
8,452 
Finance - banks
58,036 
145 
127 
0.2 
88 
0.2 
(13)
12 
              - other
54,561 
1,129 
595 
2.1 
53 
1.1 
198 
141 
Residential mortgages
146,501 
4,276 
877 
2.9 
21 
0.6 
1,014 
669 
Personal lending
37,472 
3,544 
2,894 
9.5 
82 
7.7 
1,370 
1,577 
Property
90,106 
19,584 
6,736 
21.7 
34 
7.5 
4,682 
1,009 
Construction
12,032 
2,464 
875 
20.5 
36 
7.3 
530 
146 
Manufacturing
32,317 
1,199 
503 
3.7 
42 
1.6 
(92)
1,547 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
25,165 
1,157 
572 
4.6 
49 
2.3 
334 
161 
  - transport and storage
24,141 
248 
118 
1.0 
48 
0.5 
87 
39 
  - health, education and
    recreation
19,321 
1,055 
319 
5.5 
30 
1.7 
159 
199 
  - hotels and restaurants
9,681 
1,269 
504 
13.1 
40 
5.2 
321 
106 
  - utilities
9,208 
91 
23 
1.0 
25 
0.2 
14 
  - other
29,994 
1,438 
749 
4.8 
52 
2.5 
378 
310 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,893 
152 
86 
3.9 
57 
2.2 
31 
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
16,850 
847 
554 
5.0 
65 
3.3 
252 
113 
Interest accruals
1,109 
Latent
2,650 
(121)
                 
 
578,839 
38,598 
18,182 
6.7 
47 
3.1 
9,144 
6,042 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
101,593 
2,062 
314 
2.0 
15 
0.3 
169 
17 
  - personal lending
23,620 
3,083 
2,518 
13.1 
82 
10.7 
1,046 
1,153 
  - property
65,462 
7,986 
2,219 
12.2 
28 
3.4 
1,546 
397 
  - other
191,934 
5,652 
3,580 
2.9 
63 
1.9 
1,197 
704 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
20,094 
1,551 
301 
7.7 
19 
1.5 
221 
  - personal lending
2,870 
401 
316 
14.0 
79 
11.0 
66 
24 
  - property
17,775 
10,534 
4,199 
59.3 
40 
23.6 
2,828 
210 
  - other
53,380 
3,950 
2,454 
7.4 
62 
4.6 
763 
1,423 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
24,201 
640 
253 
2.6 
40 
1.0 
615 
645 
  - personal lending
9,520 
55 
55 
0.6 
100 
0.6 
160 
271 
  - property
4,929 
765 
202 
15.5 
26 
4.1 
321 
220 
  - other
36,780 
870 
1,133 
2.4 
130 
3.1 
(76)
524 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
613 
23 
3.8 
39 
1.5 
  - personal lending
1,462 
0.3 
100 
0.3 
98 
129 
  - property
1,940 
299 
116 
15.4 
39 
6.0 
(13)
182 
  - other
22,666 
722 
508 
3.2 
70 
2.2 
194 
136 
                 
 
578,839 
38,598 
18,182 
6.7 
47 
3.1 
9,144 
6,042 
 
 
12

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by industry and geography (continued)

30 June 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
of gross 
 loans 
 
H1 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
H1 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Central and local government
6,574 
Finance - banks
52,619 
145 
132 
0.3 
91 
0.3 
              - other
47,545 
777 
531 
1.6 
68 
1.1 
130 
18 
Residential mortgages
144,400 
4,629 
1,000 
3.2 
22 
0.7 
422 
118 
Personal lending
32,224 
2,968 
2,380 
9.2 
80 
7.4 
320 
502 
Property
44,539 
3,749 
943 
8.4 
25 
2.1 
124 
59 
Construction
8,525 
812 
271 
9.5 
33 
3.2 
100 
84 
Manufacturing
24,068 
546 
259 
2.3 
47 
1.1 
21 
22 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
22,123 
667 
315 
3.0 
47 
1.4 
92 
48 
  - transport and storage
15,243 
247 
45 
1.6 
18 
0.3 
23 
19 
  - health, education and
    recreation
16,707 
576 
177 
3.4 
31 
1.1 
53 
14 
  - hotels and restaurants
8,028 
976 
345 
12.2 
35 
4.3 
112 
19 
  - utilities
7,487 
20 
0.3 
(1)
  - other
25,128 
1,070 
638 
4.3 
60 
2.5 
407 
72 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,791 
81 
24 
2.1 
30 
0.6 
(29)
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
8,353 
194 
124 
2.3 
64 
1.5 
20 
40 
Interest accruals
715 
Latent
1,568 
(132)
                 
 
468,069 
17,457 
8,752 
3.7 
50 
1.9 
1,662 
1,018 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
103,689 
2,168 
397 
2.1 
18 
0.4 
119 
11 
  - personal lending
22,205 
2,723 
2,210 
12.3 
81 
10.0 
326 
458 
  - property
36,584 
2,747 
586 
7.5 
21 
1.6 
77 
 42 
  - other
153,718 
3,078 
1,814 
2.0 
59 
1.2 
231 
293 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
20,224 
1,956 
514 
9.7 
26 
2.5 
224 
  - personal lending
2,234 
146 
125 
6.5 
86 
5.6 
(23)
12 
  - property
5,483 
826 
281 
15.1 
34 
5.1 
37 
  - other
37,702 
2,576 
1,829 
6.8 
71 
4.9 
568 
15 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
20,020 
481 
80 
2.4 
17 
0.4 
79 
105 
  - personal lending
6,315 
97 
43 
1.5 
44 
0.7 
17 
29 
  - property
2,228 
127 
38 
5.7 
30 
1.7 
10 
17 
  - other
34,157 
304 
638 
0.9 
210 
1.9 
29 
28 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
467 
24 
5.1 
38 
1.9 
  - personal lending
1,470 
0.1 
100 
0.1 
  - property
244 
49 
38 
20.1 
78 
15.6 
  - other
21,329 
153 
148 
0.7 
97 
0.7 
(32)
                 
 
468,069 
17,457 
8,752 
3.7 
50 
1.9 
1,662 
1,018 
 
 
13

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by industry and geography (continued)

 
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
FY 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
FY 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
31 December 2010
                 
Core
               
Central and local government
6,781 
Finance - banks
57,033 
144 
126 
0.3 
88 
0.2 
(5)
              - other
46,910 
567 
402 
1.2 
71 
0.9 
191 
53 
Residential mortgages
140,359 
3,999 
693 
2.8 
17 
0.5 
578 
243 
Personal lending
33,581 
3,131 
2,545 
9.3 
81 
7.6 
1,157 
1,271 
Property
42,455 
3,287 
818 
7.7 
25 
1.9 
739 
98 
Construction
8,680 
610 
222 
7.0 
36 
2.6 
189 
38 
Manufacturing
25,797 
555 
266 
2.2 
48 
1.0 
119 
124 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
21,974 
611 
259 
2.8 
42 
1.2 
199 
103 
  - transport and storage
15,946 
112 
40 
0.7 
36 
0.3 
40 
35 
  - health, education and
    recreation
17,456 
507 
134 
2.9 
26 
0.8 
145 
64 
  - hotels and restaurants
8,189 
741 
236 
9.0 
32 
2.9 
165 
49 
  - utilities
7,098 
22 
0.3 
14 
  - other
24,464 
583 
276 
2.4 
47 
1.1 
137 
98 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,758 
94 
57 
2.5 
61 
1.5 
24 
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
8,321 
244 
140 
2.9 
57 
1.7 
63 
42 
Interest accruals
831 
Latent
1,649 
(5)
                 
 
469,633 
15,207 
7,866 
3.2 
52 
1.7 
3,737 
2,224 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
99,928 
2,010 
307 
2.0 
15 
0.3 
164 
16 
  - personal lending
23,035 
2,888 
2,341 
12.5 
81 
10.2 
1,033 
1,142 
  - property
34,970 
2,454 
500 
7.0 
20 
1.4 
394 
43 
  - other
161,746 
2,657 
1,743 
1.6 
66 
1.1 
689 
318 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
19,473 
1,506 
280 
7.7 
19 
1.4 
184 
  - personal lending
2,270 
203 
164 
8.9 
81 
7.2 
43 
19 
  - property
5,139 
631 
240 
12.3 
38 
4.7 
241 
  - other
38,992 
1,565 
1,343 
4.0 
86 
3.4 
468 
85 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
20,548 
460 
97 
2.2 
21 
0.5 
225 
221 
  - personal lending
6,816 
35 
35 
0.5 
100 
0.5 
81 
110 
  - property
1,611 
144 
43 
8.9 
30 
2.7 
84 
54 
  - other
33,110 
388 
649 
1.2 
167 
2.0 
35 
171 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
410 
23 
5.6 
39 
2.2 
  - personal lending
1,460 
0.3 
100 
0.3 
  - property
735 
58 
35 
7.9 
60 
4.8 
20 
  - other
19,390 
180 
75 
0.9 
42 
0.4 
71 
38 
                 
 
469,633 
15,207 
7,866 
3.2 
52 
1.7 
3,737 
2,224 
 
 
14

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by industry and geography (continued)

30 June 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
H1 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
H1 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Non-Core
               
Central and local government
1,507 
Finance - banks
645 
10 
1.6 
10 
0.2 
              - other
5,038 
311 
146 
6.2 
47 
2.9 
(115)
34 
Residential mortgages
5,509 
498 
284 
9.0 
57 
5.2 
248 
156 
Personal lending
3,229 
311 
248 
9.6 
80 
7.7 
(17)
71 
Property
42,862 
18,204 
7,968 
42.5 
44 
18.6 
2,271 
356 
Construction
3,070 
945 
423 
30.8 
45 
13.8 
(173)
34 
Manufacturing
6,293 
728 
303 
11.6 
42 
4.8 
64 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
2,598 
407 
221 
15.7 
54 
8.5 
(12)
18 
  - transport and storage
6,449 
280 
103 
4.3 
37 
1.6 
26 
  - health, education and
    recreation
1,547 
626 
236 
40.5 
38 
15.3 
93 
23 
  - hotels and restaurants
1,452 
635 
318 
43.7 
50 
21.9 
83 
24 
  - utilities
2,010 
69 
25 
3.4 
36 
1.2 
  - other
4,966 
1,103 
500 
22.2 
45 
10.1 
116 
133 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
123 
71 
38 
57.7 
54 
30.9 
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
7,920 
695 
407 
8.8 
59 
5.1 
48 
52 
Interest accruals
176 
Latent
786 
(163)
                 
 
95,394 
24,893 
12,007 
26.1 
48 
12.6 
2,473 
912 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
1,570 
54 
10 
3.4 
19 
0.6 
  - personal lending
358 
204 
185 
57.0 
91 
51.7 
10 
  - property
27,182 
5,480 
2,261 
20.2 
41 
8.3 
753 
120 
  - other
25,008 
2,657 
1,610 
10.6 
61 
6.4 
146 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
640 
184 
140 
28.8 
76 
21.9 
113 
  - personal lending
572 
70 
53 
12.2 
76 
9.3 
(57)
15 
  - property
12,790 
12,192 
5,545 
95.3 
45 
43.4 
1,533 
170 
  - other
13,009 
2,428 
1,277 
18.7 
53 
9.8 
69 
33 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
3,093 
259 
134 
8.4 
52 
4.3 
130 
155 
  - personal lending
2,299 
37 
10 
1.6 
27 
0.4 
30 
53 
  - property
1,626 
233 
59 
14.3 
25 
3.6 
(56)
46 
  - other
2,751 
306 
415 
11.1 
136 
15.1 
(111)
12 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
206 
0.5 
  - personal lending
  - property
1,264 
299 
103 
23.7 
34 
8.1 
41 
20 
  - other
3,026 
489 
205 
16.2 
42 
6.8 
138 
                 
 
95,394 
24,893 
12,007 
26.1 
48 
12.6 
2,473 
912 
 
 
15

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by industry and geography (continued)

31 December 2010
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
FY 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
FY 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Non-Core
               
Central and local government
1,671 
Finance - banks
1,003 
0.1 
100 
0.1 
(8)
11 
              - other
7,651 
562 
193 
7.3 
34 
2.5 
88 
Residential mortgages
6,142 
277 
184 
4.5 
66 
3.0 
436 
426 
Personal lending
3,891 
413 
349 
10.6 
85 
9.0 
213 
306 
Property
47,651 
16,297 
5,918 
34.2 
36 
12.4 
3,943 
911 
Construction
3,352 
1,854 
653 
55.3 
35 
19.5 
341 
108 
Manufacturing
6,520 
644 
237 
9.9 
37 
3.6 
(211)
1,423 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
3,191 
546 
313 
17.1 
57 
9.8 
135 
58 
  - transport and storage
8,195 
136 
78 
1.7 
57 
1.0 
47 
  - health, education and
    recreation
1,865 
548 
185 
29.4 
34 
9.9 
14 
135 
  - hotels and restaurants
1,492 
528 
268 
35.4 
51 
18.0 
156 
57 
  - utilities
2,110 
69 
20 
3.3 
29 
0.9 
13 
  - other
5,530 
855 
473 
15.5 
55 
8.6 
241 
212 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
135 
58 
29 
43.0 
50 
21.5 
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
8,529 
603 
414 
7.1 
69 
4.9 
189 
71 
Interest accruals
278 
Latent
1,001 
(116)
                 
 
109,206 
23,391 
10,316 
21.4 
44 
9.4 
5,407 
3,818 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
1,665 
52 
3.1 
13 
0.4 
  - personal lending
585 
195 
177 
33.3 
91 
30.3 
13 
11 
  - property
30,492 
5,532 
1,719 
18.1 
31 
5.6 
1,152 
354 
  - other
30,188 
2,995 
1,837 
9.9 
61 
6.1 
508 
386 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
621 
45 
21 
7.2 
47 
3.4 
37 
  - personal lending
600 
198 
152 
33.0 
77 
25.3 
23 
  - property
12,636 
9,903 
3,959 
78.4 
40 
31.3 
2,587 
209 
  - other
14,388 
2,385 
1,111 
16.6 
47 
7.7 
295 
1,338 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
3,653 
180 
156 
4.9 
87 
4.3 
390 
424 
  - personal lending
2,704 
20 
20 
0.7 
100 
0.7 
79 
161 
  - property
3,318 
621 
159 
18.7 
26 
4.8 
237 
166 
  - other
3,670 
482 
484 
13.1 
100 
13.2 
(111)
353 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
203 
  - personal lending
98 
129 
  - property
1,205 
241 
81 
20.0 
34 
6.7 
(33)
182 
  - other
3,276 
542 
433 
16.5 
80 
13.2 
123 
98 
                 
 
109,206 
23,391 
10,316 
21.4 
44 
9.4 
5,407 
3,818 
 
 
16

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by division
The table below analyses the Group's loans and advances to banks and customers (excluding reverse repos and disposal groups) and related REIL, PPL, provisions, impairments, write-offs and coverage ratios by division.
 
Gross 
loans 
REIL 
PPL 
REIL 
 & PPL 
Provisions 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
REIL & PPL 
as a % 
of gross 
 loans 
 
Impairment 
charge 
 
Amounts 
written-off 
 
£m 
£m 
 £m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
30 June 2011
                 
UK Retail
110,770 
4,622 
135 
4,757 
2,672 
58 
4.3 
402 
457 
UK Corporate
110,893 
4,761 
157 
4,918 
1,902 
40 
4.4 
322 
332 
Wealth
19,626 
185 
52 
237 
69 
37 
1.2 
Global Transaction Services
23,074 
309 
310 
216 
70 
1.3 
74 
11 
Ulster Bank
39,450 
5,116 
5,116 
2,401 
47 
13.0 
730 
21 
US Retail & Commercial
48,020 
929 
929 
484 
52 
1.9 
139 
170 
                   
Retail & Commercial
351,833 
15,922 
345 
16,267 
7,744 
49 
4.6 
1,675 
997 
Global Banking & Markets
112,310 
1,535 
1,544 
1,008 
66 
1.4 
(13)
21 
RBS Insurance and other
3,926 
                   
Core
468,069 
17,457 
354 
17,811 
8,752 
50 
3.8 
1,662 
1,018 
Non-Core
95,394 
24,893 
127 
25,020 
12,007 
48 
26.2 
2,473 
912 
                   
 
563,463 
42,350 
481 
42,831 
20,759 
49 
7.6 
4,135 
1,930 
                   
31 December 2010
                 
UK Retail
108,813 
4,620 
175 
4,795 
2,741 
59 
4.4 
1,160 
1,135 
UK Corporate
111,744 
3,967 
221 
4,188 
1,732 
44 
3.7 
761 
349 
Wealth
18,350 
223 
38 
261 
66 
30 
1.4 
18 
Global Transaction Services
17,484 
146 
152 
147 
101 
0.9 
49 
Ulster Bank
39,786 
3,619 
3,621 
1,633 
45 
9.1 
1,161 
48 
US Retail & Commercial
48,661 
913 
913 
505 
55 
1.9 
483 
547 
                   
Retail & Commercial
344,838 
13,488 
442 
13,930 
6,824 
51 
4.0 
3,591 
2,137 
Global Banking & Markets
122,054 
1,719 
31 
1,750 
1,042 
61 
1.4 
146 
87 
RBS Insurance and other
2,741 
                   
Core
469,633 
15,207 
473 
15,680 
7,866 
52 
3.3 
3,737 
2,224 
Non-Core
109,206 
23,391 
160 
23,551 
10,316 
44 
21.6 
5,407 
3,818 
                   
 
578,839 
38,598 
633 
39,231 
18,182 
47 
6.8 
9,144 
6,042 
 
 
17

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

ABS by geography and measurement classification

 
US 
UK 
Other 
 Europe 
RoW 
Total 
HFT 
DFV 
AFS 
LAR 
30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Gross exposure
                 
RMBS: G10 government
29,429 
15 
6,538 
35,982 
17,876 
18,106 
RMBS: covered bond
141 
214 
8,871 
9,226 
9,226 
RMBS: prime
1,457 
3,451 
1,997 
379 
7,284 
1,461 
28 
5,689 
106 
RMBS: non-conforming
994 
2,029 
85 
3,108 
516 
1,214 
1,378 
RMBS: sub-prime
753 
613 
149 
207 
1,722 
1,057 
470 
195 
CMBS
2,467 
1,755 
916 
46 
5,184 
2,668 
1,100 
1,416 
CDOs
11,663 
85 
503 
12,251 
7,764 
4,392 
95 
CLOs
5,002 
122 
841 
5,966 
1,153 
4,488 
325 
Other ABS
2,603 
1,679 
2,313 
1,340 
7,935 
1,749 
3,630 
2,556 
                   
 
54,509 
9,963 
22,213 
1,973 
88,658 
34,244 
28 
48,315 
6,071 
                   
Carrying value
                 
RMBS: G10 government
29,826 
15 
6,104 
35,945 
17,967 
17,978 
RMBS: covered bond
144 
214 
7,814 
8,172 
8,172 
RMBS: prime
1,279 
3,141 
1,731 
378 
6,529 
1,253 
5,178 
97 
RMBS: non-conforming
848 
1,876 
85 
2,809 
428 
1,004 
1,377 
RMBS: sub-prime
600 
298 
121 
189 
1,208 
685 
336 
187 
CMBS
2,320 
1,416 
701 
45 
4,482 
2,161 
993 
1,328 
CDOs
3,119 
54 
312 
3,485 
1,367 
2,024 
94 
CLOs
4,529 
84 
631 
5,245 
814 
4,147 
284 
Other ABS
2,351 
929 
2,190 
1,312 
6,782 
961 
3,375 
2,446 
                   
 
45,016 
8,027 
19,689 
1,925 
74,657 
25,636 
43,207 
5,813 
                   
Net exposure
                 
RMBS: G10 government
29,826 
15 
6,104 
35,945 
17,967 
17,978 
RMBS: covered bond
144 
214 
7,814 
8,172 
8,172 
RMBS: prime
1,048 
3,129 
1,406 
378 
5,961 
691 
5,172 
97 
RMBS: non-conforming
845 
1,877 
85 
2,807 
426 
1,004 
1,377 
RMBS: sub-prime
113 
298 
113 
164 
688 
174 
327 
187 
CMBS
1,368 
1,414 
573 
45 
3,400 
1,138 
952 
1,310 
CDOs
1,087 
29 
304 
1,420 
856 
470 
94 
CLOs
1,251 
84 
630 
1,966 
811 
871 
284 
Other ABS
2,026 
810 
2,190 
1,312 
6,338 
617 
3,376 
2,345 
                   
 
37,708 
7,870 
19,219 
1,900 
66,697 
22,680 
38,322 
5,694 
 
 
18

 
 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

ABS by geography and measurement classification (continued)

 
US 
UK 
Other 
 Europe 
RoW 
Total 
HFT 
DFV 
AFS 
LAR 
31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Gross exposure
                 
RMBS: G10 government
24,207 
16 
6,422 
30,645 
13,840 
16,805 
RMBS: covered bond
138 
208 
8,525 
8,871 
8,871 
RMBS: prime
1,784 
3,385 
1,118 
192 
6,479 
1,605 
4,749 
124 
RMBS: non-conforming
1,249 
2,107 
92 
3,448 
708 
1,313 
1,427 
RMBS: sub-prime
792 
365 
139 
221 
1,517 
819 
496 
202 
CMBS
3,086 
1,451 
912 
45 
5,494 
2,646 
120 
1,409 
1,319 
CDOs
12,156 
128 
453 
12,737 
7,951 
4,687 
99 
CLOs
6,038 
134 
879 
7,060 
1,062 
5,572 
426 
Other ABS
3,104 
1,144 
2,871 
1,705 
8,824 
1,533 
4,523 
2,768 
                   
 
52,554 
8,938 
21,411 
2,172 
85,075 
30,164 
121 
48,425 
6,365 
                   
Carrying value
                 
RMBS: G10 government
24,390 
16 
5,958 
30,364 
13,765 
16,599 
RMBS: covered bond
142 
208 
7,522 
7,872 
7,872 
RMBS: prime
1,624 
3,000 
931 
192 
5,747 
1,384 
4,249 
113 
RMBS: non-conforming
1,084 
1,959 
92 
3,135 
605 
1,102 
1,428 
RMBS: sub-prime
638 
255 
120 
205 
1,218 
681 
344 
193 
CMBS
2,936 
1,338 
638 
38 
4,950 
2,262 
118 
1,281 
1,289 
CDOs
3,135 
69 
254 
3,458 
1,341 
2,021 
96 
CLOs
5,334 
102 
635 
6,074 
691 
4,958 
425 
Other ABS
2,780 
945 
2,615 
1,667 
8,007 
1,259 
4,089 
2,659 
                   
 
42,063 
7,892 
18,765 
2,105 
70,825 
21,988 
119 
42,515 
6,203 
                   
Net exposure
                 
RMBS: G10 government
24,390 
16 
5,958 
30,364 
13,765 
16,599 
RMBS: covered bond
142 
208 
7,522 
7,872 
7,872 
RMBS: prime
1,523 
2,948 
596 
192 
5,259 
897 
4,248 
113 
RMBS: non-conforming
1,081 
1,959 
92 
3,132 
602 
1,102 
1,428 
RMBS: sub-prime
289 
253 
112 
176 
830 
305 
332 
193 
CMBS
1,823 
1,336 
458 
38 
3,655 
1,188 
10 
1,230 
1,227 
CDOs
1,085 
39 
245 
1,369 
743 
530 
96 
CLOs
1,387 
102 
629 
2,119 
673 
1,021 
425 
Other ABS
2,293 
748 
2,609 
1,659 
7,309 
690 
4,081 
2,538 
                   
 
34,013 
7,609 
18,221 
2,066 
61,909 
18,863 
11 
37,015 
6,020 
 
 
19

 


 

 
Appendix 3
 
Asset Protection Scheme



 
 
 
 
 
Appendix 3 Asset Protection Scheme

Covered assets roll forward
The table below shows the movement in covered assets.
 
Covered 
amount 
 
£bn 
   
Covered assets at 31 December 2010
194.7 
Disposals
(1.4)
Maturities, amortisation and early repayments
(10.6)
Effect of foreign currency movements and other adjustments
(0.9)
   
Covered assets at 31 March 2011
181.8 
Disposals
(1.5)
Maturities, amortisation and early repayments
(13.7)
Effect of foreign currency movements and other adjustments
1.1 
   
Covered assets at 30 June 2011
167.7 

Key points
·
Covered amount has reduced by £114 billion since scheme inception (December 2008) from £282 billion to £168 billion.
   
·
The Group continues to take advantage of market conditions and execute sales from a number of its portfolios.

Credit impairments and write downs
The table below analyses the cumulative credit impairment losses and adjustments to par value (including available-for-sale reserves) relating to the covered assets.

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Loans and advances
19,777 
18,799 
18,033 
Debt securities
10,785 
11,085 
11,747 
Derivatives
2,125 
1,826 
2,043 
       
 
32,687 
31,710 
31,823 
       
By division:
     
UK Retail
3,124 
3,053 
2,964 
UK Corporate
1,838 
1,703 
1,382 
Ulster Bank
1,190 
1,040 
804 
       
Retail & Commercial
6,152 
5,796 
5,150 
Global Banking & Markets
1,420 
1,445 
1,496 
       
Core
7,572 
7,241 
6,646 
Non-Core
25,115 
24,469 
25,177 
       
 
32,687 
31,710 
31,823 

Key point
·
Cumulative credit impairments and write-downs increased by £1.0 billion in the quarter, reflecting further impairments and write-downs (£1.0 billion) and exchange rate movements (£0.1 billion) partially offset by Non-Core disposals (£0.1 billion).

 
1

 
 
Appendix 3 Asset Protection Scheme (continued)

First loss utilisation
The Group has agreed with HM Treasury modifications to the Scheme rules, which affect most APS portfolios in Global Banking & Markets and an APS portfolio in UK Corporate that relates to larger clients. All other APS portfolios in the Group are unaffected. The overall economic aspects of the Scheme are unchanged, including value and term of cover, credit derivative valuation and capital effects.

The modified rules for recognition of triggered assets align more closely to the Group’s normal accounting and risk management procedures and will reduce the administrative burden of operating the Scheme. For the portfolios subject to these changes, the calculation of loss now takes into account expected recoveries in addition to those already received. This has resulted in a reduction in first loss utilisation. A comparison of losses arising under the original Scheme rules with those arising under the modified Scheme rules is set out below. This covers the period from Scheme inception to 31 March 2011 (the last point at which the original rules applied for the affected assets).

 
£m 
   
Original First Loss Utilisation
38,961 
Assets not triggered under modified rules (1)
(4,126)
Assets triggered under modified rules (2)
997 
Expected recoveries (3)
(6,272)
   
Revised First Loss Utilisation
29,560 

Notes:
(1)
Assets that had triggered under the original Scheme rules but were not impaired or defaulted are not triggered under the modified rules.
(2)
Assets that had not yet triggered under the original Scheme rules but had impaired or defaulted are triggered under the modified rules.
(3)
For assets which have triggered under both original and modified rules, this amount represents the excess of expected recoveries over cash recoveries received to date.
 
 
2

 
 
Appendix 3 Asset Protection Scheme (continued)

First loss utilisation (continued)
The table below shows the first loss utilisation under the original and modified rules.

 
Original Scheme rules
 
Modified
Scheme rules
 
 
Gross loss 
amount 
Cash 
recoveries 
to date 
 
Net 
triggered 
 loss 
Total 
net 
triggered 
amount 
30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
           
UK Retail
3,895 
(608)
 
3,287 
UK Corporate
1,914 
(622)
 
806 
2,098 
Ulster Bank
1,918 
(202)
 
1,716 
           
Retail & Commercial
7,727 
(1,432)
 
806 
7,101 
Global Banking & Markets
 
962 
962 
           
Core
7,727 
(1,432)
 
1,768 
8,063 
Non-Core
14,676 
(2,190)
 
7,753 
20,239 
           
 
22,403 
(3,622)
 
9,521 
28,302 
           
Loss credits
       
1,632 
           
         
29,934 
           
31 March 2011
         
           
UK Retail
3,789 
(514)
 
3,275 
UK Corporate
1,930 
(559)
 
768 
2,139 
Ulster Bank
1,659 
(216)
 
1,443 
           
Retail & Commercial
7,378 
(1,289)
 
768 
6,857 
Global Banking & Markets
 
994 
994 
           
Core
7,378 
(1,289)
 
1,762 
7,851 
Non-Core
14,852 
(2,007)
 
7,396 
20,241 
           
 
22,230 
(3,296)
 
9,158 
28,092 
           
Loss credits
       
1,468 
           
         
29,560 
           
31 December 2010
         
           
UK Retail
3,675 
(455)
 
3,220 
UK Corporate
1,690 
(427)
 
597 
1,860 
Ulster Bank
1,500 
(160)
 
1,340 
           
Retail & Commercial
6,865 
(1,042)
 
597 
6,420 
Global Banking & Markets
 
962 
962 
           
Core
6,865 
(1,042)
 
1,559 
7,382 
Non-Core
13,946 
(1,876)
 
6,923 
18,993 
           
 
20,811 
(2,918)
 
8,482 
26,375 
           
Loss credits
       
1,241 
           
         
27,616 
 
 
3

 
 
Appendix 3 Asset Protection Scheme (continued)

First loss utilisation (continued)

Key points
·
In Q2 2011 the Group received loss credits of £0.2 billion in relation to disposals. The Group and the Asset Protection Agency remain in discussion with regard to loss credits in relation to the withdrawal of £0.5 billion of derivative assets during Q2 2010.
   
·
As previously disclosed the Group expects an average recovery rate of approximately 45% across all portfolios.

Risk-weighted assets
The table below analyses by division, risk-weighted assets (RWAs) covered by APS.

 
30 June 
2011 
31 March 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
UK Retail
10.7 
11.4 
12.4 
UK Corporate
19.3 
21.5 
22.9 
Ulster Bank
7.6 
7.4 
7.9 
       
Retail & Commercial
37.6 
40.3 
43.2 
Global Banking & Markets
10.3 
11.1 
11.5 
       
Core
47.9 
51.4 
54.7 
Non-Core
47.3 
47.0 
50.9 
       
APS RWAs
95.2 
98.4 
105.6 

Key point
·
The decrease of £3.2 billion in RWAs reflects pool movements, partially offset by changes in risk parameters principally in Non-Core and Ulster Bank.

 
4

 
 

Glossary of terms


Alt-A (Alternative A-paper) are mortgage loans with a higher credit quality than sub-prime loans but with features that disqualify the borrower from a traditional prime loan. Alt-A lending characteristics include limited documentation; high loan-to-value ratio; secured on non-owner occupied properties; and debt-to-income ratio above normal limits.

Arrears are the aggregate of contractual payments due on a debt that have not been met by the borrower. A loan or other financial asset is said to be 'in arrears' when payments have not been made.

Asset-backed commercial paper (ABCP) - a form of asset-backed security generally issued by a commercial paper conduit.

Asset-backed securities (ABS) are securities that represent interests in specific portfolios of assets. They are issued by a special purpose entity following a securitisation. The underlying portfolios commonly comprise residential or commercial mortgages but can include any class of asset that yields predictable cash flows. Payments on the securities depend primarily on the cash flows generated by the assets in the underlying pool and other rights designed to assure timely payment, such as guarantees or other credit enhancements. Collateralised bond obligations, collateralised debt obligations, collateralised loan obligations, commercial mortgage backed securities and residential mortgage backed securities are all types of ABS.

Asset Protection Scheme credit default swap - in 2009, the Group became party to the asset protection scheme under which it purchased credit protection over a portfolio of specified assets and exposures (covered assets) from Her Majesty’s Treasury acting on behalf of the UK Government.  The contract is accounted for as a derivative financial instrument.  It is recognised at fair value and included in Derivatives on the balance sheet.  Changes in its fair value are recognised in profit or loss within Income from trading activities.

Assets under management are assets managed by the Group on behalf of clients.

Certificate of deposit (CD) - CDs are bearer negotiable instruments acknowledging the receipt of a fixed term deposit at a specified interest rate.

Collateralised bond obligations (CBOs) are asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are bonds, some of which may be sub-investment grade.

Collateralised debt obligations (CDOs) are asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are debt obligations: either bonds (collateralised bond obligations) or loans (collateralised loan obligations) or both. The credit exposure underlying synthetic CDOs derives from credit default swaps. The CDOs issued by an individual vehicle are usually divided in different tranches: senior tranches (rated AAA), mezzanine tranches (AA to BB), and equity tranches (unrated). Losses are borne first by the equity securities, next by the junior securities, and finally by the senior securities; junior tranches offer higher coupons (interest payments) to compensate for their increased risk.

Collateralised loan obligations (CLOs) are asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are loans, often leveraged loans.

 
1

 
 
Glossary of terms (continued)

Collectively assessed loan impairment provisions - impairment loss provisions in respect of impaired loans, such as credit cards or personal loans, that are below individual assessment thresholds. Such provisions are established on a portfolio basis, taking account of the level of arrears, security, past loss experience, credit scores and defaults based on portfolio trends.

Commercial mortgage backed securities (CMBS) are asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are loans secured on commercial real estate.

Commercial paper (CP) comprises unsecured obligations issued by a corporate or a bank directly or secured obligations (asset-backed CP), often issued through a commercial paper conduit, to fund working capital. Maturities typically range from 2 to 270 days. However, the depth and reliability of some CP markets means that issuers can repeatedly roll over CP issuance and effectively achieve longer term funding. Commercial paper is issued in a wide range of denominations and can be either discounted or interest-bearing.

Commercial real estate - freehold and leasehold properties used for business activities. Commercial real estate includes office buildings, industrial property, medical centres, hotels, retail stores, shopping centres, agricultural land and buildings, warehouses, garages etc.

Contractual maturity is the date in the terms of a financial instrument on which the last payment or receipt under the contract is due for settlement.

Core Tier 1 capital - called-up share capital and eligible reserves plus equity non-controlling interests, less intangible assets and other regulatory deductions.

Core Tier 1 capital ratio - core Tier 1 capital as a percentage of risk-weighted assets.

Cost:income ratio - operating expenses as a percentage of total income.

Covered mortgage bonds are debt securities backed by a portfolio of mortgages that is segregated from the issuer's other assets solely for the benefit of the holders of the covered bonds

Credit default swap (CDS) is a contract where the protection seller receives premium or interest-related payments in return for contracting to make payments to the protection buyer upon a defined credit event in relation to a reference financial asset or portfolio of financial assets. Credit events usually include bankruptcy, payment default and rating downgrades.

Credit derivative product company (CDPC) is a special purpose entity that sells credit protection under credit default swaps or certain approved forms of insurance policies. Sometimes they can also buy credit protection. CDPCs are similar to monoline insurers. However, unlike monoline insurers, they are not regulated as insurers.
 
 
2

 
 
Glossary of terms (continued)

Credit derivatives are contractual agreements that provide protection against a credit event on one or more reference entities or financial assets. The nature of a credit event is established by the protection buyer and protection seller at the inception of a transaction, and such events include bankruptcy, insolvency or failure to meet payment obligations when due. The buyer of the credit derivative pays a periodic fee in return for a payment by the protection seller upon the occurrence, if any, of a credit event. Credit derivatives include credit default swaps, total return swaps and credit swap options.

Credit risk assets - loans and advances (including overdraft facilities), instalment credit, finance lease receivables and other traded instruments across all customer types.

Credit risk spread - is the difference between the coupon on a debt instrument and the benchmark or the risk-free interest rate for the instrument's maturity structure. It is the premium over the risk-free rate required by the market for the credit quality of an individual debt instrument.

Credit valuation adjustments - are adjustments to the fair values of derivative assets to reflect the creditworthiness of the counterparty.

Currency swap - an arrangement in which two parties exchange specific principal amounts of different currencies at inception and subsequently interest payments on the principal amounts. Often, one party will pay a fixed interest rate, while the other will pay a floating exchange rate (though there are also fixed-fixed and floating-floating arrangements). At the maturity of the swap, the principal amounts are usually re-exchanged.

Customer accounts - comprise money deposited with the Group by counterparties other than banks and classified as liabilities. They include demand, savings and time deposits; securities sold under repurchase agreements; and other short-term deposits. Deposits received from banks are classified as deposits by banks.

Debt restructuring - see Renegotiated loans.

Debt securities are transferable instruments creating or acknowledging indebtedness. They include debentures, bonds, certificates of deposit, notes and commercial paper. The holder of a debt security is typically entitled to the payment of principal and interest, together with other contractual rights under the terms of the issue, such as the right to receive certain information. Debt securities are generally issued for a fixed term and redeemable by the issuer at the end of that term. Debt securities can be secured or unsecured.

Debt securities in issue comprise unsubordinated debt securities issued by the Group. They include commercial paper, certificates of deposit, bonds and medium-term notes.

Deferred tax asset - income taxes recoverable in future periods as a result of deductible temporary differences - temporary differences between the accounting and tax base of an asset or liability that will result in tax deductible amounts in future periods - and the carry-forward of tax losses and unused tax credits.

 
3

 
 
Glossary of terms (continued)

Deferred tax liability - income taxes payable in future periods as a result of taxable temporary differences (temporary differences between the accounting and tax base of an asset or liability that will result in taxable amounts in future periods).

Defined benefit obligation - the present value of expected future payments required to settle the obligations of a defined benefit plan resulting from employee service.

Defined benefit plan - pension or other post-retirement benefit plan other than a defined contribution plan.

Delinquency - a debt or other financial obligation is considered delinquent when one or more contractual payments are overdue. Delinquency is usually defined in terms of days past due. Delinquent and in arrears are synonymous.

Deposits by banks - comprise money deposited with the Group by banks and recorded as liabilities. They include money-market deposits, securities sold under repurchase agreements, federal funds purchased and other short term deposits. Deposits received from customers are recorded as customer accounts.

Derivative - a contract or agreement whose value changes with movements in an underlying index such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates, share prices or indices and which requires no initial investment or an initial investment that is smaller than would be required for other types of contracts with a similar response to market factors. The principal types of derivatives are: swaps, forwards, futures and options.

Discontinued operation - is a component of the Group that either has been disposed of or is classified as held for sale. A discontinued operation is either: a separate major line of business or geographical area of operations or part of a single co-ordinated plan to dispose of a separate major line of business or geographical area of operations; or a subsidiary acquired exclusively with a view to resale.

Exposure at default (EAD) - an estimate of the expected level of utilisation of a credit facility at the time of a borrower's default. The EAD may be higher than the current utilisation (e.g. in the case where further drawings may be made under a revolving credit facility prior to default) but will not typically exceed the total facility limit.

Fannie Mae (Federal National Mortgage Association) - is a US Government Sponsored Enterprise. It buys mortgages, principally issued by banks, on the secondary market, pools them, and sells them as residential mortgage-backed securities to investors on the open market. Its obligations are not explicitly guaranteed by the full faith and credit of the US Government.

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation - see Freddie Mac.

Federal National Mortgage Association - see Fannie Mae.

 
4

 
 
Glossary of terms (continued)

First/second lien - a lien is a charge such as a mortgage held by one party, over property owned by a second party, as security for payment of some debt, obligation, or duty owed by that second party. The holder of a first lien takes precedence over all other encumbrances on that property i.e. second and subsequent liens.

Forbearance - is the term generally applied to an agreement, principally in relation to secured loans with retail customers experiencing temporary financial difficulty, to a payment moratorium, to reduced repayments or to roll up arrears. Forbearance loans are a subset of Renegotiated loans.

Freddie Mac (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation) - is a US Government Sponsored Enterprise. It buys mortgages, principally issued by thrifts, on the secondary market, pools them, and sells them as residential mortgage-backed securities to investors on the open market. Its obligations are not explicitly guaranteed by the full faith and credit of the US Government.

G10 - the Group of Ten comprises the eleven industrial countries (Belgium, Canada, France, Germany, Italy, Japan, the Netherlands, Sweden, Switzerland, the United Kingdom and the United States) that have agreed to participate in the IMF's General Arrangements to Borrow.

Government Sponsored Enterprises (GSEs) - are a group of financial services corporations created by the US Congress. Their function is to improve the efficiency of capital markets and to overcome statutory and other market imperfections which otherwise prevent funds from moving easily from suppliers of funds to areas of high loan demand. They include Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac.

Gross yield - is the interest rate earned on average interest-earning assets i.e. interest income divided by average interest-earning assets.

Guaranteed mortgages - are mortgages that are guaranteed by a government or government agency. In the US, government loan guarantee programmes are offered by the Federal Housing Administration, the Department of Veterans Affairs and the Department of Agriculture's Rural Housing Service. In the Netherlands, the Gemeentegarantie programme is run partly by the central government and partly by the municipalities.

Home equity loan - is a type of loan in which the borrower uses the equity in their home as collateral. A home equity loan creates a charge against the borrower's house.

Impaired loans - comprise all loans for which an impairment provision has been established; for collectively assessed loans, impairment loss provisions are not allocated to individual loans and the entire portfolio is included in impaired loans.

Impairment allowance - see Loan impairment provisions.

Impairment losses - for impaired financial assets measured at amortised cost, impairment losses - the difference between carrying value and the present value of estimated future cash flows discounted at the asset's original effective interest rate - are recognised in profit or loss and the carrying amount of the financial asset reduced by establishing a provision (allowance). For impaired available-for-sale financial assets, the cumulative loss that had been recognised directly in equity is removed from equity and recognised in profit or loss as an impairment loss.

 
5

 
 
Glossary of terms (continued)

Individually assessed loan impairment provisions - impairment loss provisions for individually significant impaired loans assessed on a case-by-case basis, taking into account the financial condition of the counterparty and any guarantor and the realisable value of any collateral held.

International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) - is the independent standard-setting body of the IASC Foundation. Its members are responsible for the development and publication of International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) and for approving Interpretations of IFRS as developed by the International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC).

Interest spread - is the difference between the gross yield and the interest rate paid on average interest-bearing liabilities.

Investment grade - generally represents a risk profile similar to a rating of BBB-/Baa3 or better, as defined by independent rating agencies.

Latent loss provisions - loan impairment provisions held against impairments in the performing loan portfolio that have been incurred as a result of events occurring before the balance sheet date but which have not been identified as impaired at the balance sheet date. The Group has developed methodologies to estimate latent loss provisions that reflect historical loss experience (adjusted for current economic and credit conditions) and the period between an impairment occurring and a loan being identified and reported as impaired.

Loan impairment provisions - are established to recognise incurred impairment losses on a portfolio of loans classified as loans and receivables and carried at amortised cost. It has three components: individually assessed loan impairment provisions, collectively assessed loan impairment provisions and latent loss provisions.

Loan-to-value ratio - the amount of a secured loan as a percentage of the appraised value of the security e.g. the outstanding amount of a mortgage loan as a percentage of the property's value.

Loss given default (LGD) - the economic loss that may occur in the event of default i.e. the actual loss - that part of the exposure that is not expected to be recovered - plus any costs of recovery.

Master netting agreement - is an agreement between two counterparties that have multiple derivative contracts with each other that provides for the net settlement of all contracts through a single payment, in a single currency, in the event of default on, or termination of, any one contract.

Medium term notes (MTNs) - are debt securities usually with a maturity of five to ten years, but the term may be less than one year or as long as 50 years. They can be issued on a fixed or floating coupon basis or with an exotic coupon; with a fixed maturity date (non-callable) or with embedded call or put options or early repayment triggers. MTNs are most generally issued as senior, unsecured debt.

Monoline insurers - are entities that specialise in providing credit protection against the notional and interest cash flows due to the holders of debt instruments in the event of default. This protection is typically in the form of derivatives such as credit default swaps.
 
 
6

 
 
Glossary of terms (continued)

Mortgage-backed securities (MBS) - are asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are loans secured on property. See Residential mortgage backed securities and Commercial mortgage backed securities.

Net interest income - is the difference between interest receivable on financial assets classified as loans and receivables or available-for-sale and interest payable on financial liabilities carried at amortised cost.

Net interest margin - is net interest income as a percentage of average interest-earning assets.

Net principal exposure - is the carrying value of a financial asset after taking account of credit protection purchased but excluding the effect of any counterparty credit valuation adjustment to that protection.

Non-conforming mortgages - mortgage loans that do not meet the requirements for sale to US Government agencies or US Government sponsored enterprises. These requirements include limits on loan-to-value ratios, loan terms, loan amounts, borrower creditworthiness and other requirements.

Option - an option is a contract that gives the holder the right but not the obligation to buy (or sell) a specified amount of the underlying physical or financial commodity, at a specific price, at an agreed date or over an agreed period. Options can be exchange-traded or traded over-the-counter.

Past due - a financial asset such as a loan is past due when the counterparty has failed to make a payment when contractually due.

Potential problem loans - are loans other than impaired loans, accruing loans which are contractually overdue 90 days or more as to principal or interest and troubled debt restructurings where known information about possible credit problems of the borrower causes management to have serious doubts about the borrower's ability to meet the loan's repayment terms.

Prime - prime mortgage loans generally have low default risk and are made to borrowers with good credit records and a monthly income that is at least three to four times greater than their monthly housing expense (mortgage payments plus taxes and other debt payments). These borrowers provide full documentation and generally have reliable payment histories.

Probability of default (PD) - the likelihood that a customer will fail to make full and timely repayment of credit obligations over a one year time horizon.

Renegotiated loans - loans are generally renegotiated either as part of the ongoing banking relationship with a creditworthy customer or in response to a borrower's financial difficulties. In the latter case, renegotiation encompasses not only revisions to the terms of a loan such as a maturity extension, a payment moratorium, a concessionary rate of interest but also the restructuring of all or part of the exposure including debt forgiveness or a debt for equity swap. Loans renegotiated as part of the ongoing banking relationship with a creditworthy customer, are treated as new loans.

Repurchase agreement (Repo) - see Sale and repurchase agreements.
 
 
7

 
 
Glossary of terms (continued)

Residential mortgage backed securities (RMBS) - are asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are residential mortgages.

Retail loans - are loans made to individuals rather than institutions. The loans may be for car purchases, home purchases, medical care, home repair, holidays and other consumer uses.

Reverse repurchase agreement (Reverse repo) - see Sale and repurchase agreements.

Risk asset ratio (RAR) - total regulatory capital as a percentage of risk-weighted assets.

Risk elements in lending (REIL) - comprise impaired loans, accruing loans which are contractually overdue 90 days or more as to principal or interest and troubled debt restructurings.

Risk-weighted assets - assets adjusted for their associated risks using weightings established in accordance with the Basel Capital Accord as implemented by the FSA. Certain assets are not weighted but deducted from capital.

Sale and repurchase agreements - in a sale and repurchase agreement one party, the seller, sells a financial asset to another party, the buyer, at the same time the seller agrees to reacquire, and the buyer to resell, the asset at a later date. From the seller's perspective such agreements are repurchase agreements (repos) and from the buyer's reverse repurchase agreements (reverse repos).

Securitisation - is a process by which assets or cash flows are transformed into transferable securities. The underlying assets or cash flows are transferred by the originator or an intermediary, typically an investment bank, to a special purpose entity which issues securities to investors. Asset securitisations involve issuing debt securities (asset-backed securities) that are backed by the cash flows of income-generating assets (ranging from credit card receivables to residential mortgage loans). Liability securitisations typically involve issuing bonds that assume the risk of a potential insurance liability (ranging from a catastrophic natural event to an unexpected claims level on a certain product type).

Special purpose entity (SPE) - is an entity created by a sponsor, typically a major bank, finance company, investment bank or insurance company. An SPE can take the form of a corporation, trust, partnership, corporation or a limited liability company. Its operations are typically limited for example in a securitisation to the acquisition and financing of specific assets or liabilities.

Structured credit portfolio (SCP) - the SCP is a portfolio of certain of the Group’s illiquid assets - principally CDO super senior positions, negative basis trades and monoline exposures - held within Non-Core division.

Structured notes - are securities that pay a return linked to the value or level of a specified asset or index. Structured notes can be linked to equities, interest rates, funds, commodities and foreign currency.

 
8

 
 
Glossary of terms (continued)

Subordinated liabilities - are liabilities which, in the event of insolvency or liquidation of the issuer, are subordinated to the claims of depositors and other creditors of the issuer.

Sub-prime - sub-prime mortgage loans are designed for customers with one or more high risk characteristics, such as: unreliable or poor payment histories; loan-to-value ratio of greater than 80%; high debt-to-income ratio; the loan is not secured on the borrower's primary residence; or a history of delinquencies or late payments on the loan.

Super senior CDO - is the most senior class of instrument issued by a CDO vehicle. They benefit from the subordination of all other instruments, including AAA rated securities, issued by the CDO vehicle.

Tangible Net Asset Value (TNAV) - Owners’ equity attributable to ordinary and B shareholders less intangible assets, divided by number of ordinary and B shares in issue.

Tier 1 capital - core Tier 1 capital plus other Tier 1 securities in issue, less material holdings in financial companies.

Tier 1 capital ratio - Tier 1 capital as a percentage of risk-weighted assets.

Tier 2 capital - qualifying subordinated debt and other Tier 2 securities in issue, eligible collective impairment allowances, unrealised available-for-sale equity gains and revaluation reserves less certain regulatory deductions.

VaR - is a technique that produces estimates of the potential change in the market value of a portfolio over a specified time horizon at given confidence levels.

Write down - a reduction in the carrying value of an asset to record a decline in its fair value or value in use.
 
 
 
 
9